doc: Fix typos.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set KEY-SERVER pool.sks-keyservers.net
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 ng0@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65
66 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
67 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
68 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
69 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
70 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
71 Documentation License''.
72 @end copying
73
74 @dircategory System administration
75 @direntry
76 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
77 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
78 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
79 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
80 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
81 @end direntry
82
83 @dircategory Software development
84 @direntry
85 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
86 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
87 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
88 @end direntry
89
90 @titlepage
91 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
92 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
93 @author The GNU Guix Developers
94
95 @page
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
98 @value{UPDATED} @*
99
100 @insertcopying
101 @end titlepage
102
103 @contents
104
105 @c *********************************************************************
106 @node Top
107 @top GNU Guix
108
109 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
110 package management tool written for the GNU system.
111
112 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
113 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
114 @c translation.
115 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
116 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
117 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}), and
118 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}). If you
119 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
120 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
121 Project}.
122
123 @menu
124 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
125 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
126 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
127 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
128 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
129 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
130 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
131 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
132 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
133 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
134 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
135 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
136 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
137 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
138
139 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
140 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
141 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
142 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
143
144 @detailmenu
145 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
146
147 Introduction
148
149 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
150 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
151
152 Installation
153
154 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
155 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
156 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
157 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
158 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
159 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
160
161 Setting Up the Daemon
162
163 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
164 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
165 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
166
167 System Installation
168
169 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
170 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
171 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
172 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
173 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
174 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
175 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
176 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
177 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
178
179 Manual Installation
180
181 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
182 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
183
184 Package Management
185
186 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
187 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
188 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
189 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
190 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
191 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
192 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
193 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
194 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
195 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
196
197 Substitutes
198
199 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
200 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
201 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
202 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
203 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
204 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
205
206 Development
207
208 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
209 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
210
211 Programming Interface
212
213 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
214 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
215 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
216 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
217 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
218 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
219 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
220 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
221
222 Defining Packages
223
224 * package Reference:: The package data type.
225 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
226
227 Utilities
228
229 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
230 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
231 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
232 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
233 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
234 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
235 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
236 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
237 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
238 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
239 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
240 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
241 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
242 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
243 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
244
245 Invoking @command{guix build}
246
247 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
248 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
249 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
250 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
251
252 System Configuration
253
254 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
255 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
256 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
257 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
258 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
259 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
260 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
261 * Services:: Specifying system services.
262 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
263 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
264 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
265 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
266 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
267 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
268 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
269 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
270
271 Services
272
273 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
274 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
275 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
276 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
277 * X Window:: Graphical display.
278 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
279 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
280 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
281 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
282 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
283 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
284 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
285 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
286 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
287 * Web Services:: Web servers.
288 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
289 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
290 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
291 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
292 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
293 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
294 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
295 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
296 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
297 * Game Services:: Game servers.
298 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
299
300 Defining Services
301
302 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
303 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
304 * Service Reference:: API reference.
305 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
306
307 @end detailmenu
308 @end menu
309
310 @c *********************************************************************
311 @node Introduction
312 @chapter Introduction
313
314 @cindex purpose
315 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
316 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
317 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
318 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
319 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
320 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
321 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
322
323 @cindex Guix System
324 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
325 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
326 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
327 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
328 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
329 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
330 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
331 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
332 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
333 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
334
335 @menu
336 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
337 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
338 @end menu
339
340 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
341 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
342
343 @cindex user interfaces
344 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
345 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
346 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage,
347 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
348 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
349 @cindex build daemon
350 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
351 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
352 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
353
354 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
355 @cindex customization, of packages
356 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
357 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
358 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
359 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
360 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
361 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
362 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
363 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
364
365 @cindex functional package management
366 @cindex isolation
367 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
368 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
369 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
370 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
371 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
372 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
373 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
374 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
375 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
376 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
377 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
378 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
379 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
380 explicit inputs are visible.
381
382 @cindex store
383 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
384 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
385 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
386 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
387 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
388 input yields a different directory name.
389
390 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
391 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
392 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
393
394
395 @node GNU Distribution
396 @section GNU Distribution
397
398 @cindex Guix System
399 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
400 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
401 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
402 users of that software}.}. The
403 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
404 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
405 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
406 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
407 Guix@tie{}System.
408
409 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
410 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
411 list of available packages can be browsed
412 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
413 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
414
415 @example
416 guix package --list-available
417 @end example
418
419 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
420 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
421 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
422 tools that help users exert that freedom.
423
424 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
425
426 @table @code
427
428 @item x86_64-linux
429 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
430
431 @item i686-linux
432 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
433
434 @item armhf-linux
435 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
436 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
437 and Linux-Libre kernel.
438
439 @item aarch64-linux
440 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel. This is
441 currently in an experimental stage, with limited support.
442 @xref{Contributing}, for how to help!
443
444 @item mips64el-linux
445 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
446 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
447
448 @end table
449
450 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
451 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
452 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
453 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
454 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
455 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
456 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
457
458 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
459 @code{mips64el-linux}.
460
461 @noindent
462 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
463 @pxref{Porting}.
464
465 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
466 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
467
468
469 @c *********************************************************************
470 @node Installation
471 @chapter Installation
472
473 @cindex installing Guix
474
475 @quotation Note
476 We recommend the use of this
477 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
478 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
479 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
480 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
481 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
482 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
483 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
484 as the root user.
485 @end quotation
486
487 @cindex foreign distro
488 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
489 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
490 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
491 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
492 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
493
494 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
495 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
496
497 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
498 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
499 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
500 ready to use it.
501
502 @menu
503 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
504 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
505 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
506 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
507 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
508 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
509 @end menu
510
511 @node Binary Installation
512 @section Binary Installation
513
514 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
515 @cindex installer script
516 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
517 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
518 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
519 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
520 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
521
522 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
523 @quotation Note
524 We recommend the use of this
525 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
526 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
527 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
528 user.
529 @end quotation
530
531 Installing goes along these lines:
532
533 @enumerate
534 @item
535 @cindex downloading Guix binary
536 Download the binary tarball from
537 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
538 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
539 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
540
541 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
542 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
543 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
544
545 @example
546 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
547 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
548 @end example
549
550 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
551 then run this command to import it:
552
553 @example
554 $ gpg --keyserver @value{KEY-SERVER} \
555 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
556 @end example
557
558 @noindent
559 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
560 @c end authentication part
561
562 @item
563 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
564 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
565
566 @example
567 # cd /tmp
568 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
569 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
570 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
571 @end example
572
573 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
574 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
575 step.)
576
577 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
578 would overwrite its own essential files.
579
580 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
581 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
582 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
583 versions are fine.)
584 They stem from the fact that all the
585 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
586 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
587 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
588 reproducible.
589
590 @item
591 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
592 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
593
594 @example
595 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
596 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
597 ~root/.config/guix/current
598 @end example
599
600 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @code{PATH} and other relevant
601 environment variables:
602
603 @example
604 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
605 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
606 @end example
607
608 @item
609 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
610 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
611
612 @item
613 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
614
615 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
616 with these commands:
617
618 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
619 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
620 @c files into place.
621 @c
622 @c See this thread for more information:
623 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
624
625 @example
626 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
627 /etc/systemd/system/
628 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
629 @end example
630
631 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
632
633 @example
634 # initctl reload-configuration
635 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
636 /etc/init/
637 # start guix-daemon
638 @end example
639
640 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
641
642 @example
643 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
644 --build-users-group=guixbuild
645 @end example
646
647 @item
648 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
649 for instance with:
650
651 @example
652 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
653 # cd /usr/local/bin
654 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
655 @end example
656
657 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
658 there:
659
660 @example
661 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
662 # cd /usr/local/share/info
663 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
664 do ln -s $i ; done
665 @end example
666
667 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
668 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
669 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
670 Info search path.)
671
672 @item
673 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
674 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
675 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
676
677 @example
678 # guix archive --authorize < \
679 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
680 @end example
681
682 @item
683 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
684 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
685 @end enumerate
686
687 Voilà, the installation is complete!
688
689 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
690 the root profile:
691
692 @example
693 # guix install hello
694 @end example
695
696 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
697 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
698
699 @example
700 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
701 @end example
702
703 @noindent
704 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
705
706 @example
707 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
708 --profile-name=current-guix guix
709 @end example
710
711 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
712
713 @node Requirements
714 @section Requirements
715
716 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
717 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
718 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
719 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
720
721 @cindex official website
722 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
723 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
724
725 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
726
727 @itemize
728 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.2.x;
729 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
730 0.1.0 or later;
731 @item
732 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
733 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
734 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
735 @item
736 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
737 or later;
738 @item
739 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
740 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
741 2017 or later;
742 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON};
743 @item @url{https://zlib.net, zlib};
744 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
745 @end itemize
746
747 The following dependencies are optional:
748
749 @itemize
750 @item
751 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
752 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
753 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
754 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
755 version 0.10.2 or later.
756
757 @item
758 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
759 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
760 @end itemize
761
762 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
763 following packages are also needed:
764
765 @itemize
766 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
767 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
768 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
769 C++11 standard.
770 @end itemize
771
772 @cindex state directory
773 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
774 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
775 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
776 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
777 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
778 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
779 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
780
781 @cindex Nix, compatibility
782 When a working installation of @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
783 manager} is available, you
784 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
785 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
786
787 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
788 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
789 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
790 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
791 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
792 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
793 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
794 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
795 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
796
797 @node Running the Test Suite
798 @section Running the Test Suite
799
800 @cindex test suite
801 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
802 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
803 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
804 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
805 suite, type:
806
807 @example
808 make check
809 @end example
810
811 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
812 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
813 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
814 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
815 cache.
816
817 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
818 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
819
820 @example
821 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
822 @end example
823
824 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
825 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
826 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
827
828 @example
829 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
830 @end example
831
832 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
833 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
834 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
835 your message.
836
837 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
838 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
839 Guix is already installed, using:
840
841 @example
842 make check-system
843 @end example
844
845 @noindent
846 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
847
848 @example
849 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
850 @end example
851
852 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
853 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
854 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
855 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
856 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
857 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
858
859 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
860 all the details.
861
862 @node Setting Up the Daemon
863 @section Setting Up the Daemon
864
865 @cindex daemon
866 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
867 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
868 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
869 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
870 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
871 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
872 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
873
874 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
875 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
876 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
877
878 @menu
879 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
880 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
881 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
882 @end menu
883
884 @node Build Environment Setup
885 @subsection Build Environment Setup
886
887 @cindex build environment
888 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
889 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
890 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
891 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
892 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
893 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
894 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
895
896 @cindex build users
897 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
898 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
899 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
900 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
901 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
902 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
903 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
904 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
905 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
906 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
907
908 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
909 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
910
911 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
912 @c for why `-G' is needed.
913 @example
914 # groupadd --system guixbuild
915 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
916 do
917 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
918 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
919 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
920 guixbuilder$i;
921 done
922 @end example
923
924 @noindent
925 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
926 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
927 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
928 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
929 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
930 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
931 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
932
933 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
934 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
935 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
936 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
937 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
938 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
939 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
940 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
941
942 @example
943 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
944 @end example
945
946 @cindex chroot
947 @noindent
948 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
949 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
950 environment contains nothing but:
951
952 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
953 @itemize
954 @item
955 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
956 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
957 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
958 can only be created if the host has them.};
959
960 @item
961 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
962 since a separate PID name space is used;
963
964 @item
965 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
966 user @file{nobody};
967
968 @item
969 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
970
971 @item
972 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
973 @code{127.0.0.1};
974
975 @item
976 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
977 @end itemize
978
979 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
980 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
981 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
982 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
983 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
984 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
985 capture the name of their build tree.
986
987 @vindex http_proxy
988 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
989 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
990 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
991
992 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
993 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
994 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
995 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
996 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
997 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
998 @emph{pure} functions.
999
1000
1001 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1002 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1003
1004 @cindex offloading
1005 @cindex build hook
1006 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1007 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1008 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1009 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1010 present.}. When that
1011 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
1012 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
1013 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
1014 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
1015 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
1016 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
1017 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
1018 build are copied back to the initial machine.
1019
1020 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1021
1022 @example
1023 (list (build-machine
1024 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1025 (system "x86_64-linux")
1026 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1027 (user "bob")
1028 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1029
1030 (build-machine
1031 (name "meeps.example.org")
1032 (system "mips64el-linux")
1033 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1034 (user "alice")
1035 (private-key
1036 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1037 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1038 @end example
1039
1040 @noindent
1041 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1042 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
1043 architecture.
1044
1045 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1046 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1047 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1048 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1049 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1050 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1051 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1052 detailed below.
1053
1054 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1055 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1056 builds. The important fields are:
1057
1058 @table @code
1059
1060 @item name
1061 The host name of the remote machine.
1062
1063 @item system
1064 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
1065
1066 @item user
1067 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1068 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1069 allow non-interactive logins.
1070
1071 @item host-key
1072 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1073 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1074 long string that looks like this:
1075
1076 @example
1077 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1078 @end example
1079
1080 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1081 key can be found in a file such as
1082 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1083
1084 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1085 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1086 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1087 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1088
1089 @example
1090 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1091 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1092 @end example
1093
1094 @end table
1095
1096 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1097
1098 @table @asis
1099
1100 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1101 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1102
1103 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1104 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1105 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1106
1107 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1108 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1109
1110 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1111 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1112 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1113
1114 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1115 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1116
1117 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1118 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1119 to on that machine.
1120
1121 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1122 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1123
1124 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1125 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1126 machines with a higher speed factor.
1127
1128 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1129 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1130 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1131 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1132 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1133
1134 @end table
1135 @end deftp
1136
1137 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1138 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1139
1140 @example
1141 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1142 @end example
1143
1144 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1145 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1146 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1147 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1148 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1149
1150 @example
1151 # guix archive --generate-key
1152 @end example
1153
1154 @noindent
1155 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1156 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1157
1158 @example
1159 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1160 @end example
1161
1162 @noindent
1163 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1164
1165 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1166 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1167 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1168 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1169 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1170
1171 @cindex offload test
1172 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1173 master node:
1174
1175 @example
1176 # guix offload test
1177 @end example
1178
1179 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1180 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1181 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1182 from it, and report any error in the process.
1183
1184 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1185 command line:
1186
1187 @example
1188 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1189 @end example
1190
1191 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1192 regular expression like this:
1193
1194 @example
1195 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1196 @end example
1197
1198 @cindex offload status
1199 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1200 main node:
1201
1202 @example
1203 # guix offload status
1204 @end example
1205
1206
1207 @node SELinux Support
1208 @subsection SELinux Support
1209
1210 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1211 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1212 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1213 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1214 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1215 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1216 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1217 be used on Guix System.
1218
1219 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1220 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1221 To install the policy run this command as root:
1222
1223 @example
1224 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1225 @end example
1226
1227 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1228 mechanism provided by your system.
1229
1230 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1231 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1232 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1233 command:
1234
1235 @example
1236 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1237 @end example
1238
1239 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1240 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1241 operations.
1242
1243 @subsubsection Limitations
1244 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1245
1246 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1247 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1248 the Guix daemon.
1249
1250 @enumerate
1251 @item
1252 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1253 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1254 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1255 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1256
1257 @item
1258 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1259 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1260 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1261 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1262 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1263 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1264 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1265 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1266 reading and following these links.
1267
1268 @item
1269 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1270 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1271 differently from files.
1272
1273 @item
1274 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1275 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1276 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1277 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1278 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1279 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1280 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1281 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1282 allowed for processes in that domain.
1283
1284 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1285 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1286 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1287 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1288 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1289 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1290 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1291 @end enumerate
1292
1293 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1294 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1295
1296 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1297 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1298 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1299 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1300
1301 @example
1302 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1303 @end example
1304
1305 @noindent
1306 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1307
1308 @cindex chroot
1309 @cindex container, build environment
1310 @cindex build environment
1311 @cindex reproducible builds
1312 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1313 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1314 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1315 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1316 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1317 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1318 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1319 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1320 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1321 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1322 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1323
1324 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1325 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1326 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1327 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1328 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1329
1330 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1331 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1332 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1333
1334 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1335 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands.) The
1336 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1337 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1338 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1339
1340 The following command-line options are supported:
1341
1342 @table @code
1343 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1344 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1345 the Daemon, build users}).
1346
1347 @item --no-substitutes
1348 @cindex substitutes
1349 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1350 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1351 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1352
1353 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1354 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1355 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1356
1357 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1358 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1359 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1360 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1361 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1362
1363 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1364 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1365
1366 @cindex build hook
1367 @item --no-build-hook
1368 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1369
1370 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1371 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1372 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1373
1374 @item --cache-failures
1375 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1376
1377 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1378 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1379 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1380 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1381
1382 @item --cores=@var{n}
1383 @itemx -c @var{n}
1384 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1385 as available.
1386
1387 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1388 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1389 guix build}).
1390
1391 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1392 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1393 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1394
1395 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1396 @itemx -M @var{n}
1397 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1398 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1399 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1400 Setup}), or simply fail.
1401
1402 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1403 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1404 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1405
1406 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1407
1408 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1409 Build Options, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
1410
1411 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1412 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1413 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1414
1415 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1416
1417 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1418 Build Options, @code{--timeout}}).
1419
1420 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1421 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1422 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1423 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1424 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1425
1426 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1427 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1428 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1429
1430 @item --debug
1431 Produce debugging output.
1432
1433 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1434 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1435 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1436
1437 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1438 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1439
1440 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1441 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1442 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1443 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1444 needs.
1445
1446 @item --disable-chroot
1447 Disable chroot builds.
1448
1449 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1450 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1451 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1452 account.
1453
1454 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1455 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1456 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1457
1458 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1459 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1460 them with bzip2 by default.
1461
1462 @item --disable-deduplication
1463 @cindex deduplication
1464 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1465
1466 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1467 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1468 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1469 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1470 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1471 this optimization.
1472
1473 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1474 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1475 derivations.
1476
1477 @cindex GC roots
1478 @cindex garbage collector roots
1479 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1480 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1481 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are reachable from a GC
1482 root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC roots.
1483
1484 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1485 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1486 corresponding to live outputs.
1487
1488 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1489 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1490 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1491 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1492
1493 In this way, setting @code{--gc-keep-derivations} to ``yes'' causes liveness
1494 to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting @code{--gc-keep-outputs} to
1495 ``yes'' causes liveness to flow from derivations to outputs. When both are
1496 set to ``yes'', the effect is to keep all the build prerequisites (the
1497 sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time tools) of live objects in
1498 the store, regardless of whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC
1499 root. This is convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1500
1501 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1502 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1503 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1504
1505 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1506 on the kernel version number.
1507
1508 @item --lose-logs
1509 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1510 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1511
1512 @item --system=@var{system}
1513 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1514 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1515 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1516
1517 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1518 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1519 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1520 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1521 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1522
1523 @table @code
1524 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1525 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1526 creating it if needed.
1527
1528 @item --listen=localhost
1529 @cindex daemon, remote access
1530 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1531 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1532 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1533 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1534 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1535
1536 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1537 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1538 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1539 @end table
1540
1541 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1542 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1543 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1544 by setting the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1545 (@pxref{The Store, @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1546
1547 @quotation Note
1548 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1549 @code{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1550 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1551 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1552 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1553 @end quotation
1554
1555 When @code{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1556 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1557 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1558 @end table
1559
1560
1561 @node Application Setup
1562 @section Application Setup
1563
1564 @cindex foreign distro
1565 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1566 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1567 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1568
1569 @subsection Locales
1570
1571 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1572 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1573 @vindex LOCPATH
1574 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1575 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1576 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1577 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1578 variable:
1579
1580 @example
1581 $ guix install glibc-locales
1582 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1583 @end example
1584
1585 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1586 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1587 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1588 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1589
1590 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1591 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1592 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1593
1594 @enumerate
1595 @item
1596 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1597 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1598 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1599 incompatible locale data.
1600
1601 @item
1602 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1603 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1604 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1605 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1606 data in the right format.
1607 @end enumerate
1608
1609 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1610 versions may be incompatible.
1611
1612 @subsection Name Service Switch
1613
1614 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1615 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1616 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1617 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1618 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1619 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1620 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1621 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1622 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1623 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1624
1625 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1626 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1627 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1628 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1629 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1630
1631 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1632 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1633 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1634 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1635 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1636 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1637 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1638 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1639 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1640 Reference Manual}).
1641
1642 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1643 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1644 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1645 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1646 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1647 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1648 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1649 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1650 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1651
1652 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1653 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1654 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1655 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1656
1657 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1658 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1659 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1660 themselves.
1661
1662 @subsection X11 Fonts
1663
1664 @cindex fonts
1665 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1666 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1667 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1668 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1669 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1670 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1671 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1672
1673 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1674 graphical applications, consider installing
1675 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1676 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1677 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1678 for Chinese languages:
1679
1680 @example
1681 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @cindex @code{xterm}
1685 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1686 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1687 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1688
1689 @example
1690 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1691 @end example
1692
1693 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1694 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1695
1696 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1697 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1698 @example
1699 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1700 @end example
1701
1702 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1703 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1704 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1705
1706 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1707 @cindex font cache
1708 After installing fonts you may have to refresh the font cache to use
1709 them in applications. The same applies when applications installed via
1710 Guix do not seem to find fonts. To force rebuilding of the font cache
1711 run @code{fc-cache -f}. The @code{fc-cache} command is provided by the
1712 @code{fontconfig} package.
1713
1714 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1715
1716 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1717 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1718 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1719
1720 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1721 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1722 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1723 information.
1724
1725 @subsection Emacs Packages
1726
1727 @cindex @code{emacs}
1728 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1729 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1730 sub-directories of
1731 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1732 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1733 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may not be
1734 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1735 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1736 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1737 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1738
1739 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1740 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1741 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1742 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1743 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1744
1745 @subsection The GCC toolchain
1746
1747 @cindex GCC
1748 @cindex ld-wrapper
1749
1750 Guix offers individual compiler packages such as @code{gcc} but if you
1751 are in need of a complete toolchain for compiling and linking source
1752 code what you really want is the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This
1753 package provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development,
1754 including GCC itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus
1755 debugging symbols in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker
1756 wrapper.
1757
1758 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
1759 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
1760 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
1761 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
1762 @code{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
1763
1764 @c TODO What else?
1765
1766 @c *********************************************************************
1767 @node System Installation
1768 @chapter System Installation
1769
1770 @cindex installing Guix System
1771 @cindex Guix System, installation
1772 This section explains how to install Guix System
1773 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1774 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1775 @pxref{Installation}.
1776
1777 @ifinfo
1778 @quotation Note
1779 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1780 @c installation image.
1781 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1782 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1783 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1784 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1785
1786 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1787 available.
1788 @end quotation
1789 @end ifinfo
1790
1791 @menu
1792 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1793 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1794 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1795 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1796 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1797 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1798 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1799 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1800 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1801 @end menu
1802
1803 @node Limitations
1804 @section Limitations
1805
1806 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1807 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1808 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1809
1810 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1811 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1812
1813 @itemize
1814 @item
1815 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
1816
1817 @item
1818 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1819 may be missing.
1820
1821 @item
1822 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1823 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1824 missing.
1825 @end itemize
1826
1827 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1828 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
1829 info.
1830
1831
1832 @node Hardware Considerations
1833 @section Hardware Considerations
1834
1835 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
1836 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
1837 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
1838 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
1839 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
1840 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
1841 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
1842 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
1843 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
1844
1845 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
1846 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
1847 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
1848 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
1849 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
1850 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
1851 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
1852 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
1853 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
1854
1855 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
1856 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
1857 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
1858 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
1859 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
1860 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
1861
1862 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
1863 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
1864 about their support in GNU/Linux.
1865
1866
1867 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
1868 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
1869
1870 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
1871 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
1872 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz},
1873 where @var{system} is one of:
1874
1875 @table @code
1876 @item x86_64-linux
1877 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
1878
1879 @item i686-linux
1880 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
1881 @end table
1882
1883 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
1884 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
1885 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
1886
1887 @example
1888 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1889 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1890 @end example
1891
1892 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
1893 then run this command to import it:
1894
1895 @example
1896 $ gpg --keyserver @value{KEY-SERVER} \
1897 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
1898 @end example
1899
1900 @noindent
1901 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
1902 @c end duplication
1903
1904 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
1905 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
1906
1907 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
1908
1909 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
1910
1911 @enumerate
1912 @item
1913 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1914
1915 @example
1916 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1917 @end example
1918
1919 @item
1920 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
1921 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
1922 copy the image with:
1923
1924 @example
1925 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso of=/dev/sdX
1926 sync
1927 @end example
1928
1929 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
1930 @end enumerate
1931
1932 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
1933
1934 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
1935
1936 @enumerate
1937 @item
1938 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1939
1940 @example
1941 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1942 @end example
1943
1944 @item
1945 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
1946 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
1947 copy the image with:
1948
1949 @example
1950 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
1951 @end example
1952
1953 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
1954 @end enumerate
1955
1956 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
1957
1958 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
1959 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
1960 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
1961
1962 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
1963 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
1964
1965
1966 @node Preparing for Installation
1967 @section Preparing for Installation
1968
1969 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
1970 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternately,
1971 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
1972 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
1973 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
1974
1975 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
1976 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
1977 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
1978 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
1979 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
1980 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
1981 with the middle button.
1982
1983 @quotation Note
1984 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
1985 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
1986 ``Networking'' section below.
1987 @end quotation
1988
1989 @node Guided Graphical Installation
1990 @section Guided Graphical Installation
1991
1992 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
1993 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
1994
1995 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
1996 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
1997 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
1998 the networking dialog.
1999
2000 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2001
2002 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2003 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2004 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2005 things.
2006
2007 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2008
2009 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2010 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2011
2012 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2013
2014 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2015 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2016 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2017 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2018
2019
2020 @node Manual Installation
2021 @section Manual Installation
2022
2023 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2024 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2025 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2026 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2027 Installation}).
2028
2029 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2030 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2031 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2032 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2033 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2034
2035 @menu
2036 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2037 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2038 @end menu
2039
2040 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2041 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2042
2043 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2044 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2045 guide you through this.
2046
2047 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2048
2049 @cindex keyboard layout
2050 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2051 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2052 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2053
2054 @example
2055 loadkeys dvorak
2056 @end example
2057
2058 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2059 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2060 more information.
2061
2062 @subsubsection Networking
2063
2064 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2065
2066 @example
2067 ifconfig -a
2068 @end example
2069
2070 @noindent
2071 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2072
2073 @example
2074 ip a
2075 @end example
2076
2077 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2078 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2079 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2080 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2081 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2082
2083 @table @asis
2084 @item Wired connection
2085 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2086 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2087
2088 @example
2089 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2090 @end example
2091
2092 @item Wireless connection
2093 @cindex wireless
2094 @cindex WiFi
2095 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2096 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2097 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2098 @command{nano}:
2099
2100 @example
2101 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2102 @end example
2103
2104 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2105 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2106 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2107
2108 @example
2109 network=@{
2110 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2111 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2112 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2113 @}
2114 @end example
2115
2116 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2117 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2118 network interface you want to use):
2119
2120 @example
2121 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2122 @end example
2123
2124 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2125 @end table
2126
2127 @cindex DHCP
2128 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2129 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2130
2131 @example
2132 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2133 @end example
2134
2135 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2136
2137 @example
2138 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2139 @end example
2140
2141 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2142 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2143
2144 @cindex installing over SSH
2145 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2146 an SSH server:
2147
2148 @example
2149 herd start ssh-daemon
2150 @end example
2151
2152 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2153 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2154
2155 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2156
2157 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2158 then format the target partition(s).
2159
2160 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2161 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2162 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2163 the partition layout you want:
2164
2165 @example
2166 cfdisk
2167 @end example
2168
2169 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2170 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2171 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2172 manual}).
2173
2174 @cindex EFI, installation
2175 @cindex UEFI, installation
2176 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2177 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2178 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2179 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2180
2181 @example
2182 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2183 @end example
2184
2185 @quotation Note
2186 @vindex grub-bootloader
2187 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2188 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2189 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2190 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2191 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2192 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2193 bootloaders.
2194 @end quotation
2195
2196 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2197 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2198 Guix System only supports ext4 and btrfs file systems. In particular, code
2199 that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
2200 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2201 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2202
2203 @example
2204 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2205 @end example
2206
2207 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2208 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2209 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2210 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2211 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2212 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2213
2214 @example
2215 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2216 @end example
2217
2218 @cindex encrypted disk
2219 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2220 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2221 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2222 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
2223 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2224 be along these lines:
2225
2226 @example
2227 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2228 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2229 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2230 @end example
2231
2232 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2233 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2234 root file system):
2235
2236 @example
2237 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2238 @end example
2239
2240 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2241 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2242 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2243 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2244
2245 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2246 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2247 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2248 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2249
2250 @example
2251 mkswap /dev/sda3
2252 swapon /dev/sda3
2253 @end example
2254
2255 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2256 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2257 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2258 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2259 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2260 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2261
2262 @example
2263 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2264 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2265 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2266 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2267 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2268 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2269 @end example
2270
2271 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2272 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2273 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2274
2275 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2276 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2277
2278 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2279 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2280
2281 @example
2282 herd start cow-store /mnt
2283 @end example
2284
2285 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2286 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2287 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2288 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2289 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2290
2291 Next, you have to edit a file and
2292 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2293 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2294 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2295 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2296 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2297 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2298 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2299 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2300 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2301
2302 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2303 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2304 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2305 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2306 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2307 something along these lines:
2308
2309 @example
2310 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2311 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2312 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2313 @end example
2314
2315 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2316 in particular:
2317
2318 @itemize
2319 @item
2320 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2321 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2322 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2323 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2324 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2325 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2326 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2327 configuration.
2328
2329 @item
2330 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2331 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2332 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2333 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2334
2335 @item
2336 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2337 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2338 @end itemize
2339
2340 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2341 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2342 under @file{/mnt}):
2343
2344 @example
2345 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2346 @end example
2347
2348 @noindent
2349 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2350 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2351 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2352 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2353
2354 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2355 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2356 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2357 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2358 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2359 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2360 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2361
2362
2363 @node After System Installation
2364 @section After System Installation
2365
2366 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2367 system whenever you want by running, say:
2368
2369 @example
2370 guix pull
2371 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2372 @end example
2373
2374 @noindent
2375 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2376 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2377 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2378
2379 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2380 @quotation Note
2381 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2382 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2383 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @code{PATH} unchanged. To
2384 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2385 @end quotation
2386
2387 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2388 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2389
2390
2391 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2392 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2393
2394 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2395 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2396 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2397 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2398 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2399 section is for you.
2400
2401 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2402 disk image, follow these steps:
2403
2404 @enumerate
2405 @item
2406 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2407 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2408
2409 @item
2410 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2411 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2412
2413 @example
2414 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 50G
2415 @end example
2416
2417 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2418 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2419
2420 @item
2421 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2422
2423 @example
2424 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 \
2425 -net user -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
2426 -drive file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso \
2427 -drive file=guixsd.img
2428 @end example
2429
2430 The ordering of the drives matters.
2431
2432 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
2433 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
2434 selection.
2435
2436 @item
2437 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2438 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2439 @end enumerate
2440
2441 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2442 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2443 that.
2444
2445 @node Building the Installation Image
2446 @section Building the Installation Image
2447
2448 @cindex installation image
2449 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2450 system} command, specifically:
2451
2452 @example
2453 guix system disk-image --file-system-type=iso9660 \
2454 gnu/system/install.scm
2455 @end example
2456
2457 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2458 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2459 about the installation image.
2460
2461 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2462
2463 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2464 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2465
2466 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2467 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2468 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2469
2470 @example
2471 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2472 @end example
2473
2474 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2475 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2476
2477 @c *********************************************************************
2478 @node Package Management
2479 @chapter Package Management
2480
2481 @cindex packages
2482 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2483 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2484 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2485 features.
2486
2487 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2488 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2489 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2490 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2491 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2492 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2493 with it):
2494
2495 @example
2496 guix install emacs-guix
2497 @end example
2498
2499 @menu
2500 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2501 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2502 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2503 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2504 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2505 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2506 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
2507 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2508 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2509 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2510 @end menu
2511
2512 @node Features
2513 @section Features
2514
2515 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2516 own directory---something that resembles
2517 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2518
2519 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2520 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2521 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2522 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2523
2524 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2525 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2526 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2527 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2528 simply continues to point to
2529 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2530 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2531
2532 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2533 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2534 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2535
2536 @cindex transactions
2537 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2538 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2539 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2540 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2541 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2542 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2543
2544 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2545 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2546 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2547 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2548 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2549 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2550 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2551
2552 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2553 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2554 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2555 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2556 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2557 collected.
2558
2559 @cindex reproducibility
2560 @cindex reproducible builds
2561 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2562 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2563 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2564 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2565 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2566 given package installation matches the current state of their
2567 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2568 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2569 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2570 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2571
2572 @cindex substitutes
2573 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2574 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2575 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2576 downloads it and unpacks it;
2577 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2578 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2579 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2580 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2581 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2582
2583 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2584 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2585 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2586 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2587 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2588
2589 @cindex replication, of software environments
2590 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
2591 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
2592 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
2593 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
2594 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
2595 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
2596 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
2597
2598 @node Invoking guix package
2599 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
2600
2601 @cindex installing packages
2602 @cindex removing packages
2603 @cindex package installation
2604 @cindex package removal
2605 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
2606 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
2607 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
2608 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
2609 is:
2610
2611 @example
2612 guix package @var{options}
2613 @end example
2614
2615 @cindex transactions
2616 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
2617 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
2618 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
2619 want to roll back.
2620
2621 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
2622 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
2623
2624 @example
2625 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
2626 @end example
2627
2628 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
2629 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
2630
2631 @itemize
2632 @item
2633 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
2634 @item
2635 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
2636 @item
2637 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
2638 @item
2639 and @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u}.
2640 @end itemize
2641
2642 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
2643 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
2644 package} directly.
2645
2646 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
2647 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
2648 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
2649 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
2650
2651 @cindex profile
2652 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
2653 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
2654 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
2655 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
2656 variable, and so on.
2657 @cindex search paths
2658 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
2659 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
2660 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
2661 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
2662
2663 @example
2664 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
2665 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
2666 @end example
2667
2668 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
2669 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
2670 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
2671 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
2672 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
2673 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
2674 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
2675 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
2676 package}.
2677
2678 The @var{options} can be among the following:
2679
2680 @table @code
2681
2682 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
2683 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
2684 Install the specified @var{package}s.
2685
2686 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
2687 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
2688 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
2689 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
2690
2691 If no version number is specified, the
2692 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
2693 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
2694 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
2695 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
2696 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
2697 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2698
2699 @cindex propagated inputs
2700 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
2701 that automatically get installed along with the required package
2702 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
2703 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
2704 package definitions).
2705
2706 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
2707 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
2708 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
2709 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
2710 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
2711 also been explicitly installed by the user.
2712
2713 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
2714 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
2715 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
2716 environment variable definitions are reported here.
2717
2718 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
2719 @itemx -e @var{exp}
2720 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
2721
2722 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
2723 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
2724 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
2725 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
2726
2727 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
2728 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
2729 multiple-output package.
2730
2731 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
2732 @itemx -f @var{file}
2733 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
2734
2735 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
2736 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
2737
2738 @example
2739 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
2740 @end example
2741
2742 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
2743 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
2744 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
2745 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2746
2747 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
2748 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
2749 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
2750
2751 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
2752 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
2753 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
2754 @code{glibc}.
2755
2756 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2757 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2758 @cindex upgrading packages
2759 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
2760 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
2761 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
2762
2763 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
2764 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
2765 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2766 pull}).
2767
2768 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2769 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
2770 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
2771 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
2772 substring ``emacs'':
2773
2774 @example
2775 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
2776 @end example
2777
2778 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
2779 @itemx -m @var{file}
2780 @cindex profile declaration
2781 @cindex profile manifest
2782 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
2783 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
2784
2785 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
2786 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
2787 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
2788 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
2789 so on.
2790
2791 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
2792 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
2793 of packages:
2794
2795 @findex packages->manifest
2796 @example
2797 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
2798
2799 (packages->manifest
2800 (list emacs
2801 guile-2.0
2802 ;; Use a specific package output.
2803 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
2804 @end example
2805
2806 @findex specifications->manifest
2807 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
2808 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
2809 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
2810 instead provide regular package specifications and let
2811 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
2812 objects, like this:
2813
2814 @example
2815 (specifications->manifest
2816 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
2817 @end example
2818
2819 @item --roll-back
2820 @cindex rolling back
2821 @cindex undoing transactions
2822 @cindex transactions, undoing
2823 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
2824 the last transaction.
2825
2826 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
2827 before any other actions.
2828
2829 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
2830 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
2831 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
2832
2833 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
2834 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
2835 generations in a profile is always linear.
2836
2837 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
2838 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
2839 @cindex generations
2840 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
2841
2842 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
2843 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
2844 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
2845 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
2846 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
2847
2848 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
2849 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
2850 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
2851 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
2852
2853 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
2854 @cindex search paths
2855 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2856 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2857 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2858 of the installed packages.
2859
2860 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
2861 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2862 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2863 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2864 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
2865 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
2866 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2867
2868 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2869 shell:
2870
2871 @example
2872 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2873 @end example
2874
2875 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2876 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2877 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2878 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2879
2880 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2881 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2882
2883 @example
2884 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2885 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2886 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2887 @end example
2888
2889 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2890 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2891 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2892
2893
2894 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2895 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2896 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2897
2898 @cindex collisions, in a profile
2899 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
2900 @cindex profile collisions
2901 @item --allow-collisions
2902 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
2903
2904 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
2905 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
2906 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
2907
2908 @item --bootstrap
2909 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
2910 useful to distribution developers.
2911
2912 @end table
2913
2914 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
2915 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
2916 availability of packages:
2917
2918 @table @option
2919
2920 @item --search=@var{regexp}
2921 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
2922 @cindex searching for packages
2923 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
2924 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
2925 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
2926 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
2927 GNU recutils manual}).
2928
2929 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
2930 command, for instance:
2931
2932 @example
2933 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
2934 name: jemalloc
2935 version: 4.5.0
2936 relevance: 6
2937
2938 name: glibc
2939 version: 2.25
2940 relevance: 1
2941
2942 name: libgc
2943 version: 7.6.0
2944 relevance: 1
2945 @end example
2946
2947 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
2948 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
2949
2950 @example
2951 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
2952 name: elfutils
2953
2954 name: gmp
2955 @dots{}
2956 @end example
2957
2958 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
2959 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
2960 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
2961 the @command{guix search} alias):
2962
2963 @example
2964 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
2965 name: gnubg
2966 @dots{}
2967 @end example
2968
2969 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
2970 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
2971 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
2972 keyboards.
2973
2974 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
2975 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
2976 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
2977
2978 @example
2979 $ guix search crypto library | \
2980 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
2981 @end example
2982
2983 @noindent
2984 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
2985 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
2986
2987 @item --show=@var{package}
2988 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
2989 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
2990 recutils manual}).
2991
2992 @example
2993 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
2994 name: python
2995 version: 2.7.6
2996
2997 name: python
2998 version: 3.3.5
2999 @end example
3000
3001 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3002 specific version of it:
3003 @example
3004 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3005 name: python
3006 version: 3.4.3
3007 @end example
3008
3009
3010
3011 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3012 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3013 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3014 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3015 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3016
3017 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3018 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3019 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3020 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3021 the store.
3022
3023 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3024 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3025 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3026 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3027 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3028
3029 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3030 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3031 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3032
3033 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3034 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3035 @cindex generations
3036 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3037 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3038 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3039 shown.
3040
3041 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3042 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3043 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3044 location of this package in the store.
3045
3046 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3047 generations. Valid patterns include:
3048
3049 @itemize
3050 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3051 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
3052 the first one.
3053
3054 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3055 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3056
3057 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3058 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3059 a range must be smaller than its end.
3060
3061 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3062 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3063 second one.
3064
3065 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3066 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3067 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3068 that are up to 20 days old.
3069 @end itemize
3070
3071 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3072 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3073 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3074 one.
3075
3076 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3077 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3078 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3079 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3080 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3081
3082 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3083 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3084
3085 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3086 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3087
3088 @end table
3089
3090 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3091 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3092 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3093 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3094 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3095 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3096 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3097 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3098
3099 @node Substitutes
3100 @section Substitutes
3101
3102 @cindex substitutes
3103 @cindex pre-built binaries
3104 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3105 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3106 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3107 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3108 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3109
3110 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3111 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3112 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3113 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3114
3115 @menu
3116 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3117 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3118 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3119 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3120 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3121 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3122 @end menu
3123
3124 @node Official Substitute Server
3125 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3126
3127 @cindex hydra
3128 @cindex build farm
3129 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3130 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3131 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3132 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3133 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3134 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3135 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3136 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3137 option}).
3138
3139 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3140 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3141 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3142 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3143 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3144
3145 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3146 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3147 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3148 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3149 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3150 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3151 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3152 other substitute server.
3153
3154 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3155 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3156
3157 @cindex security
3158 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3159 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3160 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3161 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3162 mirror thereof, you
3163 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3164 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3165 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3166 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3167
3168 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3169 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3170 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3171 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3172 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3173 Then, you can run something like this:
3174
3175 @example
3176 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3177 @end example
3178
3179 @quotation Note
3180 Similarly, the @file{hydra.gnu.org.pub} file contains the public key
3181 of an independent build farm also run by the project, reachable at
3182 @indicateurl{https://mirror.hydra.gnu.org}.
3183 @end quotation
3184
3185 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3186 should change from something like:
3187
3188 @example
3189 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3190 The following derivations would be built:
3191 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3192 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3193 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3194 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3195 @dots{}
3196 @end example
3197
3198 @noindent
3199 to something like:
3200
3201 @example
3202 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3203 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3204 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3205 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3206 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3207 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3208 @dots{}
3209 @end example
3210
3211 @noindent
3212 This indicates that substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and
3213 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
3214
3215 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3216 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3217 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3218 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3219 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
3220 build}, and other command-line tools.
3221
3222 @node Substitute Authentication
3223 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3224
3225 @cindex digital signatures
3226 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3227 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3228 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3229
3230 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3231 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3232 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3233 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3234 with this option:
3235
3236 @example
3237 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3238 @end example
3239
3240 @noindent
3241 @cindex reproducible builds
3242 If the ACL contains only the key for @code{b.example.org}, and if
3243 @code{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3244 then Guix will download substitutes from @code{a.example.org} because it
3245 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3246 @code{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3247 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3248 below).
3249
3250 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3251 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3252 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3253 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3254 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3255 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
3256
3257 @node Proxy Settings
3258 @subsection Proxy Settings
3259
3260 @vindex http_proxy
3261 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
3262 The @code{http_proxy} environment
3263 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
3264 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
3265 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
3266 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
3267 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3268
3269 @node Substitution Failure
3270 @subsection Substitution Failure
3271
3272 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3273 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3274 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3275 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3276 etc.
3277
3278 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3279 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3280 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3281 @code{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3282 option @code{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @code{--fallback} was
3283 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3284 considered to have failed. However, if @code{--fallback} was given,
3285 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3286 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3287 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3288 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3289 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3290 @code{--fallback} was given.
3291
3292 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3293 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3294 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3295 by a server.
3296
3297 @node On Trusting Binaries
3298 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3299
3300 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3301 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3302 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3303 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3304 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3305 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3306 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3307 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3308 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3309 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3310
3311 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3312 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3313 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3314 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3315 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3316 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3317 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3318 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3319 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3320 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3321 @command{guix build --check}}).
3322
3323 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3324 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3325 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3326
3327 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3328 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3329
3330 @cindex multiple-output packages
3331 @cindex package outputs
3332 @cindex outputs
3333
3334 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3335 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3336 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3337 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3338 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3339 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3340 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3341 files.
3342
3343 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3344 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3345 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3346 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3347 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3348 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3349 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3350
3351 @example
3352 guix install glib
3353 @end example
3354
3355 @cindex documentation
3356 The command to install its documentation is:
3357
3358 @example
3359 guix install glib:doc
3360 @end example
3361
3362 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3363 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3364 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3365 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3366 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3367 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3368 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3369 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3370 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3371
3372 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3373 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3374 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3375 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3376 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3377 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3378 guix package}).
3379
3380
3381 @node Invoking guix gc
3382 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3383
3384 @cindex garbage collector
3385 @cindex disk space
3386 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3387 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3388 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3389 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3390 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3391
3392 @cindex GC roots
3393 @cindex garbage collector roots
3394 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3395 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3396 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3397 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3398 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3399 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3400 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3401 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3402
3403 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3404 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3405 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3406 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3407 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3408
3409 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3410 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3411 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3412
3413 @example
3414 guix gc -F 5G
3415 @end example
3416
3417 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
3418 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
3419 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
3420 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
3421 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
3422 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
3423 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
3424
3425 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
3426 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
3427 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
3428 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
3429 options are as follows:
3430
3431 @table @code
3432 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
3433 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
3434 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
3435 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
3436 specified.
3437
3438 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
3439 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
3440 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
3441 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
3442
3443 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
3444
3445 @item --free-space=@var{free}
3446 @itemx -F @var{free}
3447 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
3448 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
3449 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
3450
3451 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
3452 nothing and exit immediately.
3453
3454 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
3455 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
3456 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
3457 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
3458 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
3459
3460 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
3461 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
3462 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
3463
3464 @example
3465 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
3466 @end example
3467
3468 @item --delete
3469 @itemx -D
3470 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
3471 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
3472 they are still live.
3473
3474 @item --list-failures
3475 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
3476
3477 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
3478 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
3479 @option{--cache-failures}}).
3480
3481 @item --list-roots
3482 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
3483 roots.
3484
3485 @item --clear-failures
3486 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
3487
3488 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
3489 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
3490
3491 @item --list-dead
3492 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
3493 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
3494
3495 @item --list-live
3496 Show the list of live store files and directories.
3497
3498 @end table
3499
3500 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
3501
3502 @table @code
3503
3504 @item --references
3505 @itemx --referrers
3506 @cindex package dependencies
3507 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
3508 as arguments.
3509
3510 @item --requisites
3511 @itemx -R
3512 @cindex closure
3513 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
3514 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
3515 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
3516 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
3517
3518 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
3519 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
3520 the graph of references.
3521
3522 @item --derivers
3523 @cindex derivation
3524 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
3525 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3526
3527 For example, this command:
3528
3529 @example
3530 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
3531 @end example
3532
3533 @noindent
3534 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
3535 installed in your profile.
3536
3537 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
3538 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
3539 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
3540 @end table
3541
3542 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
3543 store and to control disk usage.
3544
3545 @table @option
3546
3547 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
3548 @cindex integrity, of the store
3549 @cindex integrity checking
3550 Verify the integrity of the store.
3551
3552 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
3553 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
3554
3555 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
3556 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
3557
3558 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
3559 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
3560 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
3561 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
3562 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
3563
3564 @cindex repairing the store
3565 @cindex corruption, recovering from
3566 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
3567 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
3568 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
3569 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
3570 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
3571 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
3572 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
3573
3574 @item --optimize
3575 @cindex deduplication
3576 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
3577 @dfn{deduplication}.
3578
3579 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
3580 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
3581 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
3582 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
3583 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
3584
3585 @end table
3586
3587 @node Invoking guix pull
3588 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
3589
3590 @cindex upgrading Guix
3591 @cindex updating Guix
3592 @cindex @command{guix pull}
3593 @cindex pull
3594 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
3595 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
3596 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
3597 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
3598 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
3599 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
3600 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized.
3601
3602 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
3603 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
3604 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
3605 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
3606 become available.
3607
3608 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
3609 effect is limited to the user who run @command{guix pull}. For
3610 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
3611 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
3612 versa.
3613
3614 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
3615 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
3616 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
3617 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
3618 (@pxref{Documentation}):
3619
3620 @example
3621 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
3622 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
3623 @end example
3624
3625 The @code{--list-generations} or @code{-l} option lists past generations
3626 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
3627
3628 @example
3629 $ guix pull -l
3630 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
3631 guix 65956ad
3632 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3633 branch: origin/master
3634 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
3635
3636 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
3637 guix e0cc7f6
3638 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3639 branch: origin/master
3640 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
3641 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
3642 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
3643 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
3644 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
3645
3646 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
3647 guix 844cc1c
3648 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3649 branch: origin/master
3650 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
3651 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
3652 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
3653 @end example
3654
3655 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
3656 describe the current status of Guix.
3657
3658 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works like any other profile
3659 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
3660 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
3661 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
3662
3663 @example
3664 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
3665 switched from generation 3 to 2
3666 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
3667 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3668 @end example
3669
3670 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
3671 but it supports the following options:
3672
3673 @table @code
3674 @item --url=@var{url}
3675 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
3676 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
3677 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
3678 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
3679 string), or @var{branch}.
3680
3681 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3682 @cindex configuration file for channels
3683 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
3684 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
3685 @option{--channels} option (see below).
3686
3687 @item --channels=@var{file}
3688 @itemx -C @var{file}
3689 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
3690 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm}. @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
3691 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
3692 information.
3693
3694 @item --news
3695 @itemx -N
3696 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous generation.
3697
3698 This is the same information as displayed upon @command{guix pull} completion,
3699 but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output of @command{guix pull
3700 -l} for the last generation (see below).
3701
3702 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3703 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3704 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
3705 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
3706 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
3707 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3708
3709 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
3710 current generation only.
3711
3712 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3713 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3714 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
3715
3716 @item --dry-run
3717 @itemx -n
3718 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
3719 substituted but do not actually do it.
3720
3721 @item --system=@var{system}
3722 @itemx -s @var{system}
3723 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3724 the system type of the build host.
3725
3726 @item --verbose
3727 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
3728
3729 @item --bootstrap
3730 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
3731 useful to Guix developers.
3732 @end table
3733
3734 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
3735 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
3736 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
3737 information.
3738
3739 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
3740 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
3741
3742 @node Channels
3743 @section Channels
3744
3745 @cindex channels
3746 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3747 @cindex configuration file for channels
3748 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
3749 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
3750 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
3751 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
3752 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
3753 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
3754 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
3755 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
3756 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used to
3757 @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
3758
3759 @subsection Using a Custom Guix Channel
3760
3761 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
3762 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
3763 suppose you want to update from your own copy of the Guix repository at
3764 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
3765 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
3766
3767 @lisp
3768 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use my own repo.
3769 (list (channel
3770 (name 'guix)
3771 (url "https://example.org/my-guix.git")
3772 (branch "super-hacks")))
3773 @end lisp
3774
3775 @noindent
3776 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
3777 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}.
3778
3779 @subsection Specifying Additional Channels
3780
3781 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
3782 @cindex personal packages (channels)
3783 @cindex channels, for personal packages
3784 You can also specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. Let's say you
3785 have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages that you think
3786 would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but would like to
3787 have these packages transparently available to you at the command line. You
3788 would first write modules containing those package definitions (@pxref{Package
3789 Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and then you and anyone else can
3790 use it as an additional channel to get packages from. Neat, no?
3791
3792 @c What follows stems from discussions at
3793 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
3794 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
3795 @quotation Warning
3796 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
3797 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
3798 of caution:
3799
3800 @itemize
3801 @item
3802 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
3803 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
3804 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
3805 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
3806 process.
3807
3808 @item
3809 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
3810 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
3811 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
3812 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
3813 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
3814 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
3815 either.
3816
3817 @item
3818 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
3819 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
3820 @end itemize
3821
3822 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
3823 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
3824 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
3825 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
3826 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
3827 @end quotation
3828
3829 To use a channel, write @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct
3830 @command{guix pull} to pull from it @emph{in addition} to the default Guix
3831 channel(s):
3832
3833 @vindex %default-channels
3834 @lisp
3835 ;; Add my personal packages to those Guix provides.
3836 (cons (channel
3837 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3838 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git"))
3839 %default-channels)
3840 @end lisp
3841
3842 @noindent
3843 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
3844 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
3845 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
3846 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
3847 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
3848 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
3849 modules:
3850
3851 @example
3852 $ guix pull --list-generations
3853 @dots{}
3854 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
3855 guix d894ab8
3856 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3857 branch: master
3858 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
3859 my-personal-packages dd3df5e
3860 repository URL: https://example.org/personal-packages.git
3861 branch: master
3862 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
3863 11 new packages: my-gimp, my-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
3864 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
3865 @end example
3866
3867 @noindent
3868 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
3869 both Guix and packages from the @code{my-personal-packages} channel. Among
3870 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{my-gimp} and
3871 @code{my-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
3872 @code{my-personal-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
3873
3874 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
3875 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
3876 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
3877 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
3878 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
3879 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
3880 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
3881 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
3882 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
3883 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3884
3885 @cindex dependencies, channels
3886 @cindex meta-data, channels
3887 @subsection Declaring Channel Dependencies
3888
3889 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
3890 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
3891 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
3892 the channel repository.
3893
3894 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
3895
3896 @lisp
3897 (channel
3898 (version 0)
3899 (dependencies
3900 (channel
3901 (name some-collection)
3902 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git"))
3903 (channel
3904 (name some-other-collection)
3905 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
3906 (branch "testing"))))
3907 @end lisp
3908
3909 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
3910 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
3911 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
3912 channels are available.
3913
3914 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
3915 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
3916 dependencies to a minimum.
3917
3918 @subsection Replicating Guix
3919
3920 @cindex pinning, channels
3921 @cindex replicating Guix
3922 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
3923 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
3924 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
3925 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
3926 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
3927
3928 @lisp
3929 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
3930 (list (channel
3931 (name 'guix)
3932 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
3933 (commit "d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300"))
3934 (channel
3935 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3936 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git")
3937 (branch "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
3938 @end lisp
3939
3940 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
3941 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
3942
3943 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
3944 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
3945 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
3946 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
3947 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
3948 package it defines.
3949
3950 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
3951 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
3952 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
3953 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
3954
3955 @node Inferiors
3956 @section Inferiors
3957
3958 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
3959 @quotation Note
3960 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
3961 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
3962 @end quotation
3963
3964 @cindex inferiors
3965 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
3966 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
3967 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
3968 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
3969 revisions in arbitrary ways.
3970
3971 @cindex inferior packages
3972 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
3973 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
3974 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
3975 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
3976 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
3977
3978 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
3979 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
3980 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
3981 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
3982 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
3983 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
3984 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
3985 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
3986 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
3987
3988 @lisp
3989 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
3990 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
3991
3992 (define channels
3993 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
3994 ;; extract guile-json.
3995 (list (channel
3996 (name 'guix)
3997 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
3998 (commit
3999 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4000
4001 (define inferior
4002 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4003 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4004
4005 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4006 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4007 (packages->manifest
4008 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4009 (specification->package "guile")))
4010 @end lisp
4011
4012 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4013 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4014 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4015
4016 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4017 inferior:
4018
4019 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4020 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4021 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4022 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4023 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4024
4025 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4026 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4027 @end deffn
4028
4029 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4030 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4031 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4032 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4033 the inferior could not be launched.
4034 @end deffn
4035
4036 @cindex inferior packages
4037 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4038 packages.
4039
4040 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4041 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4042 @end deffn
4043
4044 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4045 [@var{version}]
4046 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4047 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4048 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4049 @end deffn
4050
4051 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4052 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4053 @end deffn
4054
4055 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4056 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4057 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4058 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4059 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4060 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4061 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4062 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4063 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4064 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4065 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4066 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4067 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4068 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4069 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4070 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4071 these procedures.
4072 @end deffn
4073
4074 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4075 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4076 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4077 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4078 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4079 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4080 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4081 declaration, and so on.
4082
4083 @node Invoking guix describe
4084 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4085
4086 @cindex reproducibility
4087 @cindex replicating Guix
4088 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4089 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4090 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4091 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4092 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4093 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4094 command answers these questions.
4095
4096 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4097 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4098 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4099
4100 @example
4101 $ guix describe
4102 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4103 guix e0fa68c
4104 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4105 branch: master
4106 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4107 @end example
4108
4109 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4110 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4111 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4112 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4113 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4114 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4115 also to replicate it.
4116
4117 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4118 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4119
4120 @example
4121 $ guix describe -f channels
4122 (list (channel
4123 (name 'guix)
4124 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4125 (commit
4126 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")))
4127 @end example
4128
4129 @noindent
4130 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4131 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4132 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4133 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4134 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4135 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4136
4137 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4138 follows:
4139
4140 @table @code
4141 @item --format=@var{format}
4142 @itemx -f @var{format}
4143 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4144
4145 @table @code
4146 @item human
4147 produce human-readable output;
4148 @item channels
4149 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4150 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4151 guix pull});
4152 @item json
4153 @cindex JSON
4154 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4155 @item recutils
4156 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4157 @end table
4158
4159 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4160 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4161 Display information about @var{profile}.
4162 @end table
4163
4164 @node Invoking guix archive
4165 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4166
4167 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4168 @cindex archive
4169 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4170 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4171 a machine that runs Guix.
4172 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4173 to the store on another machine.
4174
4175 @quotation Note
4176 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4177 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4178 @end quotation
4179
4180 @cindex exporting store items
4181 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4182
4183 @example
4184 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4185 @end example
4186
4187 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4188 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4189 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4190 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4191 output of @code{emacs}:
4192
4193 @example
4194 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4195 @end example
4196
4197 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4198 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4199 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4200
4201 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4202 one would run:
4203
4204 @example
4205 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4206 @end example
4207
4208 @noindent
4209 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4210 to another like this:
4211
4212 @example
4213 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4214 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
4215 @end example
4216
4217 @noindent
4218 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4219 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4220 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
4221 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
4222 items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4223 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4224 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4225
4226 @cindex nar, archive format
4227 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4228 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
4229 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4230 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4231 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4232 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4233 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4234 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4235 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4236 deterministic.
4237
4238 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4239 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4240 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4241 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4242 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4243
4244 The main options are:
4245
4246 @table @code
4247 @item --export
4248 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
4249 resulting archive to the standard output.
4250
4251 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4252 @code{--recursive} is passed.
4253
4254 @item -r
4255 @itemx --recursive
4256 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
4257 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
4258 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
4259 of the exported store items.
4260
4261 @item --import
4262 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4263 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4264 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4265 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
4266
4267 @item --missing
4268 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4269 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4270 the store.
4271
4272 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4273 @cindex signing, archives
4274 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4275 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
4276 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
4277 generate the key pair.
4278
4279 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4280 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4281 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4282 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4283 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4284 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4285 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4286 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4287 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4288
4289 @item --authorize
4290 @cindex authorizing, archives
4291 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4292 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4293 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4294
4295 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4296 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4297 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4298 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4299 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4300 (SPKI)}.
4301
4302 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4303 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4304 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4305 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4306 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4307
4308 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4309 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4310
4311 @example
4312 $ wget -O - \
4313 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4314 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4315 @end example
4316
4317 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4318 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4319 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4320 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4321 unsafe.
4322
4323 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4324 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
4325
4326 @end table
4327
4328
4329 @c *********************************************************************
4330 @node Development
4331 @chapter Development
4332
4333 @cindex software development
4334 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
4335 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
4336 this chapter is about.
4337
4338 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
4339 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
4340 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
4341 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
4342 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
4343
4344 @menu
4345 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4346 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
4347 @end menu
4348
4349 @node Invoking guix environment
4350 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4351
4352 @cindex reproducible build environments
4353 @cindex development environments
4354 @cindex @command{guix environment}
4355 @cindex environment, package build environment
4356 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4357 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4358 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4359 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
4360 environment to use them.
4361
4362 The general syntax is:
4363
4364 @example
4365 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4366 @end example
4367
4368 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4369 GNU@tie{}Guile:
4370
4371 @example
4372 guix environment guile
4373 @end example
4374
4375 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4376 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
4377 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4378 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4379 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4380 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
4381 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4382 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4383 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4384 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4385 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4386 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4387 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4388 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
4389 details on Bash start-up files.}.
4390
4391 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4392 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4393 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
4394 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
4395 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4396 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4397
4398 @example
4399 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4400 then
4401 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4402 fi
4403 @end example
4404
4405 @noindent
4406 ...@: or to browse the profile:
4407
4408 @example
4409 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
4410 @end example
4411
4412 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4413 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4414 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4415 and Emacs are available:
4416
4417 @example
4418 guix environment guile emacs
4419 @end example
4420
4421 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4422 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4423 command from the rest of the arguments:
4424
4425 @example
4426 guix environment guile -- make -j4
4427 @end example
4428
4429 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4430 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4431 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4432 NumPy:
4433
4434 @example
4435 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
4436 @end example
4437
4438 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4439 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4440 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4441 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4442 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4443 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4444 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4445 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4446 additionally includes Git and strace:
4447
4448 @example
4449 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
4450 @end example
4451
4452 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4453 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4454 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
4455 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4456 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4457 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4458 working directory are mounted:
4459
4460 @example
4461 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4462 @end example
4463
4464 @quotation Note
4465 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
4466 @end quotation
4467
4468 The available options are summarized below.
4469
4470 @table @code
4471 @item --root=@var{file}
4472 @itemx -r @var{file}
4473 @cindex persistent environment
4474 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
4475 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
4476 register it as a garbage collector root.
4477
4478 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
4479 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
4480
4481 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
4482 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
4483 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
4484 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
4485 gc}, for more on GC roots.
4486
4487 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4488 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4489 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
4490 @var{expr} evaluates to.
4491
4492 For example, running:
4493
4494 @example
4495 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
4496 @end example
4497
4498 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
4499 PETSc package.
4500
4501 Running:
4502
4503 @example
4504 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
4505 @end example
4506
4507 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
4508
4509 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
4510 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
4511
4512 @example
4513 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
4514 @end example
4515
4516 @item --load=@var{file}
4517 @itemx -l @var{file}
4518 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
4519 within @var{file} evaluates to.
4520
4521 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
4522 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4523
4524 @example
4525 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
4526 @end example
4527
4528 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4529 @itemx -m @var{file}
4530 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
4531 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
4532
4533 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
4534 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
4535 manifest files.
4536
4537 @item --ad-hoc
4538 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
4539 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
4540 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
4541 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
4542
4543 For instance, the command:
4544
4545 @example
4546 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
4547 @end example
4548
4549 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
4550 available.
4551
4552 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
4553 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
4554 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
4555 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4556
4557 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
4558 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
4559 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
4560 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
4561 that will be added to the environment directly.
4562
4563 @item --pure
4564 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
4565 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below.) This has the effect of
4566 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
4567
4568 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
4569 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
4570 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
4571 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
4572 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
4573 several times.
4574
4575 @example
4576 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
4577 -- mpirun @dots{}
4578 @end example
4579
4580 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
4581 variables defined are @code{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
4582 with @code{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@code{HOME},
4583 @code{USER}, etc.)
4584
4585 @item --search-paths
4586 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
4587 environment.
4588
4589 @item --system=@var{system}
4590 @itemx -s @var{system}
4591 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
4592
4593 @item --container
4594 @itemx -C
4595 @cindex container
4596 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
4597 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
4598 Additionally, unless overridden with @code{--user}, a dummy home
4599 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
4600 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
4601
4602 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
4603 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
4604 @option{--user} is passed (see below.)
4605
4606 @item --network
4607 @itemx -N
4608 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
4609 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
4610 device.
4611
4612 @item --link-profile
4613 @itemx -P
4614 For containers, link the environment profile to
4615 @file{~/.guix-profile} within the container. This is equivalent to
4616 running the command @command{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile}
4617 within the container. Linking will fail and abort the environment if
4618 the directory already exists, which will certainly be the case if
4619 @command{guix environment} was invoked in the user's home directory.
4620
4621 Certain packages are configured to look in
4622 @code{~/.guix-profile} for configuration files and data;@footnote{For
4623 example, the @code{fontconfig} package inspects
4624 @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts} for additional fonts.}
4625 @code{--link-profile} allows these programs to behave as expected within
4626 the environment.
4627
4628 @item --user=@var{user}
4629 @itemx -u @var{user}
4630 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
4631 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
4632 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
4633 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
4634 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
4635 need not exist on the system.
4636
4637 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @code{--share} and
4638 @code{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
4639 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
4640 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
4641
4642 @example
4643 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
4644 cd $HOME/wd
4645 guix environment --container --user=foo \
4646 --expose=$HOME/test \
4647 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
4648 @end example
4649
4650 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
4651 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
4652 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
4653
4654 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4655 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
4656 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
4657 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4658 point in the container.
4659
4660 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4661 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
4662 directory:
4663
4664 @example
4665 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4666 @end example
4667
4668 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4669 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
4670 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
4671 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4672 point in the container.
4673
4674 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4675 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
4676 @file{/exchange} directory:
4677
4678 @example
4679 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4680 @end example
4681 @end table
4682
4683 @command{guix environment}
4684 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
4685 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
4686 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4687
4688 @node Invoking guix pack
4689 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
4690
4691 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
4692 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
4693 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
4694 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
4695
4696 @quotation Note
4697 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
4698 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
4699 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
4700 @end quotation
4701
4702 @cindex pack
4703 @cindex bundle
4704 @cindex application bundle
4705 @cindex software bundle
4706 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
4707 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
4708 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
4709 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
4710 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
4711 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
4712 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
4713 that you pretend to be shipping.
4714
4715 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
4716 their dependencies, you can run:
4717
4718 @example
4719 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
4720 @dots{}
4721 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
4722 @end example
4723
4724 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
4725 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
4726 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
4727 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
4728 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
4729 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
4730
4731 Users of this pack would have to run
4732 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
4733 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
4734 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
4735
4736 @example
4737 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
4738 @end example
4739
4740 @noindent
4741 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
4742
4743 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
4744 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
4745 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
4746 that case, you will want to use the @code{--relocatable} option (see
4747 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
4748 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
4749 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
4750 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
4751
4752 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
4753 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
4754 the following command:
4755
4756 @example
4757 guix pack -f docker guile emacs geiser
4758 @end example
4759
4760 @noindent
4761 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
4762 command. See the
4763 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
4764 documentation} for more information.
4765
4766 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
4767 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
4768 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
4769 command:
4770
4771 @example
4772 guix pack -f squashfs guile emacs geiser
4773 @end example
4774
4775 @noindent
4776 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
4777 directly be used as a file system container image with the
4778 @uref{https://singularity.lbl.gov, Singularity container execution
4779 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
4780 @command{singularity exec}.
4781
4782 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
4783
4784 @table @code
4785 @item --format=@var{format}
4786 @itemx -f @var{format}
4787 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
4788
4789 The available formats are:
4790
4791 @table @code
4792 @item tarball
4793 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
4794 specified binaries and symlinks.
4795
4796 @item docker
4797 This produces a tarball that follows the
4798 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
4799 Docker Image Specification}.
4800
4801 @item squashfs
4802 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
4803 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
4804 procfs.
4805 @end table
4806
4807 @cindex relocatable binaries
4808 @item --relocatable
4809 @itemx -R
4810 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
4811 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
4812
4813 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
4814 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
4815 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
4816 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
4817 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to PRoot
4818 if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially work anywhere---see below
4819 for the implications.
4820
4821 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
4822
4823 @example
4824 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
4825 @end example
4826
4827 @noindent
4828 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
4829 home directory as a normal user, run:
4830
4831 @example
4832 tar xf pack.tar.gz
4833 ./mybin/sh
4834 @end example
4835
4836 @noindent
4837 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
4838 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
4839 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
4840 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
4841 software on a non-Guix machine.
4842
4843 @quotation Note
4844 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
4845 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
4846 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
4847 turn it off.
4848
4849 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
4850 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
4851 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to PRoot if user
4852 namespaces are not supported.
4853
4854 The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program provides the necessary
4855 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
4856 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
4857 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
4858 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
4859 @end quotation
4860
4861 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4862 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4863 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4864
4865 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
4866 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @code{--expression} in
4867 @command{guix build}}).
4868
4869 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4870 @itemx -m @var{file}
4871 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
4872 code in @var{file}.
4873
4874 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
4875 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
4876 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
4877 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
4878 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
4879 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
4880 but not both.
4881
4882 @item --system=@var{system}
4883 @itemx -s @var{system}
4884 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4885 the system type of the build host.
4886
4887 @item --target=@var{triplet}
4888 @cindex cross-compilation
4889 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4890 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
4891 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
4892
4893 @item --compression=@var{tool}
4894 @itemx -C @var{tool}
4895 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
4896 @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no compression.
4897
4898 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
4899 @itemx -S @var{spec}
4900 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
4901 appear several times.
4902
4903 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
4904 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
4905 symlink target.
4906
4907 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
4908 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
4909
4910 @item --save-provenance
4911 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
4912 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
4913 (@pxref{Channels}).
4914
4915 Provenance information is saved in the
4916 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
4917 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
4918 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
4919 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
4920
4921 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
4922 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
4923 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
4924 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
4925 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
4926
4927 @item --localstatedir
4928 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
4929 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
4930 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
4931 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
4932 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
4933
4934 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
4935 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
4936 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
4937 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
4938 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
4939
4940 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
4941 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
4942
4943 @item --bootstrap
4944 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
4945 useful to Guix developers.
4946 @end table
4947
4948 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
4949 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
4950 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4951
4952
4953 @c *********************************************************************
4954 @node Programming Interface
4955 @chapter Programming Interface
4956
4957 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
4958 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
4959 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
4960 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
4961 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
4962 turned into concrete build actions.
4963
4964 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
4965 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
4966 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
4967 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
4968 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
4969
4970 @cindex derivation
4971 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
4972 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
4973 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
4974 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
4975 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
4976 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
4977 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
4978
4979 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
4980 package definitions.
4981
4982 @menu
4983 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
4984 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
4985 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
4986 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
4987 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
4988 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
4989 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
4990 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
4991 @end menu
4992
4993 @node Package Modules
4994 @section Package Modules
4995
4996 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
4997 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
4998 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
4999 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
5000 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
5001 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
5002 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
5003 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
5004 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
5005 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
5006 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5007
5008 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
5009 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
5010 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
5011 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
5012 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
5013 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
5014
5015 @cindex customization, of packages
5016 @cindex package module search path
5017 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
5018 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
5019 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
5020 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
5021 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
5022 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
5023 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
5024 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
5025
5026 @enumerate
5027 @item
5028 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
5029 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
5030 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5031 environment variable described below.
5032
5033 @item
5034 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
5035 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
5036 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
5037 channels.
5038 @end enumerate
5039
5040 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
5041
5042 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5043 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
5044 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
5045 over the own modules of the distribution.
5046 @end defvr
5047
5048 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
5049 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
5050 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
5051 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
5052 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
5053 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
5054
5055 @node Defining Packages
5056 @section Defining Packages
5057
5058 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
5059 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
5060 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
5061 package looks like this:
5062
5063 @example
5064 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
5065 #:use-module (guix packages)
5066 #:use-module (guix download)
5067 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
5068 #:use-module (guix licenses)
5069 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
5070
5071 (define-public hello
5072 (package
5073 (name "hello")
5074 (version "2.10")
5075 (source (origin
5076 (method url-fetch)
5077 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
5078 ".tar.gz"))
5079 (sha256
5080 (base32
5081 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
5082 (build-system gnu-build-system)
5083 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
5084 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
5085 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
5086 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
5087 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
5088 (license gpl3+)))
5089 @end example
5090
5091 @noindent
5092 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
5093 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
5094 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
5095 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5096 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
5097 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
5098 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
5099
5100 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
5101 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
5102 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
5103
5104 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
5105 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
5106 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
5107 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
5108 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5109
5110 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
5111
5112 @itemize
5113 @item
5114 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
5115 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
5116 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
5117 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
5118
5119 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
5120 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
5121
5122 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
5123 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
5124 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
5125 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
5126 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
5127 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
5128
5129 @cindex patches
5130 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
5131 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
5132 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
5133
5134 @item
5135 @cindex GNU Build System
5136 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
5137 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
5138 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
5139 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
5140 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
5141
5142 @item
5143 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
5144 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
5145 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
5146 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
5147
5148 @cindex quote
5149 @cindex quoting
5150 @findex '
5151 @findex quote
5152 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
5153 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
5154 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
5155 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
5156 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
5157 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5158 Manual}).
5159
5160 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
5161 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
5162 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
5163 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
5164 Reference Manual}).
5165
5166 @item
5167 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
5168 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
5169 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
5170 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
5171
5172 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
5173 @findex `
5174 @findex quasiquote
5175 @cindex comma (unquote)
5176 @findex ,
5177 @findex unquote
5178 @findex ,@@
5179 @findex unquote-splicing
5180 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
5181 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
5182 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
5183 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
5184 Reference Manual}).
5185
5186 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
5187 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
5188 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
5189
5190 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
5191 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
5192 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
5193 @end itemize
5194
5195 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
5196
5197 Once a package definition is in place, the
5198 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
5199 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
5200 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
5201 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
5202 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
5203 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
5204 more information on how to test package definitions, and
5205 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
5206 for style conformance.
5207 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5208 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
5209 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
5210 in a ``channel''.
5211
5212 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
5213 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
5214 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
5215
5216 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
5217 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
5218 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
5219 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
5220 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
5221
5222 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
5223 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
5224 (@pxref{Derivations}).
5225
5226 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
5227 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
5228 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
5229 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
5230 (@pxref{The Store}).
5231 @end deffn
5232
5233 @noindent
5234 @cindex cross-compilation
5235 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
5236 package for some other system:
5237
5238 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
5239 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
5240 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
5241 @var{system} to @var{target}.
5242
5243 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
5244 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
5245 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5246 @end deffn
5247
5248 @cindex package transformations
5249 @cindex input rewriting
5250 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
5251 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
5252 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
5253 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
5254
5255 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
5256 [@var{rewrite-name}]
5257 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
5258 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
5259 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
5260 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
5261 is the replacement.
5262
5263 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
5264 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
5265 @end deffn
5266
5267 @noindent
5268 Consider this example:
5269
5270 @example
5271 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5272 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
5273 ;; recursively.
5274 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
5275
5276 (define git-with-libressl
5277 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
5278 @end example
5279
5280 @noindent
5281 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
5282 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
5283 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
5284 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
5285 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
5286
5287 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
5288 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
5289
5290 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements}
5291 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given @var{replacements} to
5292 all the package graph (excluding implicit inputs). @var{replacements} is a list of
5293 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as @code{"gcc"} or
5294 @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching package and returns a
5295 replacement for that package.
5296 @end deffn
5297
5298 The example above could be rewritten this way:
5299
5300 @example
5301 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5302 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
5303 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
5304 @end example
5305
5306 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
5307 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
5308 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
5309
5310 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
5311 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
5312 graph.
5313
5314 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
5315 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
5316 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
5317 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
5318 @end deffn
5319
5320 @menu
5321 * package Reference:: The package data type.
5322 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
5323 @end menu
5324
5325
5326 @node package Reference
5327 @subsection @code{package} Reference
5328
5329 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
5330 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5331
5332 @deftp {Data Type} package
5333 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
5334
5335 @table @asis
5336 @item @code{name}
5337 The name of the package, as a string.
5338
5339 @item @code{version}
5340 The version of the package, as a string.
5341
5342 @item @code{source}
5343 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
5344 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
5345 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
5346 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
5347 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5348 @code{local-file}}).
5349
5350 @item @code{build-system}
5351 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
5352 Systems}).
5353
5354 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5355 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
5356 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
5357
5358 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5359 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5360 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5361 @cindex inputs, of packages
5362 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
5363 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
5364 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
5365 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
5366 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
5367 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
5368 inputs:
5369
5370 @example
5371 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
5372 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
5373 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
5374 @end example
5375
5376 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
5377 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
5378 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
5379 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
5380 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
5381 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
5382
5383 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
5384 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
5385 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
5386 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
5387
5388 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
5389 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
5390 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
5391 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
5392 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
5393 propagated inputs.)
5394
5395 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
5396 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
5397 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
5398
5399 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
5400 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
5401 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
5402 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
5403 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
5404 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
5405
5406 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
5407 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
5408 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
5409
5410 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5411 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5412 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
5413 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
5414
5415 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
5416 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
5417 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
5418 for details.
5419
5420 @item @code{synopsis}
5421 A one-line description of the package.
5422
5423 @item @code{description}
5424 A more elaborate description of the package.
5425
5426 @item @code{license}
5427 @cindex license, of packages
5428 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
5429 or a list of such values.
5430
5431 @item @code{home-page}
5432 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
5433
5434 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
5435 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
5436 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
5437
5438 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
5439 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
5440
5441 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
5442 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
5443 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
5444 automatically corrected.
5445 @end table
5446 @end deftp
5447
5448 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
5449 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
5450 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
5451
5452 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
5453 cross-compiling:
5454
5455 @example
5456 (package
5457 (name "guile")
5458 ;; ...
5459
5460 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
5461 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
5462 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
5463 `(("self" ,this-package))
5464 '())))
5465 @end example
5466
5467 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
5468 @end deffn
5469
5470 @node origin Reference
5471 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
5472
5473 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
5474 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5475
5476 @deftp {Data Type} origin
5477 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
5478
5479 @table @asis
5480 @item @code{uri}
5481 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
5482 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
5483 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
5484 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
5485
5486 @item @code{method}
5487 A procedure that handles the URI.
5488
5489 Examples include:
5490
5491 @table @asis
5492 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
5493 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
5494 @code{uri} field;
5495
5496 @vindex git-fetch
5497 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
5498 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
5499 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
5500 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
5501
5502 @example
5503 (git-reference
5504 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
5505 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
5506 @end example
5507 @end table
5508
5509 @item @code{sha256}
5510 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
5511 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
5512 base-32 string.
5513
5514 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
5515 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
5516 guix hash}).
5517
5518 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
5519 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
5520 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
5521 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
5522 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
5523 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
5524
5525 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
5526 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5527 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
5528
5529 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
5530 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
5531 @code{%current-target-system}.
5532
5533 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
5534 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
5535 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
5536 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
5537
5538 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
5539 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
5540 command.
5541
5542 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
5543 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
5544 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
5545 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
5546
5547 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
5548 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
5549 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
5550
5551 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
5552 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
5553 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
5554 @end table
5555 @end deftp
5556
5557
5558 @node Build Systems
5559 @section Build Systems
5560
5561 @cindex build system
5562 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
5563 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
5564 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
5565 dependencies of that build procedure.
5566
5567 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
5568 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
5569 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
5570
5571 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
5572 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
5573 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
5574 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
5575 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
5576 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
5577 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
5578
5579 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
5580 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
5581 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
5582 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
5583 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
5584 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
5585 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
5586
5587 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
5588 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
5589 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
5590
5591 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
5592 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
5593 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
5594 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
5595
5596 @cindex build phases
5597 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
5598 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
5599 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
5600 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
5601 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
5602 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
5603
5604 @table @code
5605 @item unpack
5606 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
5607 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
5608 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
5609
5610 @item patch-source-shebangs
5611 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
5612 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
5613 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
5614
5615 @item configure
5616 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
5617 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
5618 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
5619
5620 @item build
5621 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
5622 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
5623 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
5624
5625 @item check
5626 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
5627 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
5628 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
5629 check -j}.
5630
5631 @item install
5632 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
5633
5634 @item patch-shebangs
5635 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
5636
5637 @item strip
5638 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
5639 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
5640 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
5641 @end table
5642
5643 @vindex %standard-phases
5644 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
5645 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
5646 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
5647 procedure implements the actual phase.
5648
5649 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
5650 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
5651
5652 @example
5653 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
5654 @end example
5655
5656 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
5657 @code{configure} phase.
5658
5659 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
5660 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
5661 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
5662 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
5663 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
5664 have to mention them.
5665 @end defvr
5666
5667 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
5668 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
5669 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
5670 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
5671 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
5672
5673 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
5674 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
5675 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
5676 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
5677
5678 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
5679 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
5680 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
5681 parameters, respectively.
5682
5683 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
5684 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
5685 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
5686 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
5687 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
5688
5689 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
5690 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
5691 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
5692 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
5693 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
5694 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
5695 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
5696
5697 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
5698 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
5699 ``jar'' task will be run.
5700
5701 @end defvr
5702
5703 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
5704 @cindex Android distribution
5705 @cindex Android NDK build system
5706 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
5707 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
5708 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
5709
5710 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
5711 (header) files to the subdirectory "include" of the "out" output and
5712 their libraries to the subdirectory "lib" of the "out" output.
5713
5714 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
5715 has no conflicting files.
5716
5717 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
5718 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
5719
5720 @end defvr
5721
5722 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
5723 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
5724 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
5725
5726 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
5727 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
5728 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
5729 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
5730
5731 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
5732 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
5733 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
5734 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
5735 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
5736 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
5737
5738 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
5739 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
5740 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
5741
5742 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
5743 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
5744 the @code{cl-} prefix.
5745
5746 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
5747 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
5748 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
5749 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
5750
5751 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
5752 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
5753 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
5754 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
5755 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
5756 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
5757
5758 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
5759 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
5760 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
5761 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
5762 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
5763 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
5764 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
5765 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
5766
5767 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
5768 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
5769 be used to specify the name of the system.
5770
5771 @end defvr
5772
5773 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
5774 @cindex Rust programming language
5775 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
5776 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
5777 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
5778 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
5779
5780 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system replaces dependencies
5781 specified in the @file{Carto.toml} file with inputs to the Guix package.
5782 The @code{install} phase installs the binaries, and it also installs the
5783 source code and @file{Cargo.toml} file.
5784 @end defvr
5785
5786 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
5787 @cindex simple Clojure build system
5788 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
5789 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
5790 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
5791 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
5792 yet.
5793
5794 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
5795 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
5796 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
5797
5798 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
5799 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
5800 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
5801 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
5802 Other parameters are documented below.
5803
5804 This build system is an extension of @var{ant-build-system}, but with the
5805 following phases changed:
5806
5807 @table @code
5808
5809 @item build
5810 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
5811 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
5812 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
5813 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
5814 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
5815 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
5816 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
5817 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
5818
5819 @item check
5820 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
5821 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
5822 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
5823 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
5824 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
5825 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
5826
5827 @item install
5828 This phase installs all jars built previously.
5829 @end table
5830
5831 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
5832
5833 @table @code
5834
5835 @item install-doc
5836 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
5837 @var{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
5838 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
5839 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
5840 @end table
5841 @end defvr
5842
5843 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
5844 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
5845 implements the build procedure for packages using the
5846 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
5847
5848 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
5849 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
5850 parameter.
5851
5852 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
5853 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
5854 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
5855 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
5856 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
5857 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
5858 @end defvr
5859
5860 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
5861 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
5862 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
5863 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
5864 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
5865 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
5866 system.
5867
5868 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
5869 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
5870 parameter.
5871
5872 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
5873 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
5874 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
5875
5876 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
5877 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
5878 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
5879
5880 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
5881 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
5882 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
5883 @code{dune}.
5884 @end defvr
5885
5886 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
5887 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
5888 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
5889 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
5890 Go build mechanisms}.
5891
5892 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
5893 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
5894 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
5895 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
5896 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
5897 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
5898 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
5899 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
5900 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
5901 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
5902
5903 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
5904 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
5905 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
5906 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
5907 @end defvr
5908
5909 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
5910 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
5911 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
5912
5913 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
5914 @var{gnu-build-system}:
5915
5916 @table @code
5917 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
5918 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
5919 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
5920 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
5921 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
5922 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
5923 environment variables.
5924
5925 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
5926 process by listing their names in the
5927 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
5928 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
5929 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
5930 GLib and GTK+.
5931
5932 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
5933 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
5934 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
5935 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
5936 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
5937 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
5938 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
5939 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
5940 @end table
5941
5942 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
5943 @end defvr
5944
5945 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
5946 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
5947 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
5948 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
5949 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
5950 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
5951 installs documentation.
5952
5953 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the @code{--target}
5954 option of @command{guild compile}.
5955
5956 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
5957 their @code{native-inputs} field.
5958 @end defvr
5959
5960 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
5961 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
5962 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
5963
5964 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
5965 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
5966 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
5967 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
5968 output.
5969
5970 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
5971 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
5972 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
5973 @end defvr
5974
5975 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
5976 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
5977 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
5978 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
5979 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
5980 try some of them.
5981
5982 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
5983 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
5984 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
5985 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
5986 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
5987 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
5988 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
5989 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
5990 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
5991
5992 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
5993 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
5994 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
5995 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
5996
5997 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
5998 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
5999 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
6000
6001 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
6002 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
6003 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
6004 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
6005 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
6006 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
6007 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
6008
6009 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
6010 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
6011 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
6012 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
6013 libraries cannot be found and we use @code{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
6014 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
6015 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
6016 @end defvr
6017
6018 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
6019 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
6020 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
6021 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
6022 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
6023
6024 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
6025 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
6026 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
6027
6028 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
6029 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
6030 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
6031 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
6032 interpreter version.
6033
6034 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
6035 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
6036 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
6037 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools} parameter to @code{#f}.
6038 @end defvr
6039
6040 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
6041 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
6042 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
6043 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
6044 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
6045 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
6046 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
6047 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
6048 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
6049 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
6050 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
6051 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
6052
6053 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
6054 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
6055 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
6056
6057 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
6058 @end defvr
6059
6060 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
6061 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
6062 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
6063 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
6064 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
6065 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
6066 are run after installation using the R function
6067 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
6068 @end defvr
6069
6070 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
6071 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
6072 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
6073 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
6074 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
6075 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
6076 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
6077 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
6078
6079 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
6080 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
6081 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6082 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
6083 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
6084 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6085 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
6086 @end defvr
6087
6088 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
6089 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
6090 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
6091 build system sets the @code{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
6092 files in the inputs.
6093
6094 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
6095 different engine and format can be specified with the
6096 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
6097 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
6098 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
6099 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
6100 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
6101 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
6102
6103 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
6104 install the built files under the texmf tree.
6105 @end defvr
6106
6107 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
6108 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
6109 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
6110 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
6111
6112 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
6113 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
6114 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
6115 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
6116 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
6117 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
6118 a traditional source release tarball.
6119
6120 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6121 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
6122 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
6123 @end defvr
6124
6125 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
6126 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
6127 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
6128 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
6129 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
6130 script.
6131
6132 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
6133 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
6134 @code{#:python} parameter.
6135 @end defvr
6136
6137 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
6138 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
6139 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
6140 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
6141 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
6142 the package.
6143
6144 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
6145 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The version of Python used to run SCons
6146 can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package with the
6147 @code{#:scons} parameter.
6148 @end defvr
6149
6150 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
6151 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
6152 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
6153 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
6154 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
6155 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
6156 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
6157 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
6158 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
6159 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
6160 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
6161 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
6162 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
6163 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
6164
6165 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
6166 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
6167 @end defvr
6168
6169 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
6170 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
6171 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
6172 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
6173 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
6174
6175 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
6176 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
6177 @end defvr
6178
6179 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
6180 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
6181 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
6182 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6183
6184 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
6185 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
6186 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
6187 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
6188 package is installed in its own directory under
6189 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
6190 @end defvr
6191
6192 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
6193 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
6194 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
6195 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
6196 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
6197 locations in the output directory.
6198 @end defvr
6199
6200 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
6201 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
6202 implements the build procedure for packages that use
6203 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
6204
6205 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
6206 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
6207 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
6208 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
6209 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
6210
6211 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6212 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
6213
6214 @table @code
6215
6216 @item configure
6217 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
6218 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @code{--build-type} is always set to
6219 @code{plain} unless something else is specified in @code{#:build-type}.
6220
6221 @item build
6222 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
6223 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
6224
6225 @item check
6226 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
6227 which is @code{"test"} by default.
6228
6229 @item install
6230 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
6231 @end table
6232
6233 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
6234
6235 @table @code
6236
6237 @item fix-runpath
6238 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
6239 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
6240 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
6241 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
6242 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
6243 required for the program to run.
6244
6245 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6246 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6247 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6248
6249 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6250 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6251 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6252 @end table
6253 @end defvr
6254
6255 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
6256 @var{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
6257
6258 @cindex build phases
6259 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6260 following phases changed:
6261
6262 @table @code
6263
6264 @item configure
6265 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
6266 can be used to build the external kernel module.
6267
6268 @item build
6269 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
6270 kernel module.
6271
6272 @item install
6273 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
6274 kernel module.
6275 @end table
6276
6277 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
6278 the module (in the "arguments" form of a package using the
6279 linux-module-build-system, use the key #:linux to specify it).
6280 @end defvr
6281
6282 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
6283 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
6284 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
6285 and does not have a notion of build phases.
6286
6287 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
6288 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
6289
6290 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
6291 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
6292 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
6293 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
6294 @end defvr
6295
6296 @node The Store
6297 @section The Store
6298
6299 @cindex store
6300 @cindex store items
6301 @cindex store paths
6302
6303 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
6304 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
6305 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
6306 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
6307 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
6308 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
6309 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
6310 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
6311 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
6312
6313 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
6314 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
6315 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
6316 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
6317
6318 @quotation Note
6319 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
6320 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
6321 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
6322
6323 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
6324 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
6325 accidental modifications.
6326 @end quotation
6327
6328 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
6329 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
6330 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
6331 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
6332 @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
6333
6334 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
6335 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
6336 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
6337 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
6338 supported URI schemes are:
6339
6340 @table @code
6341 @item file
6342 @itemx unix
6343 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
6344 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
6345 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
6346
6347 @item guix
6348 @cindex daemon, remote access
6349 @cindex remote access to the daemon
6350 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
6351 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
6352 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
6353 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
6354 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
6355
6356 @example
6357 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
6358 @end example
6359
6360 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
6361 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
6362 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
6363
6364 The @code{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
6365 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
6366 @code{--listen}}).
6367
6368 @item ssh
6369 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
6370 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over
6371 SSH@footnote{This feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}).}.
6372 A typical URL might look like this:
6373
6374 @example
6375 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
6376 @end example
6377
6378 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
6379 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
6380 @end table
6381
6382 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
6383
6384 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
6385 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
6386 @quotation Note
6387 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
6388 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
6389 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
6390 @end quotation
6391 @end defvr
6392
6393 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
6394 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
6395 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
6396 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
6397 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
6398
6399 @var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
6400 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
6401 @end deffn
6402
6403 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
6404 Close the connection to @var{server}.
6405 @end deffn
6406
6407 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
6408 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
6409 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
6410 @end defvr
6411
6412 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
6413 argument.
6414
6415 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
6416 @cindex invalid store items
6417 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
6418 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
6419 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
6420 build.)
6421
6422 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
6423 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
6424 @end deffn
6425
6426 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6427 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
6428 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
6429 resulting store path.
6430 @end deffn
6431
6432 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
6433 Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
6434 derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
6435 Return @code{#t} on success.
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
6439 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
6440 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
6441 Store Monad}).
6442
6443 @c FIXME
6444 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
6445
6446 @node Derivations
6447 @section Derivations
6448
6449 @cindex derivations
6450 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
6451 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
6452 following pieces of information:
6453
6454 @itemize
6455 @item
6456 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
6457 directory in the store, but may produce more.
6458
6459 @item
6460 @cindex build-time dependencies
6461 @cindex dependencies, build-time
6462 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
6463 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
6464 etc.)
6465
6466 @item
6467 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
6468
6469 @item
6470 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
6471 to be passed.
6472
6473 @item
6474 A list of environment variables to be defined.
6475
6476 @end itemize
6477
6478 @cindex derivation path
6479 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
6480 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
6481 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
6482 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
6483 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
6484 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
6485 Store}).
6486
6487 @cindex fixed-output derivations
6488 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
6489 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
6490 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
6491 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
6492 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
6493 method and tools being used.
6494
6495 @cindex references
6496 @cindex run-time dependencies
6497 @cindex dependencies, run-time
6498 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
6499 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
6500 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
6501 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
6502 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
6503 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
6504
6505 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
6506 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
6507 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
6508 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
6509
6510 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
6511 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6512 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
6513 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
6514 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6515 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
6516 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
6517 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
6518 @code{<derivation>} object.
6519
6520 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
6521 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
6522 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
6523 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
6524 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
6525 containing this output.
6526
6527 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
6528 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
6529 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
6530 a simple text format.
6531
6532 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
6533 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
6534 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
6535 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
6536
6537 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
6538 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
6539 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
6540 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
6541 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
6542 derivations that download files.
6543
6544 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
6545 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
6546 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
6547 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
6548
6549 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
6550 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
6551 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
6552 host CPU instruction set.
6553
6554 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
6555 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @noindent
6559 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
6560 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
6561 to a Bash executable in the store:
6562
6563 @lisp
6564 (use-modules (guix utils)
6565 (guix store)
6566 (guix derivations))
6567
6568 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
6569 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
6570 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
6571 (derivation store "foo"
6572 bash `("-e" ,builder)
6573 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
6574 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
6575 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
6576 @end lisp
6577
6578 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
6579 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
6580 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
6581 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6582 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
6583
6584 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
6585 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
6586 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
6587 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
6588
6589 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
6590 @var{name} @var{exp} @
6591 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
6592 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6593 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
6594 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
6595 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6596 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
6597 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
6598 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
6599 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
6600 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
6601 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
6602 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
6603 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
6604 gnu-build-system))}.
6605
6606 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
6607 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
6608 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
6609 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
6610 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
6611 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
6612 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
6613
6614 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
6615 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
6616 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
6617
6618 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
6619 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
6620 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
6621 @var{substitutable?}.
6622 @end deffn
6623
6624 @noindent
6625 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
6626 containing one file:
6627
6628 @lisp
6629 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
6630 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
6631 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
6632 (lambda (p)
6633 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
6634 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
6635
6636 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
6637 @end lisp
6638
6639
6640 @node The Store Monad
6641 @section The Store Monad
6642
6643 @cindex monad
6644
6645 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
6646 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
6647 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
6648 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
6649
6650 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
6651 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
6652 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
6653 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
6654 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
6655
6656 @cindex monadic values
6657 @cindex monadic functions
6658 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
6659 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
6660 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
6661 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
6662 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
6663 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
6664 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
6665 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
6666 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
6667
6668 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
6669
6670 @example
6671 (define (sh-symlink store)
6672 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
6673 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
6674 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
6675 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
6676 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
6677 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
6678 @end example
6679
6680 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
6681 as a monadic function:
6682
6683 @example
6684 (define (sh-symlink)
6685 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
6686 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
6687 (gexp->derivation "sh"
6688 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
6689 #$output))))
6690 @end example
6691
6692 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
6693 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
6694 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
6695 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
6696 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
6697
6698 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
6699 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
6700 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
6701
6702 @example
6703 (define (sh-symlink)
6704 (gexp->derivation "sh"
6705 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
6706 #$output)))
6707 @end example
6708
6709 @c See
6710 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
6711 @c for the funny quote.
6712 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
6713 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
6714 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
6715 @code{run-with-store}:
6716
6717 @example
6718 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
6719 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
6720 @end example
6721
6722 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
6723 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
6724 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
6725 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
6726
6727 @example
6728 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
6729 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
6730 @end example
6731
6732 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
6733 automatically run through the store:
6734
6735 @example
6736 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
6737 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
6738 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
6739 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
6740 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
6741 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
6742 scheme@@(guile-user)>
6743 @end example
6744
6745 @noindent
6746 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
6747 @code{store-monad} REPL.
6748
6749 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
6750 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
6751
6752 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
6753 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
6754 in @var{monad}.
6755 @end deffn
6756
6757 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
6758 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
6762 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
6763 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
6764 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
6765 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
6766 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
6767 in this example:
6768
6769 @example
6770 (run-with-state
6771 (with-monad %state-monad
6772 (>>= (return 1)
6773 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
6774 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
6775 'some-state)
6776
6777 @result{} 4
6778 @result{} some-state
6779 @end example
6780 @end deffn
6781
6782 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
6783 @var{body} ...
6784 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
6785 @var{body} ...
6786 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
6787 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
6788 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
6789 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
6790 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
6791 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
6792 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
6793 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
6794 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
6795 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
6796
6797 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
6798 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6799 @end deffn
6800
6801 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
6802 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
6803 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
6804 sequence must be a monadic expression.
6805
6806 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
6807 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
6808 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
6809 @end deffn
6810
6811 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
6812 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
6813 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
6814 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
6815 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
6816 @end deffn
6817
6818 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
6819 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
6820 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
6821 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
6822 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @cindex state monad
6826 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
6827 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
6828 monadic procedure calls.
6829
6830 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
6831 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
6832 the state that is threaded.
6833
6834 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
6835 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
6836 increments the current state value:
6837
6838 @example
6839 (define (square x)
6840 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
6841 (mbegin %state-monad
6842 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
6843 (return (* x x)))))
6844
6845 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
6846 @result{} (0 1 4)
6847 @result{} 3
6848 @end example
6849
6850 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
6851 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
6852 @end defvr
6853
6854 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
6855 Return the current state as a monadic value.
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
6859 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
6860 monadic value.
6861 @end deffn
6862
6863 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
6864 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
6865 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
6866 @end deffn
6867
6868 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
6869 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
6870 The state is assumed to be a list.
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
6874 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
6875 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
6876 @end deffn
6877
6878 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
6879 store)} module, is as follows.
6880
6881 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
6882 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
6883
6884 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
6885 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
6886 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
6887 @end defvr
6888
6889 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
6890 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
6891 open store connection.
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6895 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
6896 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
6897 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
6898 @end deffn
6899
6900 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
6901 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
6902 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
6903 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
6904 @end deffn
6905
6906 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
6907 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
6908 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
6909 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
6910 @var{name} is omitted.
6911
6912 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
6913 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
6914 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
6915
6916 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
6917 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
6918 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
6919 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
6920
6921 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
6922
6923 @example
6924 (run-with-store (open-connection)
6925 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
6926 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
6927 (return (list a b))))
6928
6929 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
6930 @end example
6931
6932 @end deffn
6933
6934 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
6935 monadic procedures:
6936
6937 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
6938 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
6939 [#:output "out"]
6940 Return as a monadic
6941 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
6942 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
6943 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
6944 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
6945 @end deffn
6946
6947 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
6948 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
6949 @var{target} [@var{system}]
6950 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
6951 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6952 @end deffn
6953
6954
6955 @node G-Expressions
6956 @section G-Expressions
6957
6958 @cindex G-expression
6959 @cindex build code quoting
6960 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
6961 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
6962 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
6963 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
6964 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
6965
6966 @cindex strata of code
6967 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
6968 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
6969 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
6970 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
6971 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
6972 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
6973 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
6974 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
6975 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
6976 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
6977 @command{make}, etc.
6978
6979 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
6980 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
6981 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
6982 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
6983 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
6984 expressions.
6985
6986 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
6987 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
6988 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
6989 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
6990 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
6991 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
6992 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
6993 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
6994
6995 @itemize
6996 @item
6997 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
6998 processes.
6999
7000 @item
7001 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
7002 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
7003 introduced.
7004
7005 @item
7006 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
7007 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
7008 processes that use them.
7009 @end itemize
7010
7011 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7012 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
7013 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
7014 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
7015 such that these objects can also be inserted
7016 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
7017 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
7018 add files to the store and to refer to them in
7019 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
7020 below.)
7021
7022 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
7023
7024 @example
7025 (define build-exp
7026 #~(begin
7027 (mkdir #$output)
7028 (chdir #$output)
7029 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
7030 "list-files")))
7031 @end example
7032
7033 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
7034 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
7035 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
7036
7037 @example
7038 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
7039 @end example
7040
7041 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
7042 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
7043 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
7044 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
7045 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
7046 output of the derivation.
7047
7048 @cindex cross compilation
7049 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
7050 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
7051 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
7052 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
7053 native package build:
7054
7055 @example
7056 (gexp->derivation "vi"
7057 #~(begin
7058 (mkdir #$output)
7059 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
7060 "-s"
7061 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
7062 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
7063 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
7064 @end example
7065
7066 @noindent
7067 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
7068 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
7069 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
7070
7071 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
7072 @findex with-imported-modules
7073 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
7074 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
7075 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
7076 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
7077
7078 @example
7079 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
7080 #~(begin
7081 (use-modules (guix build utils))
7082 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
7083 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
7084 #~(begin
7085 #$build
7086 (display "success!\n")
7087 #t)))
7088 @end example
7089
7090 @noindent
7091 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
7092 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
7093 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
7094
7095 @cindex module closure
7096 @findex source-module-closure
7097 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
7098 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
7099 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
7100 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
7101 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
7102 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
7103
7104 @example
7105 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
7106
7107 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
7108 '((guix build utils)
7109 (gnu build vm)))
7110 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
7111 #~(begin
7112 (use-modules (guix build utils)
7113 (gnu build vm))
7114 @dots{})))
7115 @end example
7116
7117 @cindex extensions, for gexps
7118 @findex with-extensions
7119 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
7120 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
7121 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
7122 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
7123
7124 @example
7125 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
7126
7127 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
7128 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
7129 #~(begin
7130 (use-modules (json))
7131 @dots{})))
7132 @end example
7133
7134 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
7135
7136 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
7137 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
7138 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
7139 or more of the following forms:
7140
7141 @table @code
7142 @item #$@var{obj}
7143 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
7144 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
7145 supported types, for example a package or a
7146 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
7147 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
7148
7149 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
7150 objects are substituted similarly.
7151
7152 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
7153 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
7154
7155 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
7156
7157 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
7158 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
7159 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
7160 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
7161 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
7162
7163 @item #+@var{obj}
7164 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
7165 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
7166 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
7167 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
7168 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
7169
7170 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
7171 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
7172 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
7173 output when @var{output} is omitted.
7174
7175 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7176
7177 @item #$@@@var{lst}
7178 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
7179 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
7180 containing list.
7181
7182 @item #+@@@var{lst}
7183 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
7184 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
7185 @var{lst}.
7186
7187 @end table
7188
7189 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
7190 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
7191 @end deffn
7192
7193 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
7194 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
7195 in their execution environment.
7196
7197 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
7198 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
7199 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
7200
7201 @example
7202 `((guix build utils)
7203 (guix gcrypt)
7204 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
7205 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
7206 @end example
7207
7208 @noindent
7209 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
7210 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
7211
7212 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
7213 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
7214 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
7215 @end deffn
7216
7217 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
7218 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
7219 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
7220 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
7221 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
7222
7223 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
7224 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
7225 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
7226 @var{body}@dots{}.
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
7230 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
7231 @end deffn
7232
7233 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
7234 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
7235 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
7236 information about monads.)
7237
7238 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
7239 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
7240 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7241 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7242 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
7243 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
7244 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7245 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7246 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
7247 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
7248 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
7249 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
7250 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7251 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
7252 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
7253 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
7254 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
7255 to by @var{exp}.
7256
7257 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
7258 Its meaning is to
7259 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
7260 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
7261 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
7262 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
7263 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
7264
7265 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
7266 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
7267
7268 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
7269 applicable.
7270
7271 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
7272 following forms:
7273
7274 @example
7275 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
7276 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
7277 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
7278 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
7279 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
7280 @end example
7281
7282 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
7283 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
7284 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
7285 text format.
7286
7287 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
7288 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
7289 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
7290 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
7291 referenced by the outputs.
7292
7293 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
7294 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
7295
7296 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
7297 @end deffn
7298
7299 @cindex file-like objects
7300 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
7301 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
7302 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
7303 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
7304
7305 @example
7306 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
7307 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
7308 @end example
7309
7310 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
7311 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
7312 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
7313 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
7314 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
7315 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
7316 content is directly passed as a string.
7317
7318 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7319 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
7320 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
7321 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
7322 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
7323 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
7324
7325 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
7326 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
7327 permission bits are kept.
7328
7329 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7330 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7331 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7332 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7333
7334 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
7335 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
7336 @end deffn
7337
7338 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
7339 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
7340 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
7341
7342 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
7343 @end deffn
7344
7345 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
7346 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
7347 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
7348 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
7349 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7350
7351 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
7352 @end deffn
7353
7354 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
7355 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path]
7356 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
7357 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
7358 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
7359
7360 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
7361 command:
7362
7363 @example
7364 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
7365
7366 (gexp->script "list-files"
7367 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
7368 "ls"))
7369 @end example
7370
7371 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
7372 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
7373 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
7374
7375 @example
7376 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
7377 !#
7378 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
7379 @end example
7380 @end deffn
7381
7382 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7383 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
7384 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
7385 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
7386 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
7387
7388 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
7389 @end deffn
7390
7391 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7392 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7393 [#:splice? #f] @
7394 [#:guile (default-guile)]
7395 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
7396 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
7397 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
7398
7399 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
7400 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
7401 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
7402 @var{module-path}.
7403
7404 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
7405 or a subset thereof.
7406 @end deffn
7407
7408 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} [#:splice? #f]
7409 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
7410 @var{exp}.
7411
7412 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
7413 @end deffn
7414
7415 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7416 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
7417 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
7418 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
7419 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
7420 references to all these.
7421
7422 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
7423 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
7424 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
7425 like this:
7426
7427 @example
7428 (define (profile.sh)
7429 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
7430 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
7431 (text-file* "profile.sh"
7432 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
7433 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
7434 @end example
7435
7436 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
7437 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
7438 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
7439 @end deffn
7440
7441 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7442 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
7443 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
7444 as in:
7445
7446 @example
7447 (mixed-text-file "profile"
7448 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
7449 @end example
7450
7451 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
7455 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
7456 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
7457 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
7458 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
7459
7460 @example
7461 (file-union "etc"
7462 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
7463 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
7464 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
7465 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
7466 @end example
7467
7468 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
7469 @end deffn
7470
7471 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
7472 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
7473 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
7474
7475 @example
7476 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
7477 @end example
7478
7479 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
7480 @end deffn
7481
7482 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
7483 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
7484 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
7485 @var{suffix} is a string.
7486
7487 As an example, consider this gexp:
7488
7489 @example
7490 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7491 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
7492 "/bin/uname")))
7493 @end example
7494
7495 The same effect could be achieved with:
7496
7497 @example
7498 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7499 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
7500 "/bin/uname")))
7501 @end example
7502
7503 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
7504 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
7505 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
7506 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
7507 @end deffn
7508
7509
7510 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
7511 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
7512 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
7513 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
7514
7515 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7516 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
7517 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
7518 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
7519 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
7520
7521 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
7522 [#:target #f]
7523 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
7524 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
7525 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
7526 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
7527 @end deffn
7528
7529 @node Invoking guix repl
7530 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
7531
7532 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop
7533 The @command{guix repl} command spawns a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop}
7534 (REPL) for interactive programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
7535 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
7536 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
7537 dependencies are available in the search path. You can use it this way:
7538
7539 @example
7540 $ guix repl
7541 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
7542 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
7543 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
7544 @end example
7545
7546 @cindex inferiors
7547 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
7548 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
7549 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
7550 of Guix.
7551
7552 The available options are as follows:
7553
7554 @table @code
7555 @item --type=@var{type}
7556 @itemx -t @var{type}
7557 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
7558
7559 @table @code
7560 @item guile
7561 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
7562 @item machine
7563 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
7564 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
7565 @end table
7566
7567 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
7568 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
7569 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
7570 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
7571
7572 @table @code
7573 @item --listen=tcp:37146
7574 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
7575
7576 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
7577 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
7578 @end table
7579 @end table
7580
7581 @c *********************************************************************
7582 @node Utilities
7583 @chapter Utilities
7584
7585 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
7586 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
7587 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
7588 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
7589
7590 @menu
7591 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
7592 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
7593 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
7594 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
7595 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
7596 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
7597 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
7598 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
7599 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
7600 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
7601 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
7602 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
7603 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
7604 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
7605 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
7606 @end menu
7607
7608 @node Invoking guix build
7609 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
7610
7611 @cindex package building
7612 @cindex @command{guix build}
7613 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
7614 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
7615 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
7616 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
7617 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
7618
7619 The general syntax is:
7620
7621 @example
7622 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
7623 @end example
7624
7625 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
7626 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
7627 resulting directories:
7628
7629 @example
7630 guix build emacs guile
7631 @end example
7632
7633 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
7634
7635 @example
7636 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
7637 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
7638 @end example
7639
7640 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
7641 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
7642 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
7643 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
7644 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
7645 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7646
7647 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
7648 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
7649 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
7650 needed.
7651
7652 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
7653 described in the subsections below.
7654
7655 @menu
7656 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
7657 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
7658 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
7659 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
7660 @end menu
7661
7662 @node Common Build Options
7663 @subsection Common Build Options
7664
7665 A number of options that control the build process are common to
7666 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
7667 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
7668 following:
7669
7670 @table @code
7671
7672 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
7673 @itemx -L @var{directory}
7674 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
7675 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7676
7677 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
7678 the command-line tools.
7679
7680 @item --keep-failed
7681 @itemx -K
7682 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
7683 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
7684 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
7685 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
7686 build issues.
7687
7688 This option has no effect when connecting to a remote daemon with a
7689 @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The Store, the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}
7690 variable}).
7691
7692 @item --keep-going
7693 @itemx -k
7694 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
7695 all the builds have either completed or failed.
7696
7697 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
7698 derivations has failed.
7699
7700 @item --dry-run
7701 @itemx -n
7702 Do not build the derivations.
7703
7704 @anchor{fallback-option}
7705 @item --fallback
7706 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
7707 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
7708
7709 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
7710 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
7711 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
7712 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
7713 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
7714
7715 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
7716 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
7717 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7718
7719 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
7720 disabled.
7721
7722 @item --no-substitutes
7723 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
7724 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
7725 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7726
7727 @item --no-grafts
7728 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
7729 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
7730 information on grafts.
7731
7732 @item --rounds=@var{n}
7733 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
7734 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
7735
7736 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
7737 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
7738 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
7739 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
7740
7741 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
7742 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
7743 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
7744 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
7745 the two results.
7746
7747 @item --no-build-hook
7748 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
7749 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
7750 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
7751
7752 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
7753 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
7754 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
7755
7756 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
7757 guix-daemon, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
7758
7759 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
7760 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
7761 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
7762
7763 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
7764 guix-daemon, @code{--timeout}}).
7765
7766 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
7767 @c most programs honor it.
7768 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
7769 @cindex build logs, verbosity
7770 @item -v @var{level}
7771 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
7772 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
7773 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
7774 output on standard error.
7775
7776 @item --cores=@var{n}
7777 @itemx -c @var{n}
7778 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
7779 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
7780
7781 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
7782 @itemx -M @var{n}
7783 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
7784 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
7785 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
7786
7787 @item --debug=@var{level}
7788 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
7789 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
7790 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
7791
7792 @end table
7793
7794 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
7795 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
7796 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
7797 derivations)} module.
7798
7799 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
7800 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
7801 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
7802
7803 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
7804 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
7805 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
7806 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
7807 below:
7808
7809 @example
7810 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
7811 @end example
7812
7813 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
7814 the parsed command-line options.
7815 @end defvr
7816
7817
7818 @node Package Transformation Options
7819 @subsection Package Transformation Options
7820
7821 @cindex package variants
7822 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
7823 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
7824 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
7825 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
7826 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
7827 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
7828 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7829
7830 @table @code
7831
7832 @item --with-source=@var{source}
7833 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
7834 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
7835 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
7836 its version number.
7837 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
7838 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
7839
7840 When @var{package} is omitted,
7841 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
7842 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
7843 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
7844 package is @code{guile}.
7845
7846 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
7847 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
7848
7849 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
7850 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
7851 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
7852 the @code{ed} package:
7853
7854 @example
7855 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
7856 @end example
7857
7858 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
7859 candidates:
7860
7861 @example
7862 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
7863 @end example
7864
7865 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
7866
7867 @example
7868 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
7869 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
7870 @end example
7871
7872 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
7873 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
7874 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
7875 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
7876 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
7877
7878 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
7879 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
7880 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
7881
7882 @example
7883 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
7884 @end example
7885
7886 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
7887 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
7888 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
7889
7890 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
7891 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
7892
7893 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
7894 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
7895 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
7896 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
7897 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
7898 information on grafts.
7899
7900 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
7901 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
7902 they currently refer to:
7903
7904 @example
7905 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
7906 @end example
7907
7908 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
7909 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
7910 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
7911 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
7912 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
7913 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
7914 care!
7915
7916 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
7917 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
7918 @cindex latest commit, building
7919 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
7920 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
7921 recursively.
7922
7923 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
7924 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
7925
7926 @example
7927 guix build python-numpy \
7928 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
7929 @end example
7930
7931 This option can also be combined with @code{--with-branch} or
7932 @code{--with-commit} (see below).
7933
7934 @cindex continuous integration
7935 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
7936 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
7937 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
7938 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
7939 integration (CI).
7940
7941 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
7942 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
7943 in a while to save disk space.
7944
7945 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
7946 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
7947 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
7948 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
7949 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
7950 @code{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
7951
7952 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
7953 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
7954 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
7955 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
7956
7957 @example
7958 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
7959 @end example
7960
7961 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
7962 This is similar to @code{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
7963 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
7964 Git commit SHA1 identifier.
7965 @end table
7966
7967 @node Additional Build Options
7968 @subsection Additional Build Options
7969
7970 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
7971 build}.
7972
7973 @table @code
7974
7975 @item --quiet
7976 @itemx -q
7977 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
7978 @code{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
7979 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
7980
7981 @item --file=@var{file}
7982 @itemx -f @var{file}
7983 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
7984 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
7985
7986 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
7987 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
7988
7989 @example
7990 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
7991 @end example
7992
7993 @item --expression=@var{expr}
7994 @itemx -e @var{expr}
7995 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
7996
7997 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
7998 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
7999 version 1.8 of Guile.
8000
8001 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
8002 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
8003 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8004
8005 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
8006 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
8007 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
8008
8009 @item --source
8010 @itemx -S
8011 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
8012 themselves.
8013
8014 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
8015 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
8016 source tarball.
8017
8018 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
8019 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
8020 Packages}).
8021
8022 @item --sources
8023 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
8024 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
8025 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
8026 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
8027 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
8028 optional argument values:
8029
8030 @table @code
8031 @item package
8032 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
8033 as the @code{--source} option.
8034
8035 @item all
8036 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
8037 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
8038
8039 @example
8040 $ guix build --sources tzdata
8041 The following derivations will be built:
8042 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
8043 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8044 @end example
8045
8046 @item transitive
8047 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
8048 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
8049 prefetch package source for later offline building.
8050
8051 @example
8052 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
8053 The following derivations will be built:
8054 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8055 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
8056 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
8057 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
8058 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
8059 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
8060 @dots{}
8061 @end example
8062
8063 @end table
8064
8065 @item --system=@var{system}
8066 @itemx -s @var{system}
8067 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
8068 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
8069 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
8070 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
8071
8072 @quotation Note
8073 The @code{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
8074 be confused with cross-compilation. See @code{--target} below for
8075 information on cross-compilation.
8076 @end quotation
8077
8078 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
8079 different personalities. For instance, passing
8080 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
8081 @code{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows you
8082 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
8083
8084 @quotation Note
8085 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
8086 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
8087 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
8088 @end quotation
8089
8090 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
8091 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
8092 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
8093 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
8094
8095 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
8096 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
8097 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
8098
8099 @item --target=@var{triplet}
8100 @cindex cross-compilation
8101 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
8102 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
8103 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
8104
8105 @anchor{build-check}
8106 @item --check
8107 @cindex determinism, checking
8108 @cindex reproducibility, checking
8109 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
8110 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
8111 identical.
8112
8113 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
8114 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
8115 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
8116 background information and tools.
8117
8118 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
8119 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
8120 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
8121
8122 @item --repair
8123 @cindex repairing store items
8124 @cindex corruption, recovering from
8125 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
8126 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
8127
8128 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
8129
8130 @item --derivations
8131 @itemx -d
8132 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
8133 packages.
8134
8135 @item --root=@var{file}
8136 @itemx -r @var{file}
8137 @cindex GC roots, adding
8138 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
8139 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
8140 collector root.
8141
8142 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
8143 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
8144 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
8145 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
8146 more on GC roots.
8147
8148 @item --log-file
8149 @cindex build logs, access
8150 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
8151 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
8152 missing.
8153
8154 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
8155 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
8156
8157 @example
8158 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
8159 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
8160 guix build --log-file guile
8161 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
8162 @end example
8163
8164 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
8165 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
8166 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
8167
8168 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
8169 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
8170
8171 @example
8172 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
8173 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
8174 @end example
8175
8176 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
8177 @end table
8178
8179 @node Debugging Build Failures
8180 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
8181
8182 @cindex build failures, debugging
8183 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
8184 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
8185 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
8186 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
8187 build daemon uses.
8188
8189 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
8190 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
8191 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
8192 @code{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--keep-failed}}).
8193
8194 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
8195 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
8196 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
8197 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
8198 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
8199
8200 @example
8201 $ guix build foo -K
8202 @dots{} @i{build fails}
8203 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8204 $ source ./environment-variables
8205 $ cd foo-1.2
8206 @end example
8207
8208 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
8209 troubleshoot your build process.
8210
8211 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
8212 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
8213 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
8214 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
8215 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
8216
8217 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
8218 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
8219
8220 @example
8221 $ guix build -K foo
8222 @dots{}
8223 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8224 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
8225 [env]# source ./environment-variables
8226 [env]# cd foo-1.2
8227 @end example
8228
8229 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
8230 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
8231 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
8232 the container, which would may find handy while debugging. The
8233 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
8234 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
8235 info on grafts).
8236
8237 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
8238 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
8239
8240 @example
8241 [env]# rm /bin/sh
8242 @end example
8243
8244 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
8245 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
8246
8247 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
8248 can run:
8249
8250 @example
8251 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
8252 @end example
8253
8254 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
8255 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
8256 similar to the one the daemon uses.
8257
8258
8259 @node Invoking guix edit
8260 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
8261
8262 @cindex @command{guix edit}
8263 @cindex package definition, editing
8264 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
8265 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
8266 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
8267 For instance:
8268
8269 @example
8270 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
8271 @end example
8272
8273 @noindent
8274 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
8275 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
8276 and that of Vim.
8277
8278 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
8279 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
8280 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
8281 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
8282 for packages currently in the store.
8283
8284
8285 @node Invoking guix download
8286 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
8287
8288 @cindex @command{guix download}
8289 @cindex downloading package sources
8290 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
8291 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
8292 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
8293 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
8294 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
8295 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
8296
8297 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
8298 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
8299 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
8300 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
8301 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
8302 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
8303
8304 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
8305 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
8306 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
8307 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
8308 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
8309 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
8310 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
8311
8312 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
8313 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
8314 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
8315 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
8316
8317 The following options are available:
8318
8319 @table @code
8320 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8321 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8322 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
8323 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
8324
8325 @item --no-check-certificate
8326 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
8327
8328 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
8329 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
8330 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
8331
8332 @item --output=@var{file}
8333 @itemx -o @var{file}
8334 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
8335 store.
8336 @end table
8337
8338 @node Invoking guix hash
8339 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
8340
8341 @cindex @command{guix hash}
8342 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
8343 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
8344 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
8345 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8346
8347 The general syntax is:
8348
8349 @example
8350 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
8351 @end example
8352
8353 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
8354 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
8355 following options:
8356
8357 @table @code
8358
8359 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8360 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8361 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
8362
8363 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
8364 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
8365
8366 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
8367 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
8368 in the definitions of packages.
8369
8370 @item --recursive
8371 @itemx -r
8372 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
8373
8374 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
8375 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
8376 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
8377 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
8378 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
8379 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
8380 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
8381 @c it exists.
8382
8383 @item --exclude-vcs
8384 @itemx -x
8385 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
8386 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
8387
8388 @vindex git-fetch
8389 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
8390 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
8391 Reference}):
8392
8393 @example
8394 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
8395 $ cd foo
8396 $ guix hash -rx .
8397 @end example
8398 @end table
8399
8400 @node Invoking guix import
8401 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
8402
8403 @cindex importing packages
8404 @cindex package import
8405 @cindex package conversion
8406 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
8407 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
8408 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
8409 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
8410 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
8411 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
8412 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8413
8414 The general syntax is:
8415
8416 @example
8417 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
8418 @end example
8419
8420 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
8421 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
8422 options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
8423 ``importers'' are:
8424
8425 @table @code
8426 @item gnu
8427 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
8428 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
8429 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
8430
8431 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
8432 license needs to be figured out manually.
8433
8434 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
8435 GNU@tie{}Hello:
8436
8437 @example
8438 guix import gnu hello
8439 @end example
8440
8441 Specific command-line options are:
8442
8443 @table @code
8444 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
8445 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
8446 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
8447 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
8448 @end table
8449
8450 @item pypi
8451 @cindex pypi
8452 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
8453 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
8454 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
8455 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
8456 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
8457 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
8458
8459 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
8460 package:
8461
8462 @example
8463 guix import pypi itsdangerous
8464 @end example
8465
8466 @table @code
8467 @item --recursive
8468 @itemx -r
8469 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8470 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8471 in Guix.
8472 @end table
8473
8474 @item gem
8475 @cindex gem
8476 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
8477 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
8478 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
8479 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
8480 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
8481 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
8482 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
8483 as an exercise to the packager.
8484
8485 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
8486
8487 @example
8488 guix import gem rails
8489 @end example
8490
8491 @table @code
8492 @item --recursive
8493 @itemx -r
8494 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8495 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8496 in Guix.
8497 @end table
8498
8499 @item cpan
8500 @cindex CPAN
8501 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
8502 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
8503 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
8504 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
8505 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
8506 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
8507 list of dependencies.
8508
8509 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
8510 Perl module:
8511
8512 @example
8513 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
8514 @end example
8515
8516 @item cran
8517 @cindex CRAN
8518 @cindex Bioconductor
8519 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
8520 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
8521 statistical and graphical environment}.
8522
8523 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
8524
8525 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
8526 R package:
8527
8528 @example
8529 guix import cran Cairo
8530 @end example
8531
8532 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
8533 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
8534 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
8535
8536 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
8537 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
8538 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
8539 genomic data in bioinformatics.
8540
8541 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
8542 published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
8543
8544 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
8545 R package:
8546
8547 @example
8548 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
8549 @end example
8550
8551 @item texlive
8552 @cindex TeX Live
8553 @cindex CTAN
8554 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
8555 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
8556 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
8557
8558 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
8559 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
8560 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
8561 versioned archives.
8562
8563 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
8564 TeX package:
8565
8566 @example
8567 guix import texlive fontspec
8568 @end example
8569
8570 When @code{--archive=DIRECTORY} is added, the source code is downloaded
8571 not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the @file{texmf-dist/source}
8572 tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from the specified sibling
8573 directory under the same root.
8574
8575 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
8576 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
8577 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
8578
8579 @example
8580 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
8581 @end example
8582
8583 @item json
8584 @cindex JSON, import
8585 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
8586 example package definition in JSON format:
8587
8588 @example
8589 @{
8590 "name": "hello",
8591 "version": "2.10",
8592 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
8593 "build-system": "gnu",
8594 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
8595 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
8596 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
8597 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
8598 "native-inputs": ["gcc@@6"]
8599 @}
8600 @end example
8601
8602 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
8603 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
8604 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
8605 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
8606
8607 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
8608 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
8609
8610 @example
8611 @{
8612 @dots{}
8613 "source": @{
8614 "method": "url-fetch",
8615 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
8616 "sha256": @{
8617 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
8618 @}
8619 @}
8620 @dots{}
8621 @}
8622 @end example
8623
8624 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
8625 and outputs a package expression:
8626
8627 @example
8628 guix import json hello.json
8629 @end example
8630
8631 @item nix
8632 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
8633 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
8634 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
8635 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
8636 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
8637 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
8638 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
8639 package definition.
8640
8641 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
8642 by their canonical upstream variant.
8643
8644 Usually, you will first need to do:
8645
8646 @example
8647 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
8648 @end example
8649
8650 @noindent
8651 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
8652
8653 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
8654 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
8655 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
8656
8657 @example
8658 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
8659 @end example
8660
8661 @item hackage
8662 @cindex hackage
8663 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
8664 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
8665 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
8666 dependencies.
8667
8668 Specific command-line options are:
8669
8670 @table @code
8671 @item --stdin
8672 @itemx -s
8673 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
8674 @item --no-test-dependencies
8675 @itemx -t
8676 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
8677 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
8678 @itemx -e @var{alist}
8679 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
8680 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
8681 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
8682 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
8683 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
8684 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
8685 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
8686 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
8687 @item --recursive
8688 @itemx -r
8689 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8690 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8691 in Guix.
8692 @end table
8693
8694 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
8695 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
8696 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
8697
8698 @example
8699 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
8700 @end example
8701
8702 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
8703 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
8704
8705 @example
8706 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
8707 @end example
8708
8709 @item stackage
8710 @cindex stackage
8711 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
8712 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
8713 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
8714 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
8715 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
8716 GHC compiler used by Guix.
8717
8718 Specific command-line options are:
8719
8720 @table @code
8721 @item --no-test-dependencies
8722 @itemx -t
8723 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
8724 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
8725 @itemx -l @var{version}
8726 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
8727 release is used.
8728 @item --recursive
8729 @itemx -r
8730 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8731 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8732 in Guix.
8733 @end table
8734
8735 The command below imports metadata for the @code{HTTP} Haskell package
8736 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
8737
8738 @example
8739 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
8740 @end example
8741
8742 @item elpa
8743 @cindex elpa
8744 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
8745 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8746
8747 Specific command-line options are:
8748
8749 @table @code
8750 @item --archive=@var{repo}
8751 @itemx -a @var{repo}
8752 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
8753 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
8754 are:
8755 @itemize -
8756 @item
8757 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
8758 identifier. This is the default.
8759
8760 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
8761 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
8762 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
8763 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
8764 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8765
8766 @item
8767 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
8768 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
8769
8770 @item
8771 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
8772 identifier.
8773 @end itemize
8774
8775 @item --recursive
8776 @itemx -r
8777 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8778 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8779 in Guix.
8780 @end table
8781
8782 @item crate
8783 @cindex crate
8784 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
8785 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}.
8786
8787 @item opam
8788 @cindex OPAM
8789 @cindex OCaml
8790 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
8791 repository used by the OCaml community.
8792 @end table
8793
8794 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
8795 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
8796 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
8797
8798 @node Invoking guix refresh
8799 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
8800
8801 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
8802 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
8803 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
8804 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
8805 upstream version, like this:
8806
8807 @example
8808 $ guix refresh
8809 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
8810 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
8811 @end example
8812
8813 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
8814 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
8815
8816 @example
8817 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
8818 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
8819 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
8820 @end example
8821
8822 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
8823 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
8824 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
8825 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
8826 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
8827 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
8828 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
8829
8830 @table @code
8831
8832 @item --recursive
8833 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
8834
8835 @example
8836 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
8837 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
8838 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
8839 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
8840 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
8841 @dots{}
8842 @end example
8843
8844 @end table
8845
8846 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
8847 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
8848 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
8849 to that effect:
8850
8851 @example
8852 (define-public network-manager
8853 (package
8854 (name "network-manager")
8855 ;; @dots{}
8856 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
8857 @end example
8858
8859 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
8860 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
8861 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
8862 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
8863 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
8864 using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
8865 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
8866 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
8867 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
8868 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
8869
8870 The following options are supported:
8871
8872 @table @code
8873
8874 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8875 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8876 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
8877
8878 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
8879
8880 @example
8881 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
8882 @end example
8883
8884 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
8885 the packages.)
8886
8887 @item --update
8888 @itemx -u
8889 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
8890 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
8891 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
8892
8893 @example
8894 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
8895 @end example
8896
8897 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
8898
8899 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
8900 @itemx -s @var{subset}
8901 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
8902 @code{non-core}.
8903
8904 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
8905 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
8906 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
8907 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
8908 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
8909 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
8910
8911 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
8912 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
8913 inconvenient.
8914
8915 @item --manifest=@var{file}
8916 @itemx -m @var{file}
8917 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
8918 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
8919
8920 @item --type=@var{updater}
8921 @itemx -t @var{updater}
8922 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
8923 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
8924
8925 @table @code
8926 @item gnu
8927 the updater for GNU packages;
8928 @item gnome
8929 the updater for GNOME packages;
8930 @item kde
8931 the updater for KDE packages;
8932 @item xorg
8933 the updater for X.org packages;
8934 @item kernel.org
8935 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
8936 @item elpa
8937 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
8938 @item cran
8939 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
8940 @item bioconductor
8941 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
8942 @item cpan
8943 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
8944 @item pypi
8945 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
8946 @item gem
8947 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
8948 @item github
8949 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
8950 @item hackage
8951 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
8952 @item stackage
8953 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
8954 @item crate
8955 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
8956 @item launchpad
8957 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
8958 @end table
8959
8960 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
8961 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
8962
8963 @example
8964 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
8965 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
8966 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
8967 @end example
8968
8969 @end table
8970
8971 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
8972 names, as in this example:
8973
8974 @example
8975 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
8976 @end example
8977
8978 @noindent
8979 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
8980 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
8981 effect in this case.
8982
8983 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
8984 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
8985 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
8986 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
8987
8988 @table @code
8989
8990 @item --list-updaters
8991 @itemx -L
8992 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
8993
8994 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
8995 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
8996
8997 @item --list-dependent
8998 @itemx -l
8999 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
9000 result of upgrading one or more packages.
9001
9002 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
9003 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
9004 dependents of a package.
9005
9006 @end table
9007
9008 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
9009 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
9010 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
9011
9012 @example
9013 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
9014 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
9015 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
9016 @end example
9017
9018 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
9019 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
9020
9021 @table @code
9022
9023 @item --list-transitive
9024 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
9025
9026 @example
9027 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
9028 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
9029 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
9030 @end example
9031
9032 @end table
9033
9034 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
9035 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
9036
9037 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
9038
9039 @table @code
9040
9041 @item --gpg=@var{command}
9042 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
9043 for in @code{$PATH}.
9044
9045 @item --keyring=@var{file}
9046 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
9047 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
9048 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
9049 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
9050 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
9051
9052 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
9053 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
9054 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
9055 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
9056 @option{--key-download} below.)
9057
9058 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
9059 commands like this one:
9060
9061 @example
9062 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
9063 @end example
9064
9065 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
9066
9067 @example
9068 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
9069 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
9070 @end example
9071
9072 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
9073 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
9074
9075 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9076 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
9077 of:
9078
9079 @table @code
9080 @item always
9081 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
9082 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
9083
9084 @item never
9085 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
9086
9087 @item interactive
9088 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
9089 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
9090 @end table
9091
9092 @item --key-server=@var{host}
9093 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
9094
9095 @end table
9096
9097 The @code{github} updater uses the
9098 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
9099 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
9100 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
9101 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
9102 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
9103 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
9104 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
9105 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
9106 otherwise.
9107
9108
9109 @node Invoking guix lint
9110 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
9111
9112 @cindex @command{guix lint}
9113 @cindex package, checking for errors
9114 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
9115 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
9116 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
9117 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
9118 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
9119
9120 @table @code
9121 @item synopsis
9122 @itemx description
9123 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
9124 descriptions and synopses.
9125
9126 @item inputs-should-be-native
9127 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
9128
9129 @item source
9130 @itemx home-page
9131 @itemx mirror-url
9132 @itemx github-url
9133 @itemx source-file-name
9134 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
9135 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
9136 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
9137 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
9138 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
9139 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
9140
9141 @item source-unstable-tarball
9142 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
9143 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
9144 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
9145
9146 @item cve
9147 @cindex security vulnerabilities
9148 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
9149 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
9150 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
9151 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
9152 NIST}.
9153
9154 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
9155
9156 @itemize
9157 @item
9158 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9159 @item
9160 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9161 @end itemize
9162
9163 @noindent
9164 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
9165 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
9166
9167 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
9168 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
9169 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
9170 that Guix uses, as in this example:
9171
9172 @example
9173 (package
9174 (name "grub")
9175 ;; @dots{}
9176 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
9177 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
9178 (cpe-version . "2.3")))
9179 @end example
9180
9181 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
9182 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
9183 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
9184 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
9185 declare them as in this example:
9186
9187 @example
9188 (package
9189 (name "t1lib")
9190 ;; @dots{}
9191 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
9192 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
9193 "CVE-2011-1553"
9194 "CVE-2011-1554"
9195 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
9196 @end example
9197
9198 @item formatting
9199 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
9200 use of tabulations, etc.
9201 @end table
9202
9203 The general syntax is:
9204
9205 @example
9206 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9207 @end example
9208
9209 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
9210 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
9211
9212 @table @code
9213 @item --list-checkers
9214 @itemx -l
9215 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
9216 and exit.
9217
9218 @item --checkers
9219 @itemx -c
9220 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
9221 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
9222
9223 @end table
9224
9225 @node Invoking guix size
9226 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
9227
9228 @cindex size
9229 @cindex package size
9230 @cindex closure
9231 @cindex @command{guix size}
9232 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
9233 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
9234 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
9235 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
9236 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
9237 @command{guix size} can highlight.
9238
9239 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
9240 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
9241 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
9242 example:
9243
9244 @example
9245 $ guix size coreutils
9246 store item total self
9247 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
9248 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
9249 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
9250 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
9251 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
9252 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
9253 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
9254 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
9255 total: 78.9 MiB
9256 @end example
9257
9258 @cindex closure
9259 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
9260 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
9261 would be returned by:
9262
9263 @example
9264 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
9265 @end example
9266
9267 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
9268 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
9269 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
9270 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
9271 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
9272 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
9273
9274 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
9275 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
9276 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
9277 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
9278 on the system anyway.)
9279
9280 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
9281 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
9282 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
9283 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
9284 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
9285 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
9286 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
9287 Coreutils}).
9288
9289 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
9290 reports information based on the available substitutes
9291 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
9292 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
9293
9294 You can also specify several package names:
9295
9296 @example
9297 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
9298 store item total self
9299 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
9300 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
9301 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
9302 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
9303 @dots{}
9304 total: 102.3 MiB
9305 @end example
9306
9307 @noindent
9308 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
9309 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
9310 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
9311
9312 The available options are:
9313
9314 @table @option
9315
9316 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9317 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
9318 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
9319
9320 @item --sort=@var{key}
9321 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
9322
9323 @table @code
9324 @item self
9325 the size of each item (the default);
9326 @item closure
9327 the total size of the item's closure.
9328 @end table
9329
9330 @item --map-file=@var{file}
9331 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
9332
9333 For the example above, the map looks like this:
9334
9335 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
9336 produced by @command{guix size}}
9337
9338 This option requires that
9339 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
9340 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
9341 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
9342
9343 @item --system=@var{system}
9344 @itemx -s @var{system}
9345 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
9346
9347 @end table
9348
9349 @node Invoking guix graph
9350 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
9351
9352 @cindex DAG
9353 @cindex @command{guix graph}
9354 @cindex package dependencies
9355 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
9356 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
9357 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
9358 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
9359 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
9360 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
9361 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
9362 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
9363 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
9364 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
9365 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language.
9366 The general syntax is:
9367
9368 @example
9369 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9370 @end example
9371
9372 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
9373 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
9374 dependencies:
9375
9376 @example
9377 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9378 @end example
9379
9380 The output looks like this:
9381
9382 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9383
9384 Nice little graph, no?
9385
9386 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
9387 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
9388 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
9389 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
9390 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
9391
9392 @table @code
9393 @item package
9394 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
9395 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
9396 filters out many details.
9397
9398 @item reverse-package
9399 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
9400
9401 @example
9402 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
9403 @end example
9404
9405 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
9406 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
9407 @code{reverse-bag} below.)
9408
9409 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
9410 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
9411 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
9412 @option{--list-dependent}}).
9413
9414 @item bag-emerged
9415 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
9416
9417 For instance, the following command:
9418
9419 @example
9420 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9421 @end example
9422
9423 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
9424
9425 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9426
9427 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
9428 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
9429
9430 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
9431 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
9432 here, for conciseness.
9433
9434 @item bag
9435 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
9436 dependencies.
9437
9438 @item bag-with-origins
9439 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
9440
9441 @item reverse-bag
9442 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
9443 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
9444
9445 @example
9446 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
9447 @end example
9448
9449 @noindent
9450 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
9451 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
9452 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
9453 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
9454
9455 @item derivation
9456 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
9457 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
9458 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
9459 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
9460
9461 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
9462 name instead of a package name, as in:
9463
9464 @example
9465 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
9466 @end example
9467
9468 @item module
9469 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9470 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
9471 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
9472
9473 @example
9474 guix graph -t module guile | dot -Tpdf > module-graph.pdf
9475 @end example
9476 @end table
9477
9478 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
9479 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
9480
9481 @table @code
9482 @item references
9483 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
9484 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9485
9486 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
9487 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
9488
9489 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
9490 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
9491 (which can be big!):
9492
9493 @example
9494 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
9495 @end example
9496
9497 @item referrers
9498 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
9499 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9500
9501 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
9502 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
9503 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
9504 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
9505 to it.
9506
9507 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
9508 collected.
9509
9510 @end table
9511
9512 The available options are the following:
9513
9514 @table @option
9515 @item --type=@var{type}
9516 @itemx -t @var{type}
9517 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
9518 the values listed above.
9519
9520 @item --list-types
9521 List the supported graph types.
9522
9523 @item --backend=@var{backend}
9524 @itemx -b @var{backend}
9525 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
9526
9527 @item --list-backends
9528 List the supported graph backends.
9529
9530 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
9531
9532 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9533 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9534 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9535
9536 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9537
9538 @example
9539 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
9540 @end example
9541
9542 @item --system=@var{system}
9543 @itemx -s @var{system}
9544 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
9545
9546 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
9547 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
9548 @end table
9549
9550
9551
9552 @node Invoking guix publish
9553 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
9554
9555 @cindex @command{guix publish}
9556 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
9557 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
9558 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
9559
9560 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
9561 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
9562 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
9563 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
9564 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
9565
9566 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
9567 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
9568 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
9569 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
9570 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
9571
9572 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
9573 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
9574 guix archive}).
9575
9576 The general syntax is:
9577
9578 @example
9579 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
9580 @end example
9581
9582 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
9583 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
9584
9585 @example
9586 guix publish
9587 @end example
9588
9589 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
9590 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
9591
9592 @example
9593 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
9594 @end example
9595
9596 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
9597 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
9598 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
9599 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
9600 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
9601 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
9602 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
9603
9604 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
9605 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
9606 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
9607 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
9608 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
9609 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
9610
9611 @example
9612 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
9613 @end example
9614
9615 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
9616 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
9617
9618 @cindex build logs, publication
9619 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
9620
9621 @example
9622 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
9623 @end example
9624
9625 @noindent
9626 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
9627 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
9628 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
9629 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
9630 running @command{guix-daemon} with @code{--log-compression=gzip} since
9631 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
9632 bzip2 compression.
9633
9634 The following options are available:
9635
9636 @table @code
9637 @item --port=@var{port}
9638 @itemx -p @var{port}
9639 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
9640
9641 @item --listen=@var{host}
9642 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
9643 accept connections from any interface.
9644
9645 @item --user=@var{user}
9646 @itemx -u @var{user}
9647 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
9648 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
9649
9650 @item --compression[=@var{level}]
9651 @itemx -C [@var{level}]
9652 Compress data using the given @var{level}. When @var{level} is zero,
9653 disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds to different gzip
9654 compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best (CPU-intensive).
9655 The default is 3.
9656
9657 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
9658 the compressed streams are not
9659 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
9660 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
9661 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
9662 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
9663 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
9664 to its responses.
9665
9666 @item --cache=@var{directory}
9667 @itemx -c @var{directory}
9668 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
9669 and only serve archives that are in cache.
9670
9671 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
9672 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
9673 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
9674 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
9675 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
9676 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
9677 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
9678
9679 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
9680 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
9681 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
9682 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
9683 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
9684 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
9685 the best possible bandwidth.
9686
9687 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
9688 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
9689 @option{--workers} below.
9690
9691 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
9692 when they have expired.
9693
9694 @item --workers=@var{N}
9695 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
9696 threads to ``bake'' archives.
9697
9698 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
9699 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
9700 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
9701 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
9702
9703 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
9704 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
9705 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
9706 for as long as @var{ttl}.
9707
9708 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
9709 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
9710 item in the store, may be deleted.
9711
9712 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
9713 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
9714 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
9715
9716 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
9717 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
9718 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
9719
9720 @item --public-key=@var{file}
9721 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
9722 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
9723 the store items being published.
9724
9725 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
9726 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
9727 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
9728 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
9729 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
9730 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
9731
9732 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
9733 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
9734 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
9735 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
9736 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
9737 @end table
9738
9739 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
9740 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
9741 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
9742 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
9743
9744 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
9745 instructions:”
9746
9747 @itemize
9748 @item
9749 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
9750
9751 @example
9752 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
9753 /etc/systemd/system/
9754 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
9755 @end example
9756
9757 @item
9758 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
9759
9760 @example
9761 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
9762 # start guix-publish
9763 @end example
9764
9765 @item
9766 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
9767 @end itemize
9768
9769 @node Invoking guix challenge
9770 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
9771
9772 @cindex reproducible builds
9773 @cindex verifiable builds
9774 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
9775 @cindex challenge
9776 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
9777 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
9778 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
9779 answer.
9780
9781 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
9782 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
9783 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
9784 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
9785 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
9786 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
9787 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
9788
9789 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
9790 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
9791 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
9792 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
9793 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
9794 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
9795 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
9796 any given store item.
9797
9798 The command output looks like this:
9799
9800 @smallexample
9801 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
9802 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
9803 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
9804 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
9805 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
9806 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
9807 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
9808 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
9809 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
9810 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
9811 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
9812 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
9813 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
9814 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
9815 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
9816
9817 @dots{}
9818
9819 6,406 store items were analyzed:
9820 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
9821 - 525 (8.2%) differed
9822 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
9823 @end smallexample
9824
9825 @noindent
9826 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
9827 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
9828 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
9829 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
9830 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
9831
9832 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
9833 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
9834 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
9835 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
9836 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
9837 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
9838 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
9839 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
9840 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
9841 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
9842 more information.
9843
9844 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
9845 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
9846
9847 @example
9848 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
9849 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
9850 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
9851 @end example
9852
9853 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
9854 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
9855 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
9856 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
9857 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
9858 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
9859 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
9860
9861 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
9862 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
9863 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
9864 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
9865 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
9866 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
9867 the problem.
9868
9869 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
9870 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
9871 same build result as you did with:
9872
9873 @example
9874 $ guix challenge @var{package}
9875 @end example
9876
9877 @noindent
9878 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
9879 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
9880
9881 The general syntax is:
9882
9883 @example
9884 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
9885 @end example
9886
9887 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
9888 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
9889 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
9890 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
9891 errors.)
9892
9893 The one option that matters is:
9894
9895 @table @code
9896
9897 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9898 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
9899 URLs to compare to.
9900
9901 @item --verbose
9902 @itemx -v
9903 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
9904 information about mismatches.
9905
9906 @end table
9907
9908 @node Invoking guix copy
9909 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
9910
9911 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
9912 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
9913 @cindex sharing store items across machines
9914 @cindex transferring store items across machines
9915 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
9916 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
9917 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
9918 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
9919 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
9920 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
9921
9922 @example
9923 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
9924 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
9925 @end example
9926
9927 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
9928 they are not actually sent.
9929
9930 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
9931 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
9932
9933 @example
9934 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
9935 @end example
9936
9937 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
9938 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
9939 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
9940
9941 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
9942 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
9943 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
9944 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
9945 store item authentication.
9946
9947 The general syntax is:
9948
9949 @example
9950 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
9951 @end example
9952
9953 You must always specify one of the following options:
9954
9955 @table @code
9956 @item --to=@var{spec}
9957 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
9958 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
9959 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
9960 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
9961 @end table
9962
9963 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
9964 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
9965
9966 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
9967 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
9968 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
9969
9970
9971 @node Invoking guix container
9972 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
9973 @cindex container
9974 @cindex @command{guix container}
9975 @quotation Note
9976 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
9977 is subject to radical change in the future.
9978 @end quotation
9979
9980 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
9981 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
9982 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
9983 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
9984 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
9985
9986 The general syntax is:
9987
9988 @example
9989 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
9990 @end example
9991
9992 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
9993 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
9994
9995 The following actions are available:
9996
9997 @table @code
9998 @item exec
9999 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
10000
10001 The syntax is:
10002
10003 @example
10004 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
10005 @end example
10006
10007 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
10008 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
10009 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
10010 will be passed to @var{program}.
10011
10012 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
10013 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
10014 process ID is 9001:
10015
10016 @example
10017 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
10018 @end example
10019
10020 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
10021 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
10022
10023 @end table
10024
10025 @node Invoking guix weather
10026 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
10027
10028 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
10029 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
10030 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
10031 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
10032 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
10033 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
10034 publish}).
10035
10036 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
10037 @cindex availability of substitutes
10038 @cindex substitute availability
10039 @cindex weather, substitute availability
10040 Here's a sample run:
10041
10042 @example
10043 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
10044 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10045 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
10046 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10047 https://guix.example.org
10048 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
10049 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
10050 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
10051 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
10052 33.5 requests per second
10053
10054 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
10055 867 queued builds
10056 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
10057 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
10058 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
10059 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
10060 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
10061 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
10062 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
10063 @end example
10064
10065 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
10066 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
10067 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
10068 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
10069 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
10070 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
10071 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
10072 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
10073 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
10074 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
10075 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
10076
10077 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
10078 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
10079 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
10080 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
10081 those substitutes.
10082
10083 Among other things, it is possible to query specific system types and
10084 specific package sets. The available options are listed below.
10085
10086 @table @code
10087 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10088 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
10089 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
10090 servers is queried.
10091
10092 @item --system=@var{system}
10093 @itemx -s @var{system}
10094 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
10095 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
10096 substitutes for several system types.
10097
10098 @item --manifest=@var{file}
10099 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
10100 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
10101 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
10102 guix package}).
10103
10104 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
10105 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
10106 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
10107 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
10108 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
10109 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
10110 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
10111
10112 @example
10113 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
10114 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10115 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
10116 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
10117 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
10118 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
10119 @dots{}
10120 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
10121 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
10122 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
10123 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
10124 @dots{}
10125 @end example
10126
10127 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
10128 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
10129 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
10130
10131 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
10132 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
10133 fail to build.
10134 @end table
10135
10136 @node Invoking guix processes
10137 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
10138
10139 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
10140 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
10141 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
10142 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
10143 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
10144 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
10145
10146 @example
10147 $ sudo guix processes
10148 SessionPID: 19002
10149 ClientPID: 19090
10150 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
10151
10152 SessionPID: 19402
10153 ClientPID: 19367
10154 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
10155
10156 SessionPID: 19444
10157 ClientPID: 19419
10158 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10159 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
10160 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
10161 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
10162 ChildProcess: 20495: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10163 ChildProcess: 27733: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10164 ChildProcess: 27793: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10165 @end example
10166
10167 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
10168 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
10169 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
10170 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
10171 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
10172
10173 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked by this
10174 session, which corresponds to store items being built or substituted (the
10175 @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when @command{guix processes} is not
10176 running as root.) Last, by looking at the @code{ChildProcess} field, we
10177 understand that these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10178 Setup}).
10179
10180 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
10181 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
10182 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
10183 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
10184
10185 @example
10186 $ sudo guix processes | \
10187 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
10188 ClientPID: 19419
10189 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10190 @end example
10191
10192
10193 @node System Configuration
10194 @chapter System Configuration
10195
10196 @cindex system configuration
10197 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
10198 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
10199 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
10200 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
10201 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
10202
10203 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
10204 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
10205 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
10206 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
10207 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
10208 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
10209 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
10210 the own tools of the system.
10211 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
10212
10213 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
10214 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
10215 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
10216 instance to support new system services.
10217
10218 @menu
10219 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
10220 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
10221 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
10222 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
10223 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
10224 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
10225 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
10226 * Services:: Specifying system services.
10227 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
10228 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
10229 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
10230 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
10231 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
10232 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
10233 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
10234 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
10235 @end menu
10236
10237 @node Using the Configuration System
10238 @section Using the Configuration System
10239
10240 The operating system is configured by providing an
10241 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
10242 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
10243 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
10244 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
10245
10246 @findex operating-system
10247 @lisp
10248 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
10249 @end lisp
10250
10251 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
10252 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
10253 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
10254 which case they get a default value.
10255
10256 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
10257 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
10258 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
10259 @command{guix system}.
10260
10261 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
10262
10263 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
10264 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
10265 @cindex UEFI boot
10266 @cindex EFI boot
10267 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
10268 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
10269 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
10270 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
10271 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
10272
10273 @example
10274 (bootloader-configuration
10275 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
10276 (target "/boot/efi"))
10277 @end example
10278
10279 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
10280 configuration options.
10281
10282 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
10283
10284 @vindex %base-packages
10285 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
10286 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
10287 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
10288 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
10289 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
10290 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
10291 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
10292 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
10293 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
10294 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
10295 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
10296 of a package:
10297
10298 @lisp
10299 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10300 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
10301
10302 (operating-system
10303 ;; ...
10304 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
10305 %base-packages)))
10306 @end lisp
10307
10308 @findex specification->package
10309 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
10310 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
10311 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
10312 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
10313 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
10314 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
10315 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
10316 version:
10317
10318 @lisp
10319 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10320
10321 (operating-system
10322 ;; ...
10323 (packages (append (map specification->package
10324 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
10325 %base-packages)))
10326 @end lisp
10327
10328 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
10329
10330 @cindex services
10331 @vindex %base-services
10332 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
10333 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
10334 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
10335 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
10336 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
10337 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
10338 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
10339 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
10340 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
10341
10342 @cindex customization, of services
10343 @findex modify-services
10344 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
10345 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
10346 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
10347
10348 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
10349 (the console log-in) in the @var{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
10350 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
10351 following in your operating system declaration:
10352
10353 @lisp
10354 (define %my-services
10355 ;; My very own list of services.
10356 (modify-services %base-services
10357 (guix-service-type config =>
10358 (guix-configuration
10359 (inherit config)
10360 (use-substitutes? #f)
10361 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
10362 (mingetty-service-type config =>
10363 (mingetty-configuration
10364 (inherit config)))))
10365
10366 (operating-system
10367 ;; @dots{}
10368 (services %my-services))
10369 @end lisp
10370
10371 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
10372 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
10373 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @var{%base-services} list.
10374 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
10375 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
10376 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
10377 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
10378 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
10379 configuration, but with a few modifications.
10380
10381 @cindex encrypted disk
10382 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
10383 root partition, the X11 display
10384 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
10385 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
10386 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
10387
10388 @lisp
10389 @include os-config-desktop.texi
10390 @end lisp
10391
10392 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
10393 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
10394
10395 @lisp
10396 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
10397 @end lisp
10398
10399 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
10400 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
10401 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
10402
10403 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
10404 @var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
10405 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
10406
10407 Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
10408 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
10409 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
10410 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
10411 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
10412 @var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
10413
10414 @example
10415 (remove (lambda (service)
10416 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
10417 %desktop-services)
10418 @end example
10419
10420 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
10421
10422 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
10423 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
10424 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
10425 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
10426 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
10427
10428 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
10429 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
10430 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
10431 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
10432 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
10433 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
10434 system, should you ever need to.
10435
10436 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
10437 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
10438 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
10439 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
10440 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
10441 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
10442 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
10443 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
10444 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
10445 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
10446
10447 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
10448 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
10449 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
10450 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
10451 system}).
10452
10453 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
10454
10455 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
10456 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
10457 Monad}):
10458
10459 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
10460 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
10461 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
10462
10463 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
10464 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
10465 instantiate @var{os}.
10466 @end deffn
10467
10468 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
10469 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
10470 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
10471
10472
10473 @node operating-system Reference
10474 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
10475
10476 This section summarizes all the options available in
10477 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
10478 System}).
10479
10480 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
10481 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
10482 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
10483 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
10484
10485 @table @asis
10486 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
10487 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
10488 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
10489 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
10490
10491 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'("quiet")})
10492 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
10493 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
10494
10495 @item @code{bootloader}
10496 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
10497
10498 @item @code{label}
10499 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
10500 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
10501
10502 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
10503 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
10504 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
10505 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
10506
10507 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
10508 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
10509 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
10510 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10511
10512 @quotation Note
10513 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
10514 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
10515 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
10516 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
10517 Window System.
10518 @end quotation
10519
10520 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
10521 @cindex initrd
10522 @cindex initial RAM disk
10523 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
10524 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
10525
10526 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
10527 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
10528 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
10529 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
10530
10531 @item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
10532 @cindex firmware
10533 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
10534
10535 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
10536 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
10537 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
10538 supported hardware.
10539
10540 @item @code{host-name}
10541 The host name.
10542
10543 @item @code{hosts-file}
10544 @cindex hosts file
10545 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
10546 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10547 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
10548 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
10549
10550 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
10551 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
10552
10553 @item @code{file-systems}
10554 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
10555
10556 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
10557 @cindex swap devices
10558 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
10559 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10560 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
10561 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
10562 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
10563 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
10564
10565 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
10566 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
10567 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
10568
10569 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
10570 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
10571
10572 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
10573 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
10574 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
10575 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
10576
10577 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
10578
10579 @example
10580 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
10581 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
10582 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
10583 (activate-readline)")))
10584 @end example
10585
10586 @item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
10587 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
10588 displayed when users log in on a text console.
10589
10590 @item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
10591 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
10592 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
10593
10594 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
10595 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
10596 package}).
10597
10598 @item @code{timezone}
10599 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
10600
10601 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
10602 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
10603 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
10604
10605 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
10606 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
10607 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
10608
10609 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
10610 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
10611 run time. @xref{Locales}.
10612
10613 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
10614 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
10615 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
10616 considerations that justify this option.
10617
10618 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
10619 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
10620 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
10621 details.
10622
10623 @item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
10624 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
10625
10626 @cindex essential services
10627 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
10628 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
10629 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
10630 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
10631 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
10632
10633 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
10634 @cindex PAM
10635 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
10636 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
10637 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
10638
10639 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
10640 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
10641 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
10642
10643 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
10644 @cindex sudoers file
10645 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
10646 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
10647
10648 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
10649 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
10650 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
10651 @code{sudo}.
10652
10653 @end table
10654
10655 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
10656 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
10657 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
10658
10659 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
10660 the definition of the @code{label} field:
10661
10662 @example
10663 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
10664
10665 (operating-system
10666 ;; ...
10667 (label (package-full-name
10668 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
10669 @end example
10670
10671 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
10672 system definition.
10673 @end deffn
10674
10675 @end deftp
10676
10677 @node File Systems
10678 @section File Systems
10679
10680 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
10681 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
10682 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
10683 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
10684
10685 @example
10686 (file-system
10687 (mount-point "/home")
10688 (device "/dev/sda3")
10689 (type "ext4"))
10690 @end example
10691
10692 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
10693 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
10694
10695 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
10696 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
10697 contain the following members:
10698
10699 @table @asis
10700 @item @code{type}
10701 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
10702 @code{"ext4"}.
10703
10704 @item @code{mount-point}
10705 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
10706
10707 @item @code{device}
10708 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
10709 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
10710 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
10711 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
10712 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
10713 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
10714 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
10715 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
10716 mounted.}.
10717
10718 @findex file-system-label
10719 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
10720 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
10721 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
10722 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
10723
10724 @example
10725 (file-system
10726 (mount-point "/home")
10727 (type "ext4")
10728 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
10729 @end example
10730
10731 @findex uuid
10732 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
10733 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
10734 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
10735 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
10736 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
10737 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
10738 like this:
10739
10740 @example
10741 (file-system
10742 (mount-point "/home")
10743 (type "ext4")
10744 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
10745 @end example
10746
10747 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
10748 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
10749 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
10750 This is required so that
10751 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
10752 corresponding device mapping established.
10753
10754 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
10755 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
10756 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
10757 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
10758 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times), and @code{no-exec}
10759 (disallow program execution). @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
10760 Library Reference Manual}, for more information on these flags.
10761
10762 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
10763 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to the
10764 file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10765 Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for options for
10766 various file systems.
10767
10768 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
10769 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
10770 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
10771 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
10772 is not automatically mounted.
10773
10774 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
10775 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
10776 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
10777 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
10778 instance, for the root file system.
10779
10780 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
10781 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
10782 errors before being mounted.
10783
10784 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
10785 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
10786
10787 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
10788 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
10789 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
10790 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
10791
10792 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
10793 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
10794 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
10795
10796 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
10797 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10798 @end table
10799 @end deftp
10800
10801 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
10802 variables.
10803
10804 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
10805 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
10806 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
10807 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
10808 these.
10809 @end defvr
10810
10811 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
10812 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
10813 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
10814 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10815 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
10816 @command{xterm}.
10817 @end defvr
10818
10819 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
10820 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
10821 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
10822 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
10823 @end defvr
10824
10825 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
10826 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
10827 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
10828 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
10829 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
10830
10831 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
10832 read-write in its own ``name space.''
10833 @end defvr
10834
10835 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
10836 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
10837 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
10838 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
10839 @end defvr
10840
10841 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
10842 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
10843 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
10844 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
10845 @end defvr
10846
10847 @node Mapped Devices
10848 @section Mapped Devices
10849
10850 @cindex device mapping
10851 @cindex mapped devices
10852 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
10853 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
10854 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
10855 with additional processing over the data that flows through
10856 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
10857 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
10858 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
10859 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
10860 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
10861 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
10862 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
10863 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
10864 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
10865 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
10866 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
10867 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
10868 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
10869
10870 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
10871 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
10872
10873 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
10874 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
10875 the system boots up.
10876
10877 @table @code
10878 @item source
10879 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
10880 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
10881 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
10882
10883 @item target
10884 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
10885 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
10886 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
10887 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
10888 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
10889 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
10890
10891 @item type
10892 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
10893 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
10894 @end table
10895 @end deftp
10896
10897 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
10898 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
10899 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
10900 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
10901 @end defvr
10902
10903 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
10904 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
10905 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
10906 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
10907 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
10908 @end defvr
10909
10910 @cindex disk encryption
10911 @cindex LUKS
10912 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
10913 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
10914 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
10915 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
10916 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
10917 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
10918 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
10919
10920 @example
10921 (mapped-device
10922 (source "/dev/sda3")
10923 (target "home")
10924 (type luks-device-mapping))
10925 @end example
10926
10927 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
10928 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
10929 command like:
10930
10931 @example
10932 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
10933 @end example
10934
10935 and use it as follows:
10936
10937 @example
10938 (mapped-device
10939 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
10940 (target "home")
10941 (type luks-device-mapping))
10942 @end example
10943
10944 @cindex swap encryption
10945 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
10946 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
10947 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
10948 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
10949 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
10950
10951 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
10952 may be declared as follows:
10953
10954 @example
10955 (mapped-device
10956 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
10957 (target "/dev/md0")
10958 (type raid-device-mapping))
10959 @end example
10960
10961 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
10962 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
10963 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
10964 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
10965 automatically later.
10966
10967
10968 @node User Accounts
10969 @section User Accounts
10970
10971 @cindex users
10972 @cindex accounts
10973 @cindex user accounts
10974 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
10975 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
10976 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
10977
10978 @example
10979 (user-account
10980 (name "alice")
10981 (group "users")
10982 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
10983 "audio" ;sound card
10984 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
10985 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
10986 (comment "Bob's sister")
10987 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
10988 @end example
10989
10990 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
10991 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
10992 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
10993 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
10994 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
10995 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
10996 as declared.
10997
10998 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
10999 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
11000 be specified:
11001
11002 @table @asis
11003 @item @code{name}
11004 The name of the user account.
11005
11006 @item @code{group}
11007 @cindex groups
11008 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
11009 this account belongs to.
11010
11011 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
11012 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
11013 account belongs to.
11014
11015 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
11016 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
11017 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
11018 account is created.
11019
11020 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
11021 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
11022
11023 @item @code{home-directory}
11024 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
11025
11026 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
11027 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
11028 if it does not exist yet.
11029
11030 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
11031 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
11032 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11033
11034 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11035 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
11036 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
11037 graphical login managers do not list them.
11038
11039 @anchor{user-account-password}
11040 @cindex password, for user accounts
11041 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11042 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
11043 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
11044 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
11045 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
11046 reconfiguration.
11047
11048 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
11049 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
11050 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
11051
11052 @example
11053 (user-account
11054 (name "charlie")
11055 (group "users")
11056
11057 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
11058 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
11059 @end example
11060
11061 @quotation Note
11062 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
11063 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
11064 care.
11065 @end quotation
11066
11067 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
11068 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
11069 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
11070
11071 @end table
11072 @end deftp
11073
11074 @cindex groups
11075 User group declarations are even simpler:
11076
11077 @example
11078 (user-group (name "students"))
11079 @end example
11080
11081 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
11082 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
11083
11084 @table @asis
11085 @item @code{name}
11086 The name of the group.
11087
11088 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
11089 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
11090 automatically allocated when the group is created.
11091
11092 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11093 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
11094 System groups have low numerical IDs.
11095
11096 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11097 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
11098 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
11099
11100 @end table
11101 @end deftp
11102
11103 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
11104 expect:
11105
11106 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
11107 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
11108 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
11109 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
11110 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
11111 @end defvr
11112
11113 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
11114 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
11115 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
11116
11117 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
11118 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
11119 @end defvr
11120
11121 @node Keyboard Layout
11122 @section Keyboard Layout
11123
11124 @cindex keyboard layout
11125 @cindex keymap
11126 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
11127 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
11128 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
11129 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
11130 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
11131 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
11132 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
11133
11134 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
11135 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
11136
11137 @itemize
11138 @item
11139 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
11140 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
11141 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
11142 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
11143
11144 @item
11145 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
11146 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
11147 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11148
11149 @item
11150 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
11151 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11152 @end itemize
11153
11154 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
11155 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
11156
11157 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
11158 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
11159 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
11160 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
11161 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
11162 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
11163 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
11164 about. Here are a few example:
11165
11166 @example
11167 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
11168 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
11169 (keyboard-layout "de")
11170
11171 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
11172 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
11173
11174 ;; The Catalan layout.
11175 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
11176
11177 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
11178 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
11179 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
11180 ;; accented letters.
11181 (keyboard-layout "latam"
11182 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
11183
11184 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
11185 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
11186
11187 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
11188 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
11189 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
11190 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
11191 @end example
11192
11193 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
11194 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
11195
11196 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
11197 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
11198 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
11199 configuration would look like:
11200
11201 @findex set-xorg-configuration
11202 @lisp
11203 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
11204 ;; and for Xorg.
11205
11206 (operating-system
11207 ;; ...
11208 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
11209 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
11210 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11211 (target "/boot/efi")
11212 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
11213 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
11214 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
11215 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
11216 %desktop-services)))
11217 @end lisp
11218
11219 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
11220 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
11221 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
11222 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
11223 GDM.
11224
11225 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
11226 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
11227
11228 @itemize
11229 @item
11230 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
11231 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
11232
11233 @item
11234 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
11235 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
11236 change the layout to US Dvorak:
11237
11238 @example
11239 setxkbmap us dvorak
11240 @end example
11241
11242 @item
11243 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
11244 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
11245 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
11246 French bépo layout:
11247
11248 @example
11249 loadkeys fr-bepo
11250 @end example
11251 @end itemize
11252
11253 @node Locales
11254 @section Locales
11255
11256 @cindex locale
11257 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
11258 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11259 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
11260 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
11261 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
11262 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
11263
11264 @cindex locale definition
11265 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
11266 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
11267 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
11268
11269 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
11270 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
11271 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
11272 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
11273 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
11274 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
11275 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
11276 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
11277
11278 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
11279 that field may be:
11280
11281 @example
11282 (cons (locale-definition
11283 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
11284 %default-locale-definitions)
11285 @end example
11286
11287 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
11288 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
11289
11290 @example
11291 (list (locale-definition
11292 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
11293 (charset "EUC-JP")))
11294 @end example
11295
11296 @vindex LOCPATH
11297 The compiled locale definitions are available at
11298 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
11299 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
11300 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
11301 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11302 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11303
11304 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
11305 locale)} module. Details are given below.
11306
11307 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
11308 This is the data type of a locale definition.
11309
11310 @table @asis
11311
11312 @item @code{name}
11313 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11314 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
11315
11316 @item @code{source}
11317 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
11318 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
11319
11320 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
11321 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
11322 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
11323 IANA}.
11324
11325 @end table
11326 @end deftp
11327
11328 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
11329 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
11330 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
11331 declarations.
11332
11333 @cindex locale name
11334 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
11335 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
11336 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
11337 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
11338 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
11339 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
11340 @end defvr
11341
11342 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
11343
11344 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
11345 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
11346 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
11347 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
11348 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
11349 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
11350 another.
11351
11352 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
11353 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
11354 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
11355 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
11356 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
11357 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
11358 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
11359 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
11360 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
11361 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
11362 programs will not abort.
11363
11364 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
11365 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
11366 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
11367 used to build the system-wide locale data.
11368
11369 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
11370 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11371 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11372
11373 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
11374 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
11375 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
11376 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
11377 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
11378 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
11379
11380 @example
11381 (use-package-modules base)
11382
11383 (operating-system
11384 ;; @dots{}
11385 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
11386 @end example
11387
11388 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
11389 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
11390 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
11391
11392
11393 @node Services
11394 @section Services
11395
11396 @cindex system services
11397 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
11398 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
11399 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
11400 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
11401 configuring network access.
11402
11403 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
11404 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
11405 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
11406 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
11407 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
11408 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
11409
11410 @example
11411 # herd status
11412 @end example
11413
11414 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
11415 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
11416 service and its associated actions:
11417
11418 @example
11419 # herd doc nscd
11420 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
11421
11422 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
11423 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
11424 @end example
11425
11426 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
11427 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
11428 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
11429
11430 @example
11431 # herd stop nscd
11432 Service nscd has been stopped.
11433 # herd restart xorg-server
11434 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
11435 Service xorg-server has been started.
11436 @end example
11437
11438 The following sections document the available services, starting with
11439 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
11440 declaration.
11441
11442 @menu
11443 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
11444 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
11445 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
11446 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
11447 * X Window:: Graphical display.
11448 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
11449 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
11450 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
11451 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
11452 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
11453 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
11454 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
11455 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
11456 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
11457 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
11458 * Web Services:: Web servers.
11459 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
11460 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
11461 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
11462 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
11463 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
11464 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
11465 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
11466 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
11467 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
11468 * Game Services:: Game servers.
11469 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
11470 @end menu
11471
11472 @node Base Services
11473 @subsection Base Services
11474
11475 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
11476 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
11477 this module are listed below.
11478
11479 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
11480 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
11481 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
11482 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
11483 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
11484 more.
11485
11486 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
11487 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
11488 system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
11489 this:
11490
11491 @example
11492 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
11493 (service openssh-service-type))
11494 %base-services)
11495 @end example
11496 @end defvr
11497
11498 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
11499 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
11500 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
11501
11502 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
11503 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
11504 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
11505
11506 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
11507 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
11508 @example
11509 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append @var{bash} "/bin/sh")))
11510 @end example
11511
11512 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
11513 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
11514 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
11515 change it to:
11516
11517 @example
11518 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append @var{bash} "/bin/sh"))
11519 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append @var{coreutils} "/bin/env")))
11520 @end example
11521
11522 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
11523 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
11524 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
11525 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
11526 (see below.)
11527 @end defvr
11528
11529 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
11530 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
11531
11532 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
11533 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
11534 symlink:
11535
11536 @example
11537 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
11538 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
11539 @end example
11540 @end deffn
11541
11542 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
11543 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
11544 @end deffn
11545
11546 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
11547 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
11548 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
11549 among other things.
11550 @end deffn
11551
11552 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
11553 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
11554
11555 @table @asis
11556
11557 @item @code{motd}
11558 @cindex message of the day
11559 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
11560
11561 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
11562 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
11563 the 'root' account has just been created.
11564
11565 @end table
11566 @end deftp
11567
11568 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
11569 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
11570 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
11571 other things.
11572 @end deffn
11573
11574 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
11575 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
11576 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
11577
11578 @table @asis
11579
11580 @item @code{tty}
11581 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
11582
11583 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11584 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
11585 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
11586 user name and password must be entered to log in.
11587
11588 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
11589 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
11590 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
11591 the name of the log-in program.
11592
11593 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
11594 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
11595 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
11596
11597 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
11598 The Mingetty package to use.
11599
11600 @end table
11601 @end deftp
11602
11603 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
11604 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
11605 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
11606 among other things.
11607 @end deffn
11608
11609 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
11610 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
11611 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
11612 man page for more information.
11613
11614 @table @asis
11615
11616 @item @code{tty}
11617 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
11618 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
11619 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
11620
11621 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
11622 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
11623 from it and use that.
11624
11625 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
11626 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
11627 serial port from it and use that.
11628
11629 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
11630 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
11631 correct values.
11632
11633 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
11634 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
11635 descending order.
11636
11637 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
11638 A string containing the value used for the @code{TERM} environment
11639 variable.
11640
11641 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
11642 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
11643 disabled.
11644
11645 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11646 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
11647 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
11648
11649 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
11650 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
11651
11652 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
11653 This accepts a string containing the "login_host", which will be written
11654 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
11655
11656 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
11657 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
11658 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
11659 specified in @var{login-program}.
11660
11661 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
11662 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
11663
11664 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
11665 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
11666 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
11667
11668 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
11669 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
11670 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
11671
11672 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
11673 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
11674 the login prompt.
11675
11676 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
11677 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
11678 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
11679 Shadow tool suite.
11680
11681 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
11682 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
11683 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
11684 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
11685
11686 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
11687 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
11688 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
11689
11690 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
11691 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
11692 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
11693 systems.
11694
11695 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
11696 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
11697 @file{/etc/issue} file.
11698
11699 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
11700 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
11701 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
11702 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
11703 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
11704 options that could be parsed by the login program.
11705
11706 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
11707 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
11708 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
11709 lazily spawning shells.
11710
11711 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
11712 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
11713 path as a string.
11714
11715 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
11716 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
11717 specified terminal.
11718
11719 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
11720 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
11721 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
11722 character.
11723
11724 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
11725 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
11726 within @var{timeout} seconds.
11727
11728 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
11729 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
11730 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
11731 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
11732 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
11733 Unicode characters.
11734
11735 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
11736 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
11737 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
11738 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
11739 @var{init-string} option.
11740
11741 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
11742 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
11743 locks.
11744
11745 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
11746 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
11747 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
11748
11749 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
11750 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
11751 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
11752 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
11753
11754 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
11755 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
11756 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
11757
11758 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
11759 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean "ignore
11760 all previous characters" (also called a "kill" character) when the user
11761 types their login name.
11762
11763 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
11764 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
11765 to before login.
11766
11767 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
11768 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
11769 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
11770
11771 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
11772 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
11773 @command{login} program.
11774
11775 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
11776 This option provides an "escape hatch" for the user to provide arbitrary
11777 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
11778
11779 @end table
11780 @end deftp
11781
11782 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
11783 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
11784 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
11785 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
11786 @end deffn
11787
11788 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
11789 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
11790 implements virtual console log-in.
11791
11792 @table @asis
11793
11794 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
11795 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
11796
11797 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
11798 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
11799 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
11800
11801 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
11802 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
11803
11804 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11805 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
11806 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
11807
11808 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
11809 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
11810
11811 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
11812 The Kmscon package to use.
11813
11814 @end table
11815 @end deftp
11816
11817 @cindex name service cache daemon
11818 @cindex nscd
11819 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
11820 [#:name-services '()]
11821 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
11822 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
11823 Service Switch}, for an example.
11824
11825 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
11826
11827 @table @code
11828 @item invalidate
11829 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
11830 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
11831 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
11832
11833 @example
11834 herd invalidate nscd hosts
11835 @end example
11836
11837 @noindent
11838 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
11839
11840 @item statistics
11841 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
11842 and caches.
11843 @end table
11844
11845 @end deffn
11846
11847 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
11848 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
11849 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
11850 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
11851 @end defvr
11852
11853 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
11854 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
11855 configuration.
11856
11857 @table @asis
11858
11859 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
11860 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
11861 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
11862
11863 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
11864 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
11865 command.
11866
11867 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
11868 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
11869 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
11870
11871 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
11872 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
11873 debugging output is logged.
11874
11875 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
11876 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
11877 below.
11878
11879 @end table
11880 @end deftp
11881
11882 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
11883 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
11884
11885 @table @asis
11886
11887 @item @code{database}
11888 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
11889 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
11890 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
11891 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
11892
11893 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
11894 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
11895 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
11896 negative lookup result remains in cache.
11897
11898 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
11899 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
11900 @var{database}.
11901
11902 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
11903 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
11904 them into account.
11905
11906 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
11907 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
11908
11909 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
11910 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
11911
11912 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
11913 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
11914
11915 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
11916 @c settings, so leave them out.
11917
11918 @end table
11919 @end deftp
11920
11921 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
11922 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
11923 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
11924
11925 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
11926 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
11927 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
11928 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
11929 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
11930 @end defvr
11931
11932 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
11933 @cindex syslog
11934 @cindex logging
11935 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
11936 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
11937
11938 @table @asis
11939 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
11940 The syslog daemon to use.
11941
11942 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
11943 The syslog configuration file to use.
11944
11945 @end table
11946 @end deftp
11947
11948 @anchor{syslog-service}
11949 @cindex syslog
11950 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
11951 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
11952
11953 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
11954 information on the configuration file syntax.
11955 @end deffn
11956
11957 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
11958 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
11959 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
11960 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
11961 @end defvr
11962
11963 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
11964 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
11965 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
11966 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
11967
11968 @table @asis
11969 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
11970 The Guix package to use.
11971
11972 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
11973 Name of the group for build user accounts.
11974
11975 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
11976 Number of build user accounts to create.
11977
11978 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
11979 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
11980 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
11981 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
11982 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
11983
11984 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
11985 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @var{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
11986 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
11987 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
11988 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
11989
11990 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
11991 Whether to use substitutes.
11992
11993 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
11994 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
11995
11996 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
11997 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
11998 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
11999 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
12000 disables the timeout.
12001
12002 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
12003 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
12004 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
12005
12006 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12007 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
12008
12009 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
12010 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
12011 are written.
12012
12013 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
12014 The HTTP proxy used for downloading fixed-output derivations and
12015 substitutes.
12016
12017 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
12018 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
12019
12020 @end table
12021 @end deftp
12022
12023 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
12024 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
12025 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
12026 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule} and @code{file->udev-rule} from
12027 @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the creation of such rule files.
12028 @end deffn
12029
12030 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
12031 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
12032 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
12033
12034 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
12035 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
12036 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
12037
12038 @example
12039 (define %example-udev-rule
12040 (udev-rule
12041 "90-usb-thing.rules"
12042 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
12043 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
12044 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
12045 @end example
12046
12047 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
12048 directory containing all the active udev rules.
12049 @end deffn
12050
12051 Here we show how the default @var{udev-service} can be extended with it.
12052
12053 @example
12054 (operating-system
12055 ;; @dots{}
12056 (services
12057 (modify-services %desktop-services
12058 (udev-service-type config =>
12059 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12060 (rules (append (udev-configuration-rules config)
12061 (list %example-udev-rule))))))))
12062 @end example
12063
12064 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
12065 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
12066 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
12067
12068 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
12069
12070 @example
12071 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
12072 (guix packages) ;for origin
12073 ;; @dots{})
12074
12075 (define %android-udev-rules
12076 (file->udev-rule
12077 "51-android-udev.rules"
12078 (let ((version "20170910"))
12079 (origin
12080 (method url-fetch)
12081 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
12082 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
12083 (sha256
12084 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
12085 @end example
12086 @end deffn
12087
12088 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
12089 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
12090 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
12091 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
12092 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
12093 packages android)} module.
12094
12095 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
12096 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
12097 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
12098 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
12099 the rules defined within the @var{android-udev-rules} package. To
12100 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
12101 @var{supplementary-groups} of our @var{user-account} declaration, as
12102 well as in the @var{groups} field of the @var{operating-system} record.
12103
12104 @example
12105 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
12106 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
12107 ;; @dots{})
12108
12109 (operating-system
12110 ;; @dots{}
12111 (users (cons (user-acount
12112 ;; @dots{}
12113 (supplementary-groups
12114 '("adbusers" ;for adb
12115 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video"))
12116 ;; @dots{})))
12117
12118 (groups (cons (user-group (system? #t) (name "adbusers"))
12119 %base-groups))
12120
12121 ;; @dots{}
12122
12123 (services
12124 (modify-services %desktop-services
12125 (udev-service-type
12126 config =>
12127 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12128 (rules (cons android-udev-rules
12129 (udev-configuration-rules config))))))))
12130 @end example
12131
12132 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
12133 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
12134 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
12135 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
12136 readable.
12137 @end defvr
12138
12139 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
12140 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
12141 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
12142 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
12143 @end defvr
12144
12145 @cindex mouse
12146 @cindex gpm
12147 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
12148 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
12149 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
12150 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
12151 and paste text.
12152
12153 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
12154 (see below). This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
12155 @end defvr
12156
12157 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
12158 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
12159
12160 @table @asis
12161 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
12162 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
12163 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
12164 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
12165 more information.
12166
12167 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
12168 The GPM package to use.
12169
12170 @end table
12171 @end deftp
12172
12173 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
12174 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
12175 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
12176 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-configuration}
12177 object, as described below.
12178
12179 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
12180 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12181 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
12182 @end deffn
12183
12184 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
12185 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
12186 service.
12187
12188 @table @asis
12189 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
12190 The Guix package to use.
12191
12192 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
12193 The TCP port to listen for connections.
12194
12195 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
12196 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
12197 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
12198
12199 @item @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
12200 The gzip compression level at which substitutes are compressed. Use
12201 @code{0} to disable compression altogether, and @code{9} to get the best
12202 compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU usage.
12203
12204 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
12205 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
12206 publish, @code{--nar-path}}, for details.
12207
12208 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
12209 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
12210 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
12211 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
12212 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
12213 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
12214
12215 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
12216 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
12217 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
12218 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
12219
12220 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
12221 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
12222 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
12223 for more information.
12224 @end table
12225 @end deftp
12226
12227 @anchor{rngd-service}
12228 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
12229 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
12230 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
12231 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
12232 @var{device} does not exist.
12233 @end deffn
12234
12235 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
12236 @cindex session limits
12237 @cindex ulimit
12238 @cindex priority
12239 @cindex realtime
12240 @cindex jackd
12241 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
12242
12243 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
12244 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
12245 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
12246 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
12247 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
12248
12249 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
12250 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
12251
12252 @example
12253 (pam-limits-service
12254 (list
12255 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
12256 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
12257 @end example
12258
12259 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
12260 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
12261 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
12262 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
12263 @end deffn
12264
12265 @node Scheduled Job Execution
12266 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
12267
12268 @cindex cron
12269 @cindex mcron
12270 @cindex scheduling jobs
12271 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
12272 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
12273 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
12274 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
12275 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
12276 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
12277
12278 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
12279 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
12280 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
12281 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
12282 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
12283 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
12284 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12285
12286 @lisp
12287 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
12288 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12289
12290 (define updatedb-job
12291 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
12292 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
12293 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
12294 (lambda ()
12295 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
12296 "updatedb"
12297 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
12298
12299 (define garbage-collector-job
12300 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
12301 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
12302 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
12303 "guix gc -F 1G"))
12304
12305 (define idutils-job
12306 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
12307 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
12308 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
12309 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
12310 #:user "charlie"))
12311
12312 (operating-system
12313 ;; @dots{}
12314 (services (cons (service mcron-service-type
12315 (mcron-configuration
12316 (jobs (list garbage-collector-job
12317 updatedb-job
12318 idutils-job))))
12319 %base-services)))
12320 @end lisp
12321
12322 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
12323 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
12324 reference of the mcron service.
12325
12326 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
12327 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
12328
12329 @example
12330 # herd schedule mcron
12331 @end example
12332
12333 @noindent
12334 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
12335 also specify the number of tasks to display:
12336
12337 @example
12338 # herd schedule mcron 10
12339 @end example
12340
12341 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
12342 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
12343 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
12344
12345 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
12346 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
12347 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
12348 mcron jobs to run.
12349 @end defvr
12350
12351 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
12352 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
12353
12354 @table @asis
12355 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
12356 The mcron package to use.
12357
12358 @item @code{jobs}
12359 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
12360 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
12361 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
12362 @end table
12363 @end deftp
12364
12365
12366 @node Log Rotation
12367 @subsection Log Rotation
12368
12369 @cindex rottlog
12370 @cindex log rotation
12371 @cindex logging
12372 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
12373 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
12374 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
12375 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
12376 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12377
12378 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
12379 with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
12380
12381 @lisp
12382 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
12383 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
12384 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12385
12386 (operating-system
12387 ;; @dots{}
12388 (services (cons (service rottlog-service-type)
12389 %base-services)))
12390 @end lisp
12391
12392 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
12393 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
12394 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
12395
12396 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
12397 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
12398
12399 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
12400 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
12401 @end defvr
12402
12403 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
12404 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
12405
12406 @table @asis
12407 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
12408 The Rottlog package to use.
12409
12410 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
12411 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
12412 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12413
12414 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
12415 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
12416
12417 @item @code{jobs}
12418 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
12419 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
12420 @end table
12421 @end deftp
12422
12423 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
12424 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
12425
12426 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
12427 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
12428 defined like this:
12429
12430 @example
12431 (log-rotation
12432 (frequency 'daily)
12433 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
12434 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
12435 "rotate 6"
12436 "notifempty"
12437 "nocompress")))
12438 @end example
12439
12440 The list of fields is as follows:
12441
12442 @table @asis
12443 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
12444 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
12445
12446 @item @code{files}
12447 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
12448
12449 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
12450 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
12451 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
12452
12453 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
12454 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
12455 @end table
12456 @end deftp
12457
12458 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
12459 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and
12460 a couple of other files.
12461 @end defvr
12462
12463 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
12464 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
12465 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure")}.
12466 @end defvr
12467
12468 @node Networking Services
12469 @subsection Networking Services
12470
12471 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
12472 the network interface.
12473
12474 @cindex DHCP, networking service
12475 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
12476 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
12477 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
12478 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
12479 @end defvr
12480
12481 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
12482 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
12483 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
12484 For example:
12485
12486 @example
12487 (service dhcpd-service-type
12488 (dhcpd-configuration
12489 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
12490 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
12491 @end example
12492 @end deffn
12493
12494 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
12495 @table @asis
12496 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
12497 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
12498 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
12499 directory. The default package is the
12500 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
12501 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
12502 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
12503 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
12504 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
12505 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
12506 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
12507 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
12508 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
12509 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
12510 details.
12511 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
12512 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
12513 will be created if it does not exist.
12514 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
12515 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
12516 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
12517 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
12518 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
12519 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
12520 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
12521 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
12522 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
12523 @end table
12524 @end deftp
12525
12526 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
12527 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
12528 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
12529 @end defvr
12530
12531 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
12532 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
12533 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
12534 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
12535 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
12536 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
12537 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
12538 interface.
12539
12540 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
12541 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
12542 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
12543 to handle.
12544
12545 For example:
12546
12547 @example
12548 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
12549 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
12550 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
12551 @end example
12552 @end deffn
12553
12554 @cindex wicd
12555 @cindex wireless
12556 @cindex WiFi
12557 @cindex network management
12558 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
12559 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
12560 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
12561
12562 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
12563 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
12564 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
12565 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
12566 @end deffn
12567
12568 @cindex ModemManager
12569
12570 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
12571 This is the service type for the
12572 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
12573 service. The value for this service type is a
12574 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
12575
12576 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12577 Services}).
12578 @end defvr
12579
12580 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
12581 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
12582
12583 @table @asis
12584 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
12585 The ModemManager package to use.
12586
12587 @end table
12588 @end deftp
12589
12590 @cindex NetworkManager
12591
12592 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
12593 This is the service type for the
12594 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
12595 service. The value for this service type is a
12596 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
12597
12598 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12599 Services}).
12600 @end defvr
12601
12602 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
12603 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
12604
12605 @table @asis
12606 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
12607 The NetworkManager package to use.
12608
12609 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
12610 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
12611 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
12612
12613 @table @samp
12614 @item default
12615 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
12616 provided by currently active connections.
12617
12618 @item dnsmasq
12619 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver,
12620 using a "split DNS" configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
12621 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
12622
12623 @item none
12624 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
12625 @end table
12626
12627 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
12628 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
12629 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
12630 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
12631
12632 @end table
12633 @end deftp
12634
12635 @cindex Connman
12636 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
12637 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
12638 a network connection manager.
12639
12640 Its value must be an
12641 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
12642
12643 @example
12644 (service connman-service-type
12645 (connman-configuration
12646 (disable-vpn? #t)))
12647 @end example
12648
12649 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
12650 @end deffn
12651
12652 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
12653 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
12654
12655 @table @asis
12656 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
12657 The connman package to use.
12658
12659 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
12660 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
12661 @end table
12662 @end deftp
12663
12664 @cindex WPA Supplicant
12665 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
12666 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
12667 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
12668 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
12669 @end defvr
12670
12671 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
12672 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
12673
12674 It takes the following parameters:
12675
12676 @table @asis
12677 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
12678 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
12679
12680 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
12681 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
12682
12683 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
12684 Where to store the PID file.
12685
12686 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
12687 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
12688 WPA supplicant will control.
12689
12690 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
12691 Optional configuration file to use.
12692
12693 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12694 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
12695 @end table
12696 @end deftp
12697
12698 @cindex iptables
12699 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
12700 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
12701 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
12702 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
12703 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
12704 22 is shown below.
12705
12706 @lisp
12707 (service iptables-service-type
12708 (iptables-configuration
12709 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
12710 :INPUT ACCEPT
12711 :FORWARD ACCEPT
12712 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
12713 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
12714 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
12715 COMMIT
12716 "))
12717 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
12718 :INPUT ACCEPT
12719 :FORWARD ACCEPT
12720 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
12721 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
12722 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
12723 COMMIT
12724 "))))
12725 @end lisp
12726 @end defvr
12727
12728 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
12729 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
12730
12731 @table @asis
12732 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
12733 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
12734 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
12735 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
12736 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
12737 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
12738 objects}).
12739 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
12740 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
12741 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
12742 objects}).
12743 @end table
12744 @end deftp
12745
12746 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
12747 @cindex real time clock
12748 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
12749 This is the type of the service running the @uref{http://www.ntp.org,
12750 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
12751 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
12752
12753 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
12754 below.
12755 @end defvr
12756
12757 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
12758 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
12759
12760 @table @asis
12761 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
12762 This is the list of servers (host names) with which @command{ntpd} will be
12763 synchronized.
12764
12765 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
12766 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
12767 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
12768
12769 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
12770 The NTP package to use.
12771 @end table
12772 @end deftp
12773
12774 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
12775 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
12776 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
12777 @end defvr
12778
12779 @cindex OpenNTPD
12780 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
12781 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
12782 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
12783 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
12784
12785 @example
12786 (service
12787 openntpd-service-type
12788 (openntpd-configuration
12789 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
12790 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
12791 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
12792 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
12793 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
12794
12795 @end example
12796 @end deffn
12797
12798 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
12799 @table @asis
12800 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
12801 The openntpd executable to use.
12802 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
12803 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
12804 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
12805 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
12806 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
12807 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
12808 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
12809 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
12810 information.
12811 @item @code{server} (default: @var{%ntp-servers})
12812 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
12813 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
12814 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
12815 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
12816 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
12817 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
12818 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
12819 man-in-the-middle attacks.
12820 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
12821 a constraint.
12822 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
12823 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
12824 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
12825 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
12826 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
12827 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
12828 than 180 seconds.
12829 @end table
12830 @end deftp
12831
12832 @cindex inetd
12833 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
12834 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
12835 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
12836 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
12837 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
12838
12839 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
12840 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
12841 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
12842 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
12843 gateway @code{hostname}:
12844
12845 @example
12846 (service
12847 inetd-service-type
12848 (inetd-configuration
12849 (entries (list
12850 (inetd-entry
12851 (name "echo")
12852 (socket-type 'stream)
12853 (protocol "tcp")
12854 (wait? #f)
12855 (user "root"))
12856 (inetd-entry
12857 (node "127.0.0.1")
12858 (name "smtp")
12859 (socket-type 'stream)
12860 (protocol "tcp")
12861 (wait? #f)
12862 (user "root")
12863 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
12864 (arguments
12865 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
12866 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))
12867 @end example
12868
12869 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
12870 @end deffn
12871
12872 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
12873 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
12874
12875 @table @asis
12876 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
12877 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
12878
12879 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
12880 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
12881 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
12882 @end table
12883 @end deftp
12884
12885 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
12886 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
12887 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
12888 requests.
12889
12890 @table @asis
12891 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
12892 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
12893 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
12894 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
12895 description of all options.
12896 @item @code{name}
12897 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
12898 @item @code{socket-type}
12899 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
12900 @code{'seqpacket}.
12901 @item @code{protocol}
12902 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
12903 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
12904 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
12905 listening to new service requests.
12906 @item @code{user}
12907 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
12908 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
12909 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
12910 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
12911 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
12912 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
12913 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
12914 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
12915 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
12916 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
12917 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
12918 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
12919 @end table
12920
12921 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
12922 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
12923 @end deftp
12924
12925 @cindex Tor
12926 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
12927 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
12928 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
12929 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
12930 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
12931
12932 @end defvr
12933
12934 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
12935 @table @asis
12936 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
12937 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
12938 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
12939 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
12940 implementation.
12941
12942 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
12943 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
12944 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
12945 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
12946 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
12947 syntax.
12948
12949 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
12950 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
12951 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
12952 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
12953 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
12954 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
12955
12956 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
12957 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
12958 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
12959 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
12960 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
12961 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
12962 @code{tor} group.
12963
12964 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
12965 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
12966 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
12967 @code{SocksPort} option.
12968 @end table
12969 @end deftp
12970
12971 @cindex hidden service
12972 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
12973 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
12974 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
12975
12976 @example
12977 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
12978 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
12979 @end example
12980
12981 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
12982 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
12983
12984 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
12985 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
12986 service.
12987
12988 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
12989 project's documentation} for more information.
12990 @end deffn
12991
12992 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
12993
12994 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
12995 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
12996 files.
12997
12998 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
12999 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
13000 The value for this service type is a
13001 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
13002
13003 @example
13004 (service rsync-service-type)
13005 @end example
13006
13007 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
13008 @end deffn
13009
13010 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
13011 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
13012
13013 @table @asis
13014 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
13015 @code{rsync} package to use.
13016
13017 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
13018 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
13019 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
13020 @code{root} user and group.
13021
13022 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
13023 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
13024
13025 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
13026 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
13027
13028 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
13029 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
13030
13031 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
13032 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
13033
13034 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
13035 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13036
13037 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
13038 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13039
13040 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
13041 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
13042
13043 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
13044 I/O timeout in seconds.
13045
13046 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
13047 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
13048
13049 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
13050 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
13051
13052 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13053 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
13054 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
13055
13056 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13057 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
13058
13059 @end table
13060 @end deftp
13061
13062 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
13063 @cindex SSH
13064 @cindex SSH server
13065
13066 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
13067 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
13068 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
13069 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
13070 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
13071 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
13072 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
13073 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
13074 only by root.
13075
13076 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
13077 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
13078 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
13079 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
13080 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
13081
13082 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
13083 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
13084 require interaction.
13085
13086 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
13087 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
13088 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
13089 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
13090
13091 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
13092 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
13093 or addresses.
13094
13095 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
13096 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
13097 root.
13098
13099 The other options should be self-descriptive.
13100 @end deffn
13101
13102 @cindex SSH
13103 @cindex SSH server
13104 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
13105 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
13106 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
13107 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
13108
13109 @example
13110 (service openssh-service-type
13111 (openssh-configuration
13112 (x11-forwarding? #t)
13113 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
13114 (authorized-keys
13115 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
13116 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
13117 @end example
13118
13119 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
13120
13121 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
13122 example:
13123
13124 @example
13125 (service-extension openssh-service-type
13126 (const `(("charlie"
13127 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
13128 @end example
13129 @end deffn
13130
13131 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
13132 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
13133
13134 @table @asis
13135 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
13136 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
13137
13138 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
13139 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
13140
13141 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
13142 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
13143 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
13144 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
13145 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
13146
13147 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13148 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
13149 not.
13150
13151 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13152 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
13153 other authentication methods.
13154
13155 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13156 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
13157 false, users have to use other authentication method.
13158
13159 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13160 This is used only by protocol version 2.
13161
13162 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
13163 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
13164 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
13165 @option{-Y} will work.
13166
13167 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13168 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
13169
13170 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13171 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
13172
13173 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
13174 Whether to allow gateway ports.
13175
13176 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
13177 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
13178 PAM).
13179
13180 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
13181 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
13182 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
13183 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
13184 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
13185 module processing for all authentication types.
13186
13187 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
13188 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
13189 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
13190 @code{password-authentication?}.
13191
13192 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
13193 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
13194 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
13195
13196 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
13197 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
13198
13199 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
13200 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
13201 subsystem request.
13202
13203 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
13204 server. Alternately, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
13205 @example
13206 (service openssh-service-type
13207 (openssh-configuration
13208 (subsystems
13209 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
13210 @end example
13211
13212 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
13213 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
13214
13215 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
13216 @code{man sshd_config}.
13217
13218 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @code{COLORTERM} variable.
13219 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
13220 your shell's ressource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
13221 if this variable is set.
13222
13223 @example
13224 (service openssh-service-type
13225 (openssh-configuration
13226 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
13227 @end example
13228
13229 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
13230 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
13231 @cindex SSH authorized keys
13232 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
13233 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
13234 keys. For example:
13235
13236 @example
13237 (openssh-configuration
13238 (authorized-keys
13239 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
13240 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
13241 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
13242 @end example
13243
13244 @noindent
13245 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
13246 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
13247
13248 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
13249 @code{service-extension}.
13250
13251 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
13252 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13253
13254 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
13255 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
13256 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
13257 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
13258
13259 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
13260 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
13261 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
13262 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
13263 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
13264
13265 @example
13266 (openssh-configuration
13267 (extra-content "\
13268 Match Address 192.168.0.1
13269 PermitRootLogin yes"))
13270 @end example
13271
13272 @end table
13273 @end deftp
13274
13275 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
13276 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
13277 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
13278 object.
13279
13280 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
13281 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
13282
13283 @example
13284 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
13285 (port-number 1234)))
13286 @end example
13287 @end deffn
13288
13289 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
13290 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
13291
13292 @table @asis
13293 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
13294 The Dropbear package to use.
13295
13296 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
13297 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
13298
13299 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
13300 Whether to enable syslog output.
13301
13302 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
13303 File name of the daemon's PID file.
13304
13305 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13306 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
13307
13308 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13309 Whether to allow empty passwords.
13310
13311 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13312 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
13313 @end table
13314 @end deftp
13315
13316 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
13317 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
13318 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
13319 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
13320 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
13321 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
13322
13323 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
13324 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
13325 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
13326
13327 @example
13328 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13329
13330 (operating-system
13331 (host-name "mymachine")
13332 ;; ...
13333 (hosts-file
13334 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
13335 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
13336 (plain-file "hosts"
13337 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
13338 %facebook-host-aliases))))
13339 @end example
13340
13341 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
13342 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
13343 @end defvr
13344
13345 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
13346
13347 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
13348 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
13349 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
13350 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
13351 Its value must be a @code{zero-configuration} record---see below.
13352
13353 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
13354 resolve @code{.local} host names using
13355 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
13356 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
13357
13358 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
13359 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
13360 @end defvr
13361
13362 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
13363 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
13364
13365 @table @asis
13366
13367 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
13368 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
13369 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
13370
13371 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
13372 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
13373 network.
13374
13375 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
13376 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
13377 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
13378 your local network, you can run:
13379
13380 @example
13381 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
13382 @end example
13383
13384 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
13385 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
13386
13387 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
13388 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
13389 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
13390
13391 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
13392 This is a list of domains to browse.
13393 @end table
13394 @end deftp
13395
13396 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
13397 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
13398 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
13399 object.
13400 @end deffn
13401
13402 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
13403 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
13404 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
13405 through programmatic extension.
13406
13407 @table @asis
13408 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
13409 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
13410
13411 @end table
13412 @end deftp
13413
13414 @node X Window
13415 @subsection X Window
13416
13417 @cindex X11
13418 @cindex X Window System
13419 @cindex login manager
13420 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
13421 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
13422 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
13423 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
13424
13425 @cindex GDM
13426 @cindex GNOME, login manager
13427 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
13428 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
13429 features such as automatic screen locking.
13430
13431 @cindex window manager
13432 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
13433 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
13434 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
13435 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
13436
13437 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
13438 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
13439 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
13440 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
13441 (see below.)
13442
13443 @cindex session types (X11)
13444 @cindex X11 session types
13445 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
13446 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
13447 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
13448 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
13449 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
13450
13451 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
13452 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
13453 and/or other X clients.
13454 @end defvr
13455
13456 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
13457 @table @asis
13458 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13459 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
13460 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
13461
13462 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
13463 @code{default-user}.
13464
13465 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
13466 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
13467
13468 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13469 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13470
13471 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
13472 Script to run before starting a X session.
13473
13474 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
13475 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
13476
13477 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
13478 The GDM package to use.
13479 @end table
13480 @end deftp
13481
13482 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
13483 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
13484
13485 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
13486 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
13487 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
13488 @end defvr
13489
13490 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
13491 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
13492
13493 @table @asis
13494 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
13495 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
13496
13497 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13498 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
13499 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
13500
13501 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
13502 @code{default-user}.
13503
13504 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
13505 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
13506 The graphical theme to use and its name.
13507
13508 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
13509 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
13510 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
13511
13512 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
13513 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
13514 will be used.
13515
13516 @quotation Note
13517 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
13518 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
13519 false, you will be unable to log in.
13520 @end quotation
13521
13522 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13523 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13524
13525 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
13526 The XAuth package to use.
13527
13528 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
13529 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
13530 @command{reboot}.
13531
13532 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
13533 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
13534
13535 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
13536 The SLiM package to use.
13537 @end table
13538 @end deftp
13539
13540 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
13541 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
13542 The default SLiM theme and its name.
13543 @end defvr
13544
13545
13546 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
13547 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
13548
13549 @table @asis
13550 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
13551 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
13552 or "wayland".
13553
13554 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
13555 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
13556
13557 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
13558 Command to run when halting.
13559
13560 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
13561 Command to run when rebooting.
13562
13563 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
13564 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
13565
13566 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
13567 Directory to look for themes.
13568
13569 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
13570 Directory to look for faces.
13571
13572 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
13573 Default PATH to use.
13574
13575 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default 1000)
13576 Minimum UID to display in SDDM.
13577
13578 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default 2000)
13579 Maximum UID to display in SDDM
13580
13581 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
13582 Remember last user.
13583
13584 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
13585 Remember last session.
13586
13587 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
13588 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
13589
13590 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
13591 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
13592
13593 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
13594 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
13595
13596 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
13597 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
13598
13599 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13600 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13601
13602 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
13603 Path to xauth.
13604
13605 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
13606 Path to Xephyr.
13607
13608 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
13609 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
13610
13611 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
13612 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
13613
13614 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
13615 Script to run before starting a X session.
13616
13617 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
13618 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
13619
13620 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
13621 Minimum VT to use.
13622
13623 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
13624 User to use for auto-login.
13625
13626 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
13627 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
13628
13629 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
13630 Relogin after logout.
13631
13632 @end table
13633 @end deftp
13634
13635 @cindex login manager
13636 @cindex X11 login
13637 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sddm-service config
13638 Return a service that spawns the SDDM graphical login manager for config of
13639 type @code{<sddm-configuration>}.
13640
13641 @example
13642 (sddm-service (sddm-configuration
13643 (auto-login-user "Alice")
13644 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
13645 @end example
13646 @end deffn
13647
13648 @cindex Xorg, configuration
13649 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
13650 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
13651 server. Note that there is not Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
13652 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
13653 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
13654
13655 @table @asis
13656 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
13657 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
13658 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
13659
13660 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
13661 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
13662
13663 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
13664 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
13665 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
13666 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
13667
13668 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
13669 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
13670 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
13671 768) (640 480))}.
13672
13673 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
13674 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
13675 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13676 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
13677 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
13678
13679 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
13680 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
13681 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
13682
13683 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
13684 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
13685 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
13686
13687 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
13688 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
13689
13690 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
13691 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
13692 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
13693 @end table
13694 @end deftp
13695
13696 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
13697 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
13698 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
13699 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
13700
13701 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
13702 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
13703 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
13704 @end deffn
13705
13706 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
13707 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
13708 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
13709 @code{startx}.
13710
13711 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
13712 @end deffn
13713
13714
13715 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
13716 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
13717 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
13718 for it. For example:
13719
13720 @lisp
13721 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
13722 @end lisp
13723
13724 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
13725 @end deffn
13726
13727
13728 @node Printing Services
13729 @subsection Printing Services
13730
13731 @cindex printer support with CUPS
13732 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
13733 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
13734 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
13735
13736 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
13737 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
13738 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
13739 write:
13740 @example
13741 (service cups-service-type)
13742 @end example
13743 @end deffn
13744
13745 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
13746 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
13747 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
13748 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
13749 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
13750 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
13751 secure connections to the print server.
13752
13753 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
13754 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
13755 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package. You can do that directly,
13756 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
13757
13758 @example
13759 (service cups-service-type
13760 (cups-configuration
13761 (web-interface? #t)
13762 (extensions
13763 (list cups-filters escpr hplip-minimal))))
13764 @end example
13765
13766 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
13767 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
13768 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
13769
13770 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
13771 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
13772 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
13773 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
13774 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
13775 from some other system; see the end for more details.
13776
13777 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
13778 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
13779 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
13780 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
13781 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
13782 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
13783 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
13784
13785
13786 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
13787
13788 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
13789 The CUPS package.
13790 @end deftypevr
13791
13792 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
13793 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
13794 @end deftypevr
13795
13796 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
13797 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
13798 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
13799
13800 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
13801
13802 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
13803 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
13804 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
13805 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
13806 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
13807 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
13808 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
13809 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
13810
13811 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
13812 @end deftypevr
13813
13814 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
13815 Where CUPS should cache data.
13816
13817 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
13818 @end deftypevr
13819
13820 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
13821 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
13822 writes.
13823
13824 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
13825 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
13826 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
13827 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
13828 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
13829
13830 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
13831 @end deftypevr
13832
13833 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
13834 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
13835 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
13836 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
13837 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
13838 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
13839 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
13840 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
13841
13842 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
13843 @end deftypevr
13844
13845 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
13846 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
13847 kind strings are:
13848
13849 @table @code
13850 @item none
13851 No errors are fatal.
13852
13853 @item all
13854 All of the errors below are fatal.
13855
13856 @item browse
13857 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
13858 to the DNS-SD daemon.
13859
13860 @item config
13861 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
13862
13863 @item listen
13864 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
13865 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
13866
13867 @item log
13868 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
13869
13870 @item permissions
13871 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
13872 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
13873 @end table
13874
13875 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
13876 @end deftypevr
13877
13878 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
13879 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
13880 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
13881
13882 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13883 @end deftypevr
13884
13885 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
13886 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
13887 programs.
13888
13889 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
13890 @end deftypevr
13891
13892 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
13893 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
13894
13895 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
13896 @end deftypevr
13897
13898 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
13899 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
13900 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
13901 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
13902 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
13903 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
13904 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
13905 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
13906
13907 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
13908 @end deftypevr
13909
13910 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
13911 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
13912 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
13913
13914 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
13915 @end deftypevr
13916
13917 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
13918 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
13919 data.
13920
13921 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
13922 @end deftypevr
13923
13924 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
13925 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
13926 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
13927 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
13928 used/supported on macOS.
13929
13930 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
13931 @end deftypevr
13932
13933 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
13934 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
13935 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
13936 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
13937 PEM-encoded private keys.
13938
13939 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
13940 @end deftypevr
13941
13942 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
13943 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
13944
13945 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
13946 @end deftypevr
13947
13948 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
13949 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
13950 configuration or state files.
13951
13952 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13953 @end deftypevr
13954
13955 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
13956 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
13957 @end deftypevr
13958
13959 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
13960 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
13961
13962 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
13963 @end deftypevr
13964
13965 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
13966 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
13967 programs.
13968
13969 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
13970 @end deftypevr
13971 @end deftypevr
13972
13973 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
13974 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
13975 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
13976 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
13977 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
13978 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
13979 level logs all requests.
13980
13981 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
13982 @end deftypevr
13983
13984 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
13985 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
13986 longer required for quotas.
13987
13988 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
13989 @end deftypevr
13990
13991 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
13992 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
13993
13994 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
13995 @end deftypevr
13996
13997 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
13998 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
13999
14000 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14001 @end deftypevr
14002
14003 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
14004 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
14005
14006 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14007 @end deftypevr
14008
14009 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
14010 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
14011 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
14012 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
14013 secure printing functions.
14014
14015 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14016 @end deftypevr
14017
14018 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
14019 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
14020 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
14021
14022 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14023 @end deftypevr
14024
14025 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
14026 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
14027
14028 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
14029 @end deftypevr
14030
14031 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
14032 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
14033
14034 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
14035 @end deftypevr
14036
14037 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
14038 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
14039
14040 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
14041 @end deftypevr
14042
14043 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
14044 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
14045 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
14046 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
14047 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
14048
14049 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
14050 @end deftypevr
14051
14052 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
14053 Specifies the default access policy to use.
14054
14055 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
14056 @end deftypevr
14057
14058 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
14059 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
14060
14061 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14062 @end deftypevr
14063
14064 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
14065 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
14066 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
14067 typically within a few milliseconds.
14068
14069 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14070 @end deftypevr
14071
14072 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
14073 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
14074 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
14075 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
14076 @code{retry-this-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
14077 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
14078
14079 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
14080 @end deftypevr
14081
14082 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
14083 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
14084 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
14085 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
14086 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
14087 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
14088 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
14089 at any time.
14090
14091 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14092 @end deftypevr
14093
14094 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
14095 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
14096 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
14097 lowest priority.
14098
14099 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14100 @end deftypevr
14101
14102 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
14103 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
14104 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
14105 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
14106 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
14107 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
14108 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
14109
14110 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14111 @end deftypevr
14112
14113 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
14114 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
14115 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
14116
14117 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14118 @end deftypevr
14119
14120 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
14121 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
14122 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14123 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14124 @code{retry-current-job}.
14125
14126 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14127 @end deftypevr
14128
14129 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
14130 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
14131 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14132 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14133 @code{retry-current-job}.
14134
14135 Defaults to @samp{5}.
14136 @end deftypevr
14137
14138 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
14139 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
14140
14141 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14142 @end deftypevr
14143
14144 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
14145 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
14146
14147 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14148 @end deftypevr
14149
14150 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
14151 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
14152 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
14153
14154 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14155 @end deftypevr
14156
14157 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
14158 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
14159 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
14160 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
14161 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
14162 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
14163 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
14164 @end deftypevr
14165
14166 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
14167 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
14168 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
14169 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
14170 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
14171 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
14172 ones.
14173
14174 Defaults to @samp{128}.
14175 @end deftypevr
14176
14177 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
14178 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
14179
14180 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
14181
14182 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
14183 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
14184 @end deftypevr
14185
14186 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
14187 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
14188 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
14189
14190 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14191 @end deftypevr
14192
14193 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
14194 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
14195
14196 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14197
14198 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
14199
14200 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
14201 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
14202 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
14203
14204 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14205 @end deftypevr
14206
14207 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
14208 Methods to which this access control applies.
14209
14210 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14211 @end deftypevr
14212
14213 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
14214 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
14215 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
14216
14217 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14218 @end deftypevr
14219 @end deftypevr
14220 @end deftypevr
14221
14222 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
14223 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
14224 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
14225 of the LogLevel setting.
14226
14227 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14228 @end deftypevr
14229
14230 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
14231 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
14232 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
14233
14234 Defaults to @samp{info}.
14235 @end deftypevr
14236
14237 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
14238 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
14239 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
14240
14241 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
14242 @end deftypevr
14243
14244 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
14245 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
14246 the scheduler.
14247
14248 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14249 @end deftypevr
14250
14251 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
14252 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
14253 from a single address.
14254
14255 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14256 @end deftypevr
14257
14258 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
14259 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
14260 job.
14261
14262 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
14263 @end deftypevr
14264
14265 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
14266 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
14267 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
14268 held jobs.
14269
14270 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14271 @end deftypevr
14272
14273 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
14274 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
14275 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
14276
14277 Defaults to @samp{500}.
14278 @end deftypevr
14279
14280 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
14281 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
14282 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
14283
14284 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14285 @end deftypevr
14286
14287 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
14288 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
14289 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
14290
14291 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14292 @end deftypevr
14293
14294 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
14295 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
14296 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
14297
14298 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
14299 @end deftypevr
14300
14301 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
14302 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
14303 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
14304
14305 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
14306 @end deftypevr
14307
14308 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
14309 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
14310 multiple file print job, in seconds.
14311
14312 Defaults to @samp{300}.
14313 @end deftypevr
14314
14315 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
14316 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
14317 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
14318 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
14319 sequences are recognized:
14320
14321 @table @samp
14322 @item %%
14323 insert a single percent character
14324
14325 @item %@{name@}
14326 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
14327
14328 @item %C
14329 insert the number of copies for the current page
14330
14331 @item %P
14332 insert the current page number
14333
14334 @item %T
14335 insert the current date and time in common log format
14336
14337 @item %j
14338 insert the job ID
14339
14340 @item %p
14341 insert the printer name
14342
14343 @item %u
14344 insert the username
14345 @end table
14346
14347 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
14348 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
14349 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
14350 standard items.
14351
14352 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14353 @end deftypevr
14354
14355 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
14356 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
14357 of strings.
14358
14359 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14360 @end deftypevr
14361
14362 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
14363 Specifies named access control policies.
14364
14365 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
14366
14367 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
14368 Name of the policy.
14369 @end deftypevr
14370
14371 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
14372 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
14373 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
14374 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
14375 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
14376 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
14377 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
14378 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
14379 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
14380 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
14381
14382 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
14383 @end deftypevr
14384
14385 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
14386 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
14387 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
14388
14389 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
14390 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
14391 @end deftypevr
14392
14393 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
14394 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
14395 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
14396 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
14397 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
14398 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
14399 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
14400 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
14401 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
14402 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
14403
14404 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
14405 @end deftypevr
14406
14407 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
14408 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
14409 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
14410
14411 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
14412 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
14413 @end deftypevr
14414
14415 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
14416 Access control by IPP operation.
14417
14418 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14419 @end deftypevr
14420 @end deftypevr
14421
14422 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
14423 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
14424 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
14425 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
14426 value applies indefinitely.
14427
14428 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
14429 @end deftypevr
14430
14431 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
14432 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
14433 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
14434 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
14435 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
14436
14437 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14438 @end deftypevr
14439
14440 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
14441 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
14442 restarting the scheduler.
14443
14444 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14445 @end deftypevr
14446
14447 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
14448 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
14449 into bitmaps for a printer.
14450
14451 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
14452 @end deftypevr
14453
14454 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
14455 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
14456
14457 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
14458 @end deftypevr
14459
14460 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
14461 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
14462 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
14463 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
14464 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
14465 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
14466 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
14467 @code{*}.
14468
14469 Defaults to @samp{*}.
14470 @end deftypevr
14471
14472 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
14473 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
14474
14475 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
14476 @end deftypevr
14477
14478 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
14479 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
14480 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
14481 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
14482 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
14483 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
14484 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
14485 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
14486
14487 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
14488 @end deftypevr
14489
14490 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string set-env
14491 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
14492
14493 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
14494 @end deftypevr
14495
14496 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
14497 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
14498 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
14499 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
14500 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
14501
14502 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14503 @end deftypevr
14504
14505 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
14506 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
14507 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. The
14508 @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher suites, which are
14509 required for some older clients that do not implement newer ones. The
14510 @code{AllowSSL3} option enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some
14511 older clients that do not support TLS v1.0.
14512
14513 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14514 @end deftypevr
14515
14516 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
14517 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
14518 the IPP specifications.
14519
14520 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14521 @end deftypevr
14522
14523 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
14524 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
14525
14526 Defaults to @samp{300}.
14527
14528 @end deftypevr
14529
14530 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
14531 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
14532
14533 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14534 @end deftypevr
14535
14536 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
14537 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
14538 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
14539 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
14540 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
14541 @code{cups-service-type}.
14542
14543 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
14544
14545 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
14546 The CUPS package.
14547 @end deftypevr
14548
14549 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
14550 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
14551 @end deftypevr
14552
14553 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
14554 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
14555 @end deftypevr
14556
14557 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
14558 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
14559 this:
14560
14561 @example
14562 (service cups-service-type
14563 (opaque-cups-configuration
14564 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
14565 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
14566 @end example
14567
14568
14569 @node Desktop Services
14570 @subsection Desktop Services
14571
14572 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
14573 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
14574 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
14575 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
14576 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
14577
14578 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
14579 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
14580 environment and networking:
14581
14582 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
14583 This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
14584 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
14585
14586 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
14587 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
14588 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}), energy and color
14589 management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the
14590 Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
14591 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system
14592 passwords, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi
14593 daemon, and has the name service switch service configured to be able to
14594 use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
14595 @end defvr
14596
14597 The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
14598 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
14599 Reference, @code{services}}).
14600
14601 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
14602 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type} and
14603 @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type} procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE
14604 and/or Enlightenment to a system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level
14605 services like the backlight adjustment helpers and the power management
14606 utilities are added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
14607 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
14608 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
14609 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds the GNOME
14610 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce service
14611 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
14612 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
14613 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
14614 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
14615 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
14616 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
14617 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
14618 adding a service of type @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE
14619 metapackage to the system profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that
14620 @code{dbus} is extended appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries
14621 are set as setuid, allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other
14622 functionality to work as expetected.
14623
14624 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
14625 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
14626 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
14627 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
14628 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
14629 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
14630 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
14631 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
14632
14633 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
14634 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
14635 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
14636 object (see below.)
14637
14638 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
14639 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
14640 @end defvr
14641
14642 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
14643 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
14644
14645 @table @asis
14646 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
14647 The GNOME package to use.
14648 @end table
14649 @end deftp
14650
14651 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
14652 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
14653 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
14654 (see below.)
14655
14656 This service that adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
14657 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
14658 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
14659 with the administrator's password.
14660 @end defvr
14661
14662 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
14663 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
14664
14665 @table @asis
14666 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
14667 The Xfce package to use.
14668 @end table
14669 @end deftp
14670
14671 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
14672 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
14673 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
14674 object (see below.)
14675
14676 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
14677 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
14678 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
14679 @end deffn
14680
14681 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
14682 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
14683
14684 @table @asis
14685 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
14686 The MATE package to use.
14687 @end table
14688 @end deftp
14689
14690 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
14691 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
14692 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
14693 @end deffn
14694
14695 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
14696 @table @asis
14697 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
14698 The enlightenment package to use.
14699 @end table
14700 @end deftp
14701
14702 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
14703 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
14704 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
14705 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
14706 @code{operating-system}:
14707
14708 @example
14709 (use-modules (gnu))
14710 (use-service-modules desktop)
14711 (operating-system
14712 ...
14713 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
14714 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
14715 (service xfce-desktop-service)
14716 %desktop-services))
14717 ...)
14718 @end example
14719
14720 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
14721 graphical login window.
14722
14723 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
14724 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
14725 are described below.
14726
14727 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
14728 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
14729 support for @var{services}.
14730
14731 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
14732 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
14733 and to be notified of system-wide events.
14734
14735 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
14736 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
14737 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
14738 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
14739 @end deffn
14740
14741 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
14742 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
14743 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
14744 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
14745 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
14746 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
14747
14748 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
14749 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
14750 when the power button is pressed.
14751
14752 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
14753 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
14754 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
14755 their default values are:
14756
14757 @table @code
14758 @item kill-user-processes?
14759 @code{#f}
14760 @item kill-only-users
14761 @code{()}
14762 @item kill-exclude-users
14763 @code{("root")}
14764 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
14765 @code{5}
14766 @item handle-power-key
14767 @code{poweroff}
14768 @item handle-suspend-key
14769 @code{suspend}
14770 @item handle-hibernate-key
14771 @code{hibernate}
14772 @item handle-lid-switch
14773 @code{suspend}
14774 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
14775 @code{ignore}
14776 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
14777 @code{#f}
14778 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
14779 @code{#f}
14780 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
14781 @code{#f}
14782 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
14783 @code{#t}
14784 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
14785 @code{30}
14786 @item idle-action
14787 @code{ignore}
14788 @item idle-action-seconds
14789 @code{(* 30 60)}
14790 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
14791 @code{10}
14792 @item runtime-directory-size
14793 @code{#f}
14794 @item remove-ipc?
14795 @code{#t}
14796 @item suspend-state
14797 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
14798 @item suspend-mode
14799 @code{()}
14800 @item hibernate-state
14801 @code{("disk")}
14802 @item hibernate-mode
14803 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
14804 @item hybrid-sleep-state
14805 @code{("disk")}
14806 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
14807 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
14808 @end table
14809 @end deffn
14810
14811 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
14812 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
14813 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
14814 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
14815 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
14816 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
14817 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
14818 accountsservice web site} for more information.
14819
14820 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
14821 package to expose as a service.
14822 @end deffn
14823
14824 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
14825 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
14826 Return a service that runs the
14827 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
14828 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
14829 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
14830 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
14831 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
14832 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
14833 @end deffn
14834
14835 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
14836 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
14837 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
14838 configuration settings.
14839
14840 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
14841 notably used by GNOME.
14842 @end defvr
14843
14844 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
14845 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
14846
14847 @table @asis
14848
14849 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
14850 Package to use for @code{upower}.
14851
14852 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
14853 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
14854
14855 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
14856 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
14857
14858 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
14859 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
14860
14861 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
14862 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
14863 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
14864
14865 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
14866 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
14867 at which the battery is considered low.
14868
14869 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
14870 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
14871 at which the battery is considered critical.
14872
14873 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
14874 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
14875 at which action will be taken.
14876
14877 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
14878 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
14879 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
14880
14881 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
14882 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
14883 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
14884
14885 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
14886 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
14887 seconds at which action will be taken.
14888
14889 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
14890 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
14891 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
14892
14893 Possible values are:
14894
14895 @itemize @bullet
14896 @item
14897 @code{'power-off}
14898
14899 @item
14900 @code{'hibernate}
14901
14902 @item
14903 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
14904 @end itemize
14905
14906 @end table
14907 @end deftp
14908
14909 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
14910 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
14911 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
14912 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
14913 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
14914 @end deffn
14915
14916 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
14917 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
14918 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
14919 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
14920 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
14921 site} for more information.
14922 @end deffn
14923
14924 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
14925 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
14926 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
14927 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
14928 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
14929 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
14930 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
14931 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
14932 means that all users are allowed.
14933 @end deffn
14934
14935 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
14936 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
14937 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
14938 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
14939 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
14940 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
14941 know the user's location.
14942 @end defvr
14943
14944 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
14945 [#:whitelist '()] @
14946 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
14947 [#:submit-data? #f]
14948 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
14949 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
14950 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
14951 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
14952 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
14953 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
14954 location databases. See
14955 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
14956 web site} for more information.
14957 @end deffn
14958
14959 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
14960 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
14961 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
14962 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
14963 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
14964 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
14965 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
14966
14967 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
14968 @end deffn
14969
14970 @node Sound Services
14971 @subsection Sound Services
14972
14973 @cindex sound support
14974 @cindex ALSA
14975 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
14976
14977 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
14978 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
14979 preferred ALSA output driver.
14980
14981 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
14982 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
14983 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
14984 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
14985 record as in this example:
14986
14987 @example
14988 (service alsa-service-type)
14989 @end example
14990
14991 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
14992 @end deffn
14993
14994 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
14995 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
14996
14997 @table @asis
14998 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
14999 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
15000
15001 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
15002 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
15003 @uref{http://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
15004
15005 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
15006 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
15007 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
15008
15009 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
15010 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
15011
15012 @end table
15013 @end deftp
15014
15015 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
15016 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
15017
15018 @example
15019 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
15020 pcm_type.jack @{
15021 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
15022 @}
15023
15024 # Routing ALSA to jack:
15025 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
15026 pcm.rawjack @{
15027 type jack
15028 playback_ports @{
15029 0 system:playback_1
15030 1 system:playback_2
15031 @}
15032
15033 capture_ports @{
15034 0 system:capture_1
15035 1 system:capture_2
15036 @}
15037 @}
15038
15039 pcm.!default @{
15040 type plug
15041 slave @{
15042 pcm "rawjack"
15043 @}
15044 @}
15045 @end example
15046
15047 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
15048 details.
15049
15050
15051 @node Database Services
15052 @subsection Database Services
15053
15054 @cindex database
15055 @cindex SQL
15056 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
15057
15058 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
15059 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
15060 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8''] [#:extension-packages '()]
15061 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
15062 server.
15063
15064 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
15065 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
15066 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
15067
15068 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
15069 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
15070 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
15071 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
15072 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
15073
15074 @cindex postgis
15075 @example
15076 (use-package-modules databases geo)
15077
15078 (operating-system
15079 ...
15080 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
15081 ;; proper operation.
15082 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
15083 (services
15084 (cons*
15085 (postgresql-service #:extension-packages (list postgis))
15086 %base-services)))
15087 @end example
15088
15089 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
15090 database in this way:
15091
15092 @example
15093 psql -U postgres
15094 > create database postgistest;
15095 > \connect postgistest;
15096 > create extension postgis;
15097 > create extension postgis_topology;
15098 @end example
15099
15100 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
15101 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
15102 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
15103 @end deffn
15104
15105 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
15106 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
15107 database server.
15108
15109 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
15110 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
15111 @end deffn
15112
15113 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
15114 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
15115
15116 @table @asis
15117 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
15118 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
15119 or @var{mysql}.
15120
15121 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
15122 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
15123
15124 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
15125 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
15126 @end table
15127 @end deftp
15128
15129 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
15130 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
15131 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
15132 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
15133 @end defvr
15134
15135 @example
15136 (service memcached-service-type)
15137 @end example
15138
15139 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
15140 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
15141
15142 @table @asis
15143 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
15144 The Memcached package to use.
15145
15146 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
15147 Network interfaces on which to listen.
15148
15149 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
15150 Port on which to accept connections on,
15151
15152 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
15153 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
15154 listening on a UDP socket.
15155
15156 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
15157 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
15158 @end table
15159 @end deftp
15160
15161 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
15162 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
15163 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
15164 @end defvr
15165
15166 @example
15167 (service mongodb-service-type)
15168 @end example
15169
15170 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
15171 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
15172
15173 @table @asis
15174 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
15175 The MongoDB package to use.
15176
15177 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
15178 The configuration file for MongoDB.
15179
15180 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
15181 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
15182 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
15183 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
15184 @end table
15185 @end deftp
15186
15187 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
15188 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
15189 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
15190 @end defvr
15191
15192 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
15193 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
15194
15195 @table @asis
15196 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
15197 The Redis package to use.
15198
15199 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
15200 Network interface on which to listen.
15201
15202 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
15203 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
15204 listening on a TCP socket.
15205
15206 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
15207 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
15208 @end table
15209 @end deftp
15210
15211 @node Mail Services
15212 @subsection Mail Services
15213
15214 @cindex mail
15215 @cindex email
15216 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
15217 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
15218 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
15219 in the subsections below.
15220
15221 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
15222
15223 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
15224 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
15225 @end deffn
15226
15227 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
15228 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
15229 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
15230 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
15231 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
15232 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
15233 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
15234 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
15235
15236 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
15237 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
15238
15239 @example
15240 (dovecot-service #:config
15241 (dovecot-configuration
15242 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
15243 @end example
15244
15245 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
15246 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
15247 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
15248 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
15249 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
15250 from some other system; see the end for more details.
15251
15252 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
15253 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
15254 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
15255 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
15256 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
15257 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
15258 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
15259
15260 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
15261
15262 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
15263 The dovecot package.
15264 @end deftypevr
15265
15266 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
15267 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
15268 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
15269 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
15270 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
15271 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
15272 @end deftypevr
15273
15274 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
15275 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
15276 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
15277
15278 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
15279
15280 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
15281 The name of the protocol.
15282 @end deftypevr
15283
15284 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
15285 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
15286 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
15287 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
15288 @end deftypevr
15289
15290 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
15291 Space separated list of plugins to load.
15292 @end deftypevr
15293
15294 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
15295 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
15296 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
15297 Defaults to @samp{10}.
15298 @end deftypevr
15299
15300 @end deftypevr
15301
15302 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
15303 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
15304 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
15305 @samp{lmtp}.
15306
15307 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
15308
15309 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
15310 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
15311 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
15312 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
15313 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
15314 @end deftypevr
15315
15316 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
15317 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
15318 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
15319 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
15320 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15321
15322 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
15323
15324 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
15325 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
15326 the section name.
15327 @end deftypevr
15328
15329 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
15330 The access mode for the socket.
15331 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
15332 @end deftypevr
15333
15334 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
15335 The user to own the socket.
15336 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15337 @end deftypevr
15338
15339 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
15340 The group to own the socket.
15341 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15342 @end deftypevr
15343
15344
15345 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
15346
15347 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
15348 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
15349 the section name.
15350 @end deftypevr
15351
15352 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
15353 The access mode for the socket.
15354 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
15355 @end deftypevr
15356
15357 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
15358 The user to own the socket.
15359 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15360 @end deftypevr
15361
15362 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
15363 The group to own the socket.
15364 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15365 @end deftypevr
15366
15367
15368 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
15369
15370 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
15371 The protocol to listen for.
15372 @end deftypevr
15373
15374 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
15375 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
15376 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15377 @end deftypevr
15378
15379 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
15380 The port on which to listen.
15381 @end deftypevr
15382
15383 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
15384 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
15385 @samp{required}.
15386 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15387 @end deftypevr
15388
15389 @end deftypevr
15390
15391 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
15392 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
15393 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
15394 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
15395 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
15396
15397 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15398
15399 @end deftypevr
15400
15401 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
15402 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
15403 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
15404 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
15405 Defaults to @samp{1}.
15406
15407 @end deftypevr
15408
15409 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
15410 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
15411 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
15412
15413 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15414
15415 @end deftypevr
15416
15417 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
15418 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
15419 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15420 @end deftypevr
15421
15422 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
15423 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
15424 this.
15425 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
15426 @end deftypevr
15427
15428 @end deftypevr
15429
15430 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
15431 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
15432 constructor.
15433
15434 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
15435
15436 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
15437 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
15438 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15439 @end deftypevr
15440
15441 @end deftypevr
15442
15443 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
15444 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
15445 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
15446
15447 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
15448
15449 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
15450 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
15451 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
15452 @samp{static}.
15453 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
15454 @end deftypevr
15455
15456 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
15457 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
15458 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15459 @end deftypevr
15460
15461 @end deftypevr
15462
15463 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
15464 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
15465 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
15466
15467 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
15468
15469 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
15470 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
15471 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
15472 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
15473 @end deftypevr
15474
15475 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
15476 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
15477 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15478 @end deftypevr
15479
15480 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
15481 Override fields from passwd.
15482 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15483 @end deftypevr
15484
15485 @end deftypevr
15486
15487 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
15488 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
15489 constructor.
15490 @end deftypevr
15491
15492 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
15493 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
15494 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
15495
15496 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
15497
15498 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
15499 Name for this namespace.
15500 @end deftypevr
15501
15502 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
15503 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
15504 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
15505 @end deftypevr
15506
15507 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
15508 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
15509 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
15510 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
15511 format.
15512 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15513 @end deftypevr
15514
15515 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
15516 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
15517 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
15518 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15519 @end deftypevr
15520
15521 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
15522 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
15523 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
15524 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15525 @end deftypevr
15526
15527 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
15528 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
15529 namespace has it.
15530 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15531 @end deftypevr
15532
15533 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
15534 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
15535 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
15536 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
15537 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
15538 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
15539 and @samp{mail/}.
15540 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15541 @end deftypevr
15542
15543 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
15544 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
15545 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
15546 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
15547 hides the namespace prefix.
15548 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15549 @end deftypevr
15550
15551 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
15552 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
15553 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
15554 as @code{#t}).
15555 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15556 @end deftypevr
15557
15558 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
15559 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
15560 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15561
15562 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
15563
15564 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
15565 Name for this mailbox.
15566 @end deftypevr
15567
15568 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
15569 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
15570 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
15571 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
15572 @end deftypevr
15573
15574 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
15575 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
15576 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
15577 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
15578 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15579 @end deftypevr
15580
15581 @end deftypevr
15582
15583 @end deftypevr
15584
15585 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
15586 Base directory where to store runtime data.
15587 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
15588 @end deftypevr
15589
15590 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
15591 Greeting message for clients.
15592 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
15593 @end deftypevr
15594
15595 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
15596 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
15597 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
15598 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
15599 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
15600 here.
15601 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15602 @end deftypevr
15603
15604 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
15605 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
15606 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15607 @end deftypevr
15608
15609 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
15610 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
15611 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
15612 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
15613 accounts).
15614 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15615 @end deftypevr
15616
15617 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
15618 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
15619 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
15620 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
15621 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
15622 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15623 @end deftypevr
15624
15625 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
15626 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
15627 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
15628 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15629 @end deftypevr
15630
15631 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
15632 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
15633 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
15634 @end deftypevr
15635
15636 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
15637 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
15638 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
15639 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
15640 @end deftypevr
15641
15642 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
15643 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
15644 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
15645 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
15646 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
15647 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
15648 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15649 @end deftypevr
15650
15651 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
15652 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
15653 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
15654 for caching to be used.
15655 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15656 @end deftypevr
15657
15658 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
15659 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
15660 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
15661 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
15662 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
15663 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
15664 authentication.
15665 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
15666 @end deftypevr
15667
15668 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
15669 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
15670 0 disables caching them completely.
15671 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
15672 @end deftypevr
15673
15674 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
15675 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
15676 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
15677 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
15678 realm first.
15679 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15680 @end deftypevr
15681
15682 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
15683 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
15684 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
15685 logins.
15686 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15687 @end deftypevr
15688
15689 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
15690 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
15691 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
15692 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
15693 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
15694 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
15695 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
15696 @end deftypevr
15697
15698 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
15699 Username character translations before it's looked up from
15700 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
15701 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
15702 translated to @samp{@@}.
15703 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15704 @end deftypevr
15705
15706 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
15707 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
15708 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
15709 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
15710 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
15711 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
15712 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
15713 @end deftypevr
15714
15715 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
15716 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
15717 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
15718 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
15719 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
15720 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
15721 choice.
15722 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15723 @end deftypevr
15724
15725 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
15726 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
15727 mechanism.
15728 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
15729 @end deftypevr
15730
15731 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
15732 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
15733 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
15734 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
15735 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15736 @end deftypevr
15737
15738 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
15739 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
15740 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
15741 allow all keytab entries.
15742 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15743 @end deftypevr
15744
15745 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
15746 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
15747 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
15748 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
15749 file.
15750 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15751 @end deftypevr
15752
15753 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
15754 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
15755 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
15756 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
15757 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15758 @end deftypevr
15759
15760 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
15761 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
15762 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
15763 @end deftypevr
15764
15765 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
15766 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
15767 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
15768 @end deftypevr
15769
15770 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
15771 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
15772 fails.
15773 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15774 @end deftypevr
15775
15776 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
15777 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
15778 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
15779 CommonName.
15780 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15781 @end deftypevr
15782
15783 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
15784 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
15785 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
15786 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
15787 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
15788 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
15789 @end deftypevr
15790
15791 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
15792 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
15793 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
15794 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
15795 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15796 @end deftypevr
15797
15798 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
15799 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
15800 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
15801 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15802 @end deftypevr
15803
15804 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
15805 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
15806 has any connections.
15807 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
15808 @end deftypevr
15809
15810 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
15811 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
15812 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
15813 are shared within domain.
15814 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
15815 @end deftypevr
15816
15817 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
15818 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
15819 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
15820 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
15821 @end deftypevr
15822
15823 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
15824 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
15825 @samp{log-path}.
15826 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15827 @end deftypevr
15828
15829 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
15830 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
15831 @samp{info-log-path}.
15832 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15833 @end deftypevr
15834
15835 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
15836 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
15837 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
15838 standard facilities are supported.
15839 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
15840 @end deftypevr
15841
15842 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
15843 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
15844 failed.
15845 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15846 @end deftypevr
15847
15848 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
15849 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
15850 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
15851 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
15852 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
15853 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
15854 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15855 @end deftypevr
15856
15857 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
15858 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
15859 SQL queries.
15860 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15861 @end deftypevr
15862
15863 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
15864 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
15865 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
15866 @samp{auth-debug}.
15867 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15868 @end deftypevr
15869
15870 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
15871 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
15872 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
15873 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15874 @end deftypevr
15875
15876 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
15877 Show protocol level SSL errors.
15878 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15879 @end deftypevr
15880
15881 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
15882 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
15883 strftime(3) format.
15884 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
15885 @end deftypevr
15886
15887 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
15888 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
15889 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
15890 string.
15891 @end deftypevr
15892
15893 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
15894 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
15895 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
15896 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
15897 @end deftypevr
15898
15899 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
15900 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
15901 of possible variables you can use.
15902 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
15903 @end deftypevr
15904
15905 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
15906 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
15907 @table @code
15908 @item %$
15909 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
15910 @item %m
15911 Message-ID
15912 @item %s
15913 Subject
15914 @item %f
15915 From address
15916 @item %p
15917 Physical size
15918 @item %w
15919 Virtual size.
15920 @end table
15921 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
15922 @end deftypevr
15923
15924 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
15925 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
15926 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
15927 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
15928 Dovecot the full location.
15929
15930 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
15931 file (e.g.@: /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
15932 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
15933 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
15934 @samp{mail-location} setting.
15935
15936 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
15937
15938 @table @samp
15939 @item %u
15940 username
15941 @item %n
15942 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
15943 @item %d
15944 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
15945 @item %h
15946 home director
15947 @end table
15948
15949 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
15950 @table @samp
15951 @item maildir:~/Maildir
15952 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
15953 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
15954 @end table
15955 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15956 @end deftypevr
15957
15958 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
15959 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
15960 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
15961 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
15962 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15963 @end deftypevr
15964
15965 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
15966
15967 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15968 @end deftypevr
15969
15970 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
15971 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
15972 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
15973 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
15974 /var/mail.
15975 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15976 @end deftypevr
15977
15978 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
15979 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
15980 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
15981 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
15982 symlinks (e.g.@: if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
15983 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
15984 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
15985 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15986 @end deftypevr
15987
15988 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
15989 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
15990 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
15991 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
15992 names with e.g.@: /path/ or ~user/.
15993 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15994 @end deftypevr
15995
15996 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
15997 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
15998 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
15999 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16000 @end deftypevr
16001
16002 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
16003 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
16004 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
16005 nowadays by default.
16006 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16007 @end deftypevr
16008
16009 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
16010 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
16011 @table @code
16012 @item optimized
16013 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
16014 @item always
16015 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when write()s are delayed
16016 @item never
16017 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
16018 @end table
16019 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
16020 @end deftypevr
16021
16022 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
16023 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
16024 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
16025 this isn't needed.
16026 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16027 @end deftypevr
16028
16029 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
16030 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
16031 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
16032 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16033 @end deftypevr
16034
16035 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
16036 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
16037 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
16038 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
16039 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
16040 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
16041 @end deftypevr
16042
16043 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
16044 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
16045 kB.
16046 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
16047 @end deftypevr
16048
16049 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
16050 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
16051 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
16052 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
16053 is set to 0.
16054 Defaults to @samp{500}.
16055 @end deftypevr
16056
16057 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
16058
16059 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16060 @end deftypevr
16061
16062 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
16063 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
16064 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
16065 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
16066 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16067 @end deftypevr
16068
16069 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
16070
16071 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16072 @end deftypevr
16073
16074 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
16075 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
16076 trying to create new keywords.
16077 Defaults to @samp{50}.
16078 @end deftypevr
16079
16080 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
16081 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
16082 processes (i.e.@: /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
16083 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
16084 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
16085 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
16086 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
16087 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
16088 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
16089 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16090 @end deftypevr
16091
16092 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
16093 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
16094 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
16095 directory (e.g.@: /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
16096 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
16097 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
16098 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/."@: to
16099 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
16100 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16101 @end deftypevr
16102
16103 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
16104 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
16105 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
16106 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
16107 @end deftypevr
16108
16109 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
16110 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
16111 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
16112 @end deftypevr
16113
16114 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
16115 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
16116 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
16117 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16118 @end deftypevr
16119
16120 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
16121 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
16122 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
16123 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
16124 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16125 @end deftypevr
16126
16127 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
16128 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
16129 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
16130 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
16131 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
16132 occur.
16133 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
16134 @end deftypevr
16135
16136 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
16137 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
16138 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
16139 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
16140 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
16141 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
16142 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16143 @end deftypevr
16144
16145 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
16146 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
16147 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
16148 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
16149 causes more disk I/O.
16150 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
16151 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
16152 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16153 @end deftypevr
16154
16155 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
16156 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
16157 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
16158 side effects.
16159 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16160 @end deftypevr
16161
16162 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
16163 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
16164 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
16165 the mail otherwise.
16166 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16167 @end deftypevr
16168
16169 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
16170 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
16171 available:
16172
16173 @table @code
16174 @item dotlock
16175 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
16176 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
16177 need write access to that directory.
16178 @item dotlock-try
16179 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
16180 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
16181 @item fcntl
16182 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
16183 @item flock
16184 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
16185 @item lockf
16186 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
16187 @end table
16188
16189 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
16190 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
16191 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
16192 them simultaneously.
16193 @end deftypevr
16194
16195 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
16196
16197 @end deftypevr
16198
16199 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
16200 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
16201 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
16202 @end deftypevr
16203
16204 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
16205 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
16206 override the lock file after this much time.
16207 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
16208 @end deftypevr
16209
16210 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
16211 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
16212 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
16213 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
16214 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
16215 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
16216 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
16217 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
16218 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
16219 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
16220 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16221 @end deftypevr
16222
16223 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
16224 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
16225 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
16226 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
16227 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16228 @end deftypevr
16229
16230 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
16231 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
16232 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
16233 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
16234 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
16235 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16236 @end deftypevr
16237
16238 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
16239 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
16240 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
16241 updated.
16242 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16243 @end deftypevr
16244
16245 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
16246 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
16247 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
16248 @end deftypevr
16249
16250 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
16251 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
16252 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
16253 disabled.
16254 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
16255 @end deftypevr
16256
16257 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
16258 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
16259 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
16260 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
16261 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16262 @end deftypevr
16263
16264 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
16265 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
16266 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
16267 don't support this for now.
16268
16269 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
16270
16271 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
16272 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16273 @end deftypevr
16274
16275 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
16276 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
16277 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
16278 externally.
16279 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
16280 @end deftypevr
16281
16282 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
16283 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
16284 @table @code
16285 @item posix
16286 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
16287 @item sis posix
16288 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
16289 @item sis-queue posix
16290 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
16291 @end table
16292 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
16293 @end deftypevr
16294
16295 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
16296 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
16297 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
16298 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
16299 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
16300 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
16301 @end deftypevr
16302
16303 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
16304
16305 Defaults to @samp{100}.
16306 @end deftypevr
16307
16308 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
16309
16310 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
16311 @end deftypevr
16312
16313 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
16314 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
16315 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
16316 before they eat up everything.
16317 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
16318 @end deftypevr
16319
16320 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
16321 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
16322 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
16323 at all.
16324 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
16325 @end deftypevr
16326
16327 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
16328 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
16329 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
16330 processes.
16331 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
16332 @end deftypevr
16333
16334 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
16335 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
16336 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
16337 @end deftypevr
16338
16339 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
16340 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
16341 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
16342 @end deftypevr
16343
16344 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
16345 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
16346 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
16347 root.
16348 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
16349 @end deftypevr
16350
16351 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
16352 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
16353 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
16354 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
16355 instead to a different.
16356 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16357 @end deftypevr
16358
16359 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
16360 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
16361 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
16362 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
16363 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
16364 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16365 @end deftypevr
16366
16367 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
16368 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
16369 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16370 @end deftypevr
16371
16372 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
16373 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
16374 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
16375 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16376 @end deftypevr
16377
16378 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
16379 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
16380 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
16381 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
16382 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
16383 @end deftypevr
16384
16385 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
16386 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
16387 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
16388 @end deftypevr
16389
16390 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
16391 SSL ciphers to use.
16392 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
16393 @end deftypevr
16394
16395 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
16396 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
16397 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16398 @end deftypevr
16399
16400 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
16401 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
16402 %d expands to recipient domain.
16403 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
16404 @end deftypevr
16405
16406 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
16407 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
16408 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
16409 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16410 @end deftypevr
16411
16412 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
16413 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
16414 bouncing the mail.
16415 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16416 @end deftypevr
16417
16418 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
16419 Binary to use for sending mails.
16420 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
16421 @end deftypevr
16422
16423 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
16424 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
16425 sendmail.
16426 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16427 @end deftypevr
16428
16429 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
16430 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
16431 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
16432 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
16433 @end deftypevr
16434
16435 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
16436 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
16437 variables:
16438
16439 @table @code
16440 @item %n
16441 CRLF
16442 @item %r
16443 reason
16444 @item %s
16445 original subject
16446 @item %t
16447 recipient
16448 @end table
16449 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
16450 @end deftypevr
16451
16452 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
16453 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
16454 address.
16455 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
16456 @end deftypevr
16457
16458 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
16459 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
16460 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
16461 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
16462 X-Original-To.
16463 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16464 @end deftypevr
16465
16466 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
16467 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
16468 it?.
16469 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16470 @end deftypevr
16471
16472 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
16473 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
16474 subscribed?.
16475 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16476 @end deftypevr
16477
16478 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
16479 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
16480 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
16481 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
16482 often.
16483 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
16484 @end deftypevr
16485
16486 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
16487 IMAP logout format string:
16488 @table @code
16489 @item %i
16490 total number of bytes read from client
16491 @item %o
16492 total number of bytes sent to client.
16493 @end table
16494 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
16495 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
16496 @end deftypevr
16497
16498 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
16499 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
16500 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
16501 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16502 @end deftypevr
16503
16504 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
16505 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
16506 is IDLEing.
16507 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
16508 @end deftypevr
16509
16510 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
16511 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
16512 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
16513 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
16514 support-email.
16515 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16516 @end deftypevr
16517
16518 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
16519 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
16520 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16521 @end deftypevr
16522
16523 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
16524 Workarounds for various client bugs:
16525
16526 @table @code
16527 @item delay-newmail
16528 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
16529 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
16530 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
16531 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
16532 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
16533 "Headers Only".
16534
16535 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
16536 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
16537 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
16538 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
16539
16540 @item tb-lsub-flags
16541 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
16542 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
16543 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
16544 @end table
16545 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16546 @end deftypevr
16547
16548 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
16549 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
16550 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16551 @end deftypevr
16552
16553
16554 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
16555 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
16556 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
16557 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
16558 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
16559
16560 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
16561 and running. In that case, you can pass an
16562 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
16563 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
16564 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
16565
16566 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
16567
16568 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
16569 The dovecot package.
16570 @end deftypevr
16571
16572 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
16573 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
16574 @end deftypevr
16575
16576 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
16577 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
16578
16579 @example
16580 (dovecot-service #:config
16581 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
16582 (string "")))
16583 @end example
16584
16585 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
16586
16587 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
16588 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
16589 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
16590 as in this example:
16591
16592 @example
16593 (service opensmtpd-service-type
16594 (opensmtpd-configuration
16595 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
16596 @end example
16597 @end deffn
16598
16599 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
16600 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
16601
16602 @table @asis
16603 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
16604 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
16605
16606 @item @code{config-file} (default: @var{%default-opensmtpd-file})
16607 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
16608 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
16609 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
16610 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
16611
16612 @end table
16613 @end deftp
16614
16615 @subsubheading Exim Service
16616
16617 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
16618 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
16619 @cindex SMTP
16620
16621 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
16622 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
16623 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
16624 as in this example:
16625
16626 @example
16627 (service exim-service-type
16628 (exim-configuration
16629 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
16630 @end example
16631 @end deffn
16632
16633 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
16634 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
16635 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
16636
16637 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
16638 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
16639
16640 @table @asis
16641 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
16642 Package object of the Exim server.
16643
16644 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16645 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
16646 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
16647 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
16648 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
16649 variables.
16650
16651 @end table
16652 @end deftp
16653
16654 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
16655
16656 @cindex email aliases
16657 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
16658
16659 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
16660 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
16661 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
16662
16663 @example
16664 (service mail-aliases-service-type
16665 '(("postmaster" "bob")
16666 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
16667 @end example
16668 @end deffn
16669
16670 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
16671 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
16672 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
16673 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
16674 where to deliver this user's mail.
16675
16676 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
16677 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
16678 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
16679 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
16680 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
16681
16682 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
16683 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
16684
16685 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
16686 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
16687 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
16688 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
16689
16690 @example
16691 (service imap4d-service-type
16692 (imap4d-configuration
16693 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
16694 @end example
16695 @end deffn
16696
16697 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
16698 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
16699
16700 @table @asis
16701 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
16702 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
16703
16704 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
16705 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
16706 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
16707 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
16708
16709 @end table
16710 @end deftp
16711
16712 @node Messaging Services
16713 @subsection Messaging Services
16714
16715 @cindex messaging
16716 @cindex jabber
16717 @cindex XMPP
16718 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
16719 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
16720
16721 @subsubheading Prosody Service
16722
16723 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
16724 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
16725 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
16726 record as in this example:
16727
16728 @example
16729 (service prosody-service-type
16730 (prosody-configuration
16731 (modules-enabled (cons "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
16732 (int-components
16733 (list
16734 (int-component-configuration
16735 (hostname "conference.example.net")
16736 (plugin "muc")
16737 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
16738 (virtualhosts
16739 (list
16740 (virtualhost-configuration
16741 (domain "example.net"))))))
16742 @end example
16743
16744 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
16745
16746 @end deffn
16747
16748 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
16749 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
16750 Prosody to serve.
16751
16752 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
16753 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
16754
16755 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
16756 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
16757 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
16758
16759 @example
16760 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
16761 @end example
16762
16763 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
16764 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
16765 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
16766 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
16767 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
16768
16769 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
16770 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
16771 some other system; see the end for more details.
16772
16773 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
16774 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
16775
16776 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
16777 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
16778 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
16779 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
16780 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
16781 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
16782 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
16783
16784 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
16785
16786 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
16787 The Prosody package.
16788 @end deftypevr
16789
16790 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
16791 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
16792 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
16793 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
16794 @end deftypevr
16795
16796 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
16797 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
16798 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
16799 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16800 @end deftypevr
16801
16802 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
16803 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
16804 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
16805 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
16806 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
16807 @end deftypevr
16808
16809 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
16810 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
16811 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
16812 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
16813 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
16814 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16815 @end deftypevr
16816
16817 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
16818 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
16819 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
16820 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16821 @end deftypevr
16822
16823 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
16824 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
16825 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
16826 Documentation on modules can be found at:
16827 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
16828 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
16829 @end deftypevr
16830
16831 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
16832 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
16833 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
16834 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16835 @end deftypevr
16836
16837 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
16838 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
16839 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
16840 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
16841 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
16842 @end deftypevr
16843
16844 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
16845 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
16846 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
16847 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16848 @end deftypevr
16849
16850 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
16851 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
16852 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
16853 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
16854 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
16855
16856 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
16857
16858 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
16859 This determines what handshake to use.
16860 @end deftypevr
16861
16862 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
16863 Path to your private key file.
16864 @end deftypevr
16865
16866 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
16867 Path to your certificate file.
16868 @end deftypevr
16869
16870 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
16871 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
16872 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
16873 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
16874 @end deftypevr
16875
16876 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
16877 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
16878 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
16879 @end deftypevr
16880
16881 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
16882 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
16883 @code{set_verify()} flags).
16884 @end deftypevr
16885
16886 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
16887 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
16888 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
16889 LuaSec source.
16890 @end deftypevr
16891
16892 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
16893 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
16894 trusted root certificate.
16895 @end deftypevr
16896
16897 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
16898 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
16899 clients, and in what order.
16900 @end deftypevr
16901
16902 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
16903 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
16904 can create such a file with:
16905 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
16906 @end deftypevr
16907
16908 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
16909 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
16910 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
16911 @end deftypevr
16912
16913 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
16914 A list of "extra" verification options.
16915 @end deftypevr
16916
16917 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
16918 Password for encrypted private keys.
16919 @end deftypevr
16920
16921 @end deftypevr
16922
16923 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
16924 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
16925 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
16926 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16927 @end deftypevr
16928
16929 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
16930 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
16931 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
16932 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
16933 @end deftypevr
16934
16935 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
16936 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
16937 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
16938 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16939 @end deftypevr
16940
16941 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
16942 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
16943 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
16944 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
16945 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
16946 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16947 @end deftypevr
16948
16949 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
16950 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
16951 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
16952 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
16953 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
16954 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16955 @end deftypevr
16956
16957 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
16958 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
16959 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
16960 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
16961 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16962 @end deftypevr
16963
16964 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
16965 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
16966 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
16967 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
16968 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
16969 about using the hashed backend. See also
16970 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
16971 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
16972 @end deftypevr
16973
16974 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
16975 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
16976 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
16977 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
16978 @end deftypevr
16979
16980 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
16981 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
16982 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
16983 @end deftypevr
16984
16985 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
16986 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
16987 @end deftypevr
16988
16989 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
16990 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
16991 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
16992 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
16993 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
16994 @end deftypevr
16995
16996 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
16997 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
16998 example if you want your users to have addresses like
16999 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
17000 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
17001
17002 Note: the name "virtual" host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
17003 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
17004 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
17005 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
17006 have just one VirtualHost entry.
17007
17008 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
17009
17010 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
17011
17012 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17013 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
17014 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
17015 @end deftypevr
17016
17017 @end deftypevr
17018
17019 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
17020 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
17021 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
17022 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
17023 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
17024
17025 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
17026 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
17027 to use for the component.
17028
17029 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
17030 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17031
17032 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
17033
17034 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17035 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17036 Hostname of the component.
17037 @end deftypevr
17038
17039 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
17040 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
17041 @end deftypevr
17042
17043 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
17044 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
17045 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
17046
17047 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
17048 in the "Chatrooms" documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
17049 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
17050
17051 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
17052
17053 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
17054
17055 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
17056 The name to return in service discovery responses.
17057 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
17058 @end deftypevr
17059
17060 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
17061 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
17062 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
17063 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
17064 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
17065 restricts to service administrators only.
17066 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17067 @end deftypevr
17068
17069 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
17070 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
17071 just joined the room.
17072 Defaults to @samp{20}.
17073 @end deftypevr
17074
17075 @end deftypevr
17076
17077 @end deftypevr
17078
17079 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
17080 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
17081 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
17082 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
17083 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17084
17085 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
17086
17087 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17088 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
17089 Password which the component will use to log in.
17090 @end deftypevr
17091
17092 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17093 Hostname of the component.
17094 @end deftypevr
17095
17096 @end deftypevr
17097
17098 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
17099 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
17100 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
17101 @end deftypevr
17102
17103 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
17104 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
17105 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
17106 @end deftypevr
17107
17108 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
17109 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
17110 @end deftypevr
17111
17112 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
17113 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
17114 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
17115 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
17116 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
17117 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
17118
17119 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
17120 The prosody package.
17121 @end deftypevr
17122
17123 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
17124 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
17125 @end deftypevr
17126
17127 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
17128 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
17129
17130 @example
17131 (service prosody-service-type
17132 (opaque-prosody-configuration
17133 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
17134 @end example
17135
17136 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
17137
17138 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
17139
17140 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
17141 @cindex IRC gateway
17142 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
17143 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
17144
17145 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
17146 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
17147 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
17148 below).
17149
17150 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
17151 services:
17152
17153 @example
17154 (service bitlbee-service-type)
17155 @end example
17156 @end defvr
17157
17158 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
17159 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
17160
17161 @table @asis
17162 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
17163 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
17164 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
17165 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
17166
17167 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
17168 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
17169 networking interface.
17170
17171 @item @code{package} (default: @code{bitlbee})
17172 The BitlBee package to use.
17173
17174 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
17175 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
17176
17177 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
17178 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
17179 @end table
17180 @end deftp
17181
17182 @subsubheading Quassel Service
17183
17184 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
17185 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
17186 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
17187 central core.
17188
17189 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
17190 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
17191 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
17192 (see below).
17193 @end defvr
17194
17195 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
17196 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
17197
17198 @table @asis
17199 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
17200 The Quassel package to use.
17201
17202 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
17203 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
17204 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
17205 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
17206 @var{port}.
17207
17208 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
17209 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
17210 and Error.
17211 @end table
17212 @end deftp
17213
17214 @node Telephony Services
17215 @subsection Telephony Services
17216
17217 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
17218 @cindex VoIP server
17219 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
17220 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
17221 (VoIP) suite.
17222
17223 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
17224 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
17225 look like this:
17226
17227 @example
17228 (service murmur-service-type
17229 (murmur-configuration
17230 (welcome-text
17231 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
17232 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
17233 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
17234 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
17235 @end example
17236
17237 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
17238 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
17239
17240 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
17241 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
17242 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
17243 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
17244 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
17245 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
17246 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
17247 rights and create some channels.
17248
17249 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
17250
17251 @table @asis
17252 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
17253 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
17254
17255 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
17256 User who will run the Murmur server.
17257
17258 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
17259 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
17260
17261 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
17262 Port on which the server will listen.
17263
17264 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
17265 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
17266
17267 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
17268 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
17269
17270 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
17271 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
17272
17273 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
17274 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
17275
17276 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
17277 File name of the sqlite database.
17278 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
17279
17280 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
17281 File name of the log file.
17282 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
17283
17284 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
17285 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
17286 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
17287
17288 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
17289 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
17290
17291 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
17292 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
17293 when violating the autoban limits.
17294
17295 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
17296 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
17297 before switching over to opus audio codec.
17298
17299 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
17300 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
17301
17302 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
17303 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
17304
17305 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
17306 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
17307
17308 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
17309 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
17310
17311 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
17312 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
17313
17314 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
17315 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentification
17316 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
17317
17318 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
17319 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
17320 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
17321
17322 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
17323 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
17324
17325 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
17326 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
17327 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
17328 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
17329
17330 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
17331
17332 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
17333 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
17334
17335 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
17336 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
17337
17338 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
17339 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
17340 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
17341 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
17342
17343 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
17344 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
17345
17346 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
17347 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
17348
17349 @example
17350 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
17351 @end example
17352 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
17353 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
17354 @example
17355 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
17356 @end example
17357
17358 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
17359 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
17360 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
17361 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
17362 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
17363
17364 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
17365 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
17366 in SSL/TLS.
17367
17368 This option is specified using
17369 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
17370 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
17371
17372 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
17373 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
17374 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
17375 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
17376
17377 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
17378 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
17379 to connect to it.
17380
17381 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
17382 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
17383
17384 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
17385 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
17386 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
17387 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
17388
17389 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
17390
17391 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
17392 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
17393 @end table
17394 @end deftp
17395
17396 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
17397 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
17398
17399 @table @asis
17400 @item @code{name}
17401 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
17402
17403 @item @code{password}
17404 A password to identify your registration.
17405 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
17406
17407 @item @code{url}
17408 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
17409 site.
17410
17411 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
17412 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
17413 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
17414 @end table
17415 @end deftp
17416
17417
17418
17419 @node Monitoring Services
17420 @subsection Monitoring Services
17421
17422 @subsubheading Tailon Service
17423
17424 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
17425 viewing and searching log files.
17426
17427 The following example will configure the service with default values.
17428 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
17429
17430 @example
17431 (service tailon-service-type)
17432 @end example
17433
17434 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
17435 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
17436
17437 @example
17438 (service tailon-service-type
17439 (tailon-configuration
17440 (config-file
17441 (tailon-configuration-file
17442 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
17443 @end example
17444
17445
17446 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
17447 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
17448 This type has the following parameters:
17449
17450 @table @asis
17451 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
17452 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
17453 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
17454 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
17455
17456 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
17457 can be used:
17458
17459 @example
17460 (service tailon-service-type
17461 (tailon-configuration
17462 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
17463 @end example
17464
17465 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
17466 The tailon package to use.
17467
17468 @end table
17469 @end deftp
17470
17471 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
17472 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
17473 This type has the following parameters:
17474
17475 @table @asis
17476 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
17477 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
17478 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
17479 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
17480 subsection.
17481
17482 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
17483 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
17484
17485 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
17486 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
17487
17488 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
17489 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
17490
17491 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
17492 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
17493
17494 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
17495 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
17496
17497 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
17498 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
17499
17500 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
17501 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
17502
17503 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
17504 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
17505 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
17506 wrap lines.
17507
17508 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
17509 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
17510 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
17511 @code{"basic"}.
17512
17513 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
17514 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
17515 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
17516 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
17517 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
17518
17519 @example
17520 (tailon-configuration-file
17521 (http-auth "basic")
17522 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
17523 ("user2" . "password2"))))
17524 @end example
17525
17526 @end table
17527 @end deftp
17528
17529
17530 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
17531 @cindex darkstat
17532 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
17533 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
17534
17535 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
17536 This is the service type for the
17537 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
17538 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
17539 this example:
17540
17541 @example
17542 (service darkstat-service-type
17543 (darkstat-configuration
17544 (interface "eno1")))
17545 @end example
17546 @end defvar
17547
17548 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
17549 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
17550
17551 @table @asis
17552 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
17553 The darkstat package to use.
17554
17555 @item @code{interface}
17556 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
17557
17558 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
17559 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
17560
17561 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
17562 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
17563
17564 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
17565 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
17566 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
17567
17568 @end table
17569 @end deftp
17570
17571 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
17572
17573 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
17574 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
17575 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
17576 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
17577 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
17578
17579 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
17580 This is the service type for the
17581 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
17582 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}
17583 record as in this example:
17584
17585 @example
17586 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
17587 (prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
17588 (web-listen-address ":9100")))
17589 @end example
17590 @end defvar
17591
17592 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
17593 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
17594
17595 @table @asis
17596 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
17597 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
17598
17599 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
17600 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
17601
17602 @end table
17603 @end deftp
17604
17605 @subsubheading Zabbix server
17606 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
17607 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
17608 and disk space consumption:
17609
17610 @itemize
17611 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
17612 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
17613 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
17614 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
17615 @item Native high performance agents.
17616 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
17617 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
17618 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
17619 @end itemize
17620
17621 @c %start of fragment
17622
17623 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
17624
17625 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
17626 The zabbix-server package.
17627
17628 @end deftypevr
17629
17630 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
17631 User who will run the Zabbix server.
17632
17633 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
17634
17635 @end deftypevr
17636
17637 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
17638 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
17639
17640 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
17641
17642 @end deftypevr
17643
17644 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
17645 Database host name.
17646
17647 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
17648
17649 @end deftypevr
17650
17651 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
17652 Database name.
17653
17654 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
17655
17656 @end deftypevr
17657
17658 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
17659 Database user.
17660
17661 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
17662
17663 @end deftypevr
17664
17665 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
17666 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
17667 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
17668
17669 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17670
17671 @end deftypevr
17672
17673 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
17674 Database port.
17675
17676 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
17677
17678 @end deftypevr
17679
17680 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
17681 Specifies where log messages are written to:
17682
17683 @itemize @bullet
17684 @item
17685 @code{system} - syslog.
17686
17687 @item
17688 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
17689
17690 @item
17691 @code{console} - standard output.
17692
17693 @end itemize
17694
17695 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17696
17697 @end deftypevr
17698
17699 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
17700 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
17701
17702 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
17703
17704 @end deftypevr
17705
17706 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
17707 Name of PID file.
17708
17709 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
17710
17711 @end deftypevr
17712
17713 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
17714 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
17715 certificate verification.
17716
17717 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
17718
17719 @end deftypevr
17720
17721 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
17722 Location of SSL client certificates.
17723
17724 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
17725
17726 @end deftypevr
17727
17728 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
17729 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
17730
17731 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17732
17733 @end deftypevr
17734
17735 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
17736 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
17737 configuration file.
17738
17739 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17740
17741 @end deftypevr
17742
17743 @c %end of fragment
17744
17745 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
17746 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
17747
17748 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
17749
17750 @c %start of fragment
17751
17752 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
17753
17754 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
17755 The zabbix-agent package.
17756
17757 @end deftypevr
17758
17759 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
17760 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
17761
17762 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
17763
17764 @end deftypevr
17765
17766 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
17767 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
17768
17769 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
17770
17771 @end deftypevr
17772
17773 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17774 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
17775 must match hostname as configured on the server.
17776
17777 Defaults to @samp{"Zabbix server"}.
17778
17779 @end deftypevr
17780
17781 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
17782 Specifies where log messages are written to:
17783
17784 @itemize @bullet
17785 @item
17786 @code{system} - syslog.
17787
17788 @item
17789 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
17790
17791 @item
17792 @code{console} - standard output.
17793
17794 @end itemize
17795
17796 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17797
17798 @end deftypevr
17799
17800 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
17801 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
17802
17803 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
17804
17805 @end deftypevr
17806
17807 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
17808 Name of PID file.
17809
17810 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
17811
17812 @end deftypevr
17813
17814 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
17815 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
17816 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
17817 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
17818
17819 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
17820
17821 @end deftypevr
17822
17823 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
17824 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
17825 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
17826 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
17827
17828 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
17829
17830 @end deftypevr
17831
17832 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
17833 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
17834
17835 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17836
17837 @end deftypevr
17838
17839 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
17840 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
17841 configuration file.
17842
17843 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17844
17845 @end deftypevr
17846
17847 @c %end of fragment
17848
17849 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
17850 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
17851
17852 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
17853
17854 @c %start of fragment
17855
17856 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
17857
17858 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
17859 NGINX configuration.
17860
17861 @end deftypevr
17862
17863 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
17864 Database host name.
17865
17866 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
17867
17868 @end deftypevr
17869
17870 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
17871 Database port.
17872
17873 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
17874
17875 @end deftypevr
17876
17877 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
17878 Database name.
17879
17880 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
17881
17882 @end deftypevr
17883
17884 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
17885 Database user.
17886
17887 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
17888
17889 @end deftypevr
17890
17891 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
17892 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
17893
17894 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17895
17896 @end deftypevr
17897
17898 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
17899 Secret file which will be appended to @file{zabbix.conf.php} file. This
17900 file contains credentials for use by Zabbix front-end. You are expected
17901 to create it manually.
17902
17903 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17904
17905 @end deftypevr
17906
17907 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
17908 Zabbix server hostname.
17909
17910 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
17911
17912 @end deftypevr
17913
17914 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
17915 Zabbix server port.
17916
17917 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
17918
17919 @end deftypevr
17920
17921
17922 @c %end of fragment
17923
17924 @node Kerberos Services
17925 @subsection Kerberos Services
17926 @cindex Kerberos
17927
17928 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
17929 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
17930
17931 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
17932
17933 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
17934 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
17935 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
17936 operating system declaration.
17937 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
17938
17939 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
17940 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
17941 Other implementations have not been tested.
17942
17943 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
17944 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
17945 @end defvr
17946
17947 @noindent
17948 Here is an example of its use:
17949 @lisp
17950 (service krb5-service-type
17951 (krb5-configuration
17952 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
17953 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
17954 (realms (list
17955 (krb5-realm
17956 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
17957 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
17958 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
17959 (krb5-realm
17960 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
17961 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
17962 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
17963 @end lisp
17964
17965 @noindent
17966 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
17967 @itemize
17968 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
17969 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
17970 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
17971 specified by clients;
17972 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
17973 @end itemize
17974
17975 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
17976 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
17977 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
17978 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
17979 documentation.
17980
17981
17982 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
17983 @cindex realm, kerberos
17984 @table @asis
17985 @item @code{name}
17986 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
17987 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
17988 converted to upper case.
17989
17990 @item @code{admin-server}
17991 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
17992 running.
17993
17994 @item @code{kdc}
17995 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
17996 for the realm.
17997 @end table
17998 @end deftp
17999
18000 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
18001
18002 @table @asis
18003 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
18004 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
18005 known to be weak will be accepted.
18006
18007 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
18008 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
18009 realm for the client.
18010 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
18011 If this value is @code{#f}
18012 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
18013 such as @command{kinit}.
18014
18015 @item @code{realms}
18016 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
18017 access.
18018 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
18019 field.
18020 @end table
18021 @end deftp
18022
18023
18024 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
18025 @cindex pam-krb5
18026
18027 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
18028 management via Kerberos.
18029 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
18030 users using Kerberos.
18031
18032 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
18033 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
18034 @end defvr
18035
18036 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
18037 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
18038 This type has the following parameters:
18039 @table @asis
18040 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
18041 The pam-krb5 package to use.
18042
18043 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
18044 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
18045 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
18046 @end table
18047 @end deftp
18048
18049
18050 @node LDAP Services
18051 @subsection LDAP Services
18052 @cindex LDAP
18053 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
18054
18055 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
18056 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
18057 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
18058 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
18059 Switch} for detailed information.
18060
18061 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
18062 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
18063 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
18064
18065 @example
18066 (use-service-modules authentication)
18067 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
18068 ...
18069 (operating-system
18070 ...
18071 (services
18072 (cons*
18073 (service nslcd-service-type)
18074 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
18075 %base-services))
18076 (name-service-switch
18077 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
18078 (name-service (name "files"))
18079 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
18080 (name-service-switch
18081 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
18082 (password services)
18083 (shadow services)
18084 (group services)
18085 (netgroup services)
18086 (gshadow services)))))
18087 @end example
18088
18089 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
18090
18091 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
18092
18093 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
18094 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
18095
18096 @end deftypevr
18097
18098 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
18099 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
18100 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
18101 The default is to start 5 threads.
18102
18103 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18104
18105 @end deftypevr
18106
18107 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
18108 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
18109
18110 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
18111
18112 @end deftypevr
18113
18114 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
18115 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
18116
18117 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
18118
18119 @end deftypevr
18120
18121 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
18122 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
18123 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols "none"
18124 or "syslog", or an absolute file name. The LEVEL argument is optional
18125 and specifies the log level. The log level may be one of the following
18126 symbols: "crit", "error", "warning", "notice", "info" or "debug". All
18127 messages with the specified log level or higher are logged.
18128
18129 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
18130
18131 @end deftypevr
18132
18133 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
18134 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
18135 used with the following servers as fall-back.
18136
18137 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
18138
18139 @end deftypevr
18140
18141 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
18142 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
18143 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
18144
18145 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18146
18147 @end deftypevr
18148
18149 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
18150 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
18151 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
18152
18153 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18154
18155 @end deftypevr
18156
18157 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
18158 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
18159 applicable when used with binddn.
18160
18161 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18162
18163 @end deftypevr
18164
18165 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
18166 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
18167 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
18168
18169 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18170
18171 @end deftypevr
18172
18173 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
18174 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
18175 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
18176 rootpwmoddn
18177
18178 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18179
18180 @end deftypevr
18181
18182 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
18183 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
18184 authentication.
18185
18186 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18187
18188 @end deftypevr
18189
18190 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
18191 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
18192
18193 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18194
18195 @end deftypevr
18196
18197 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
18198 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
18199 authentication.
18200
18201 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18202
18203 @end deftypevr
18204
18205 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
18206 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
18207 authentication.
18208
18209 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18210
18211 @end deftypevr
18212
18213 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
18214 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
18215 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
18216 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
18217 performed or not.
18218
18219 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18220
18221 @end deftypevr
18222
18223 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
18224 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
18225
18226 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18227
18228 @end deftypevr
18229
18230 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
18231 The directory search base.
18232
18233 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
18234
18235 @end deftypevr
18236
18237 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
18238 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
18239 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
18240 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
18241
18242 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
18243
18244 @end deftypevr
18245
18246 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
18247 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
18248 to never dereference aliases.
18249
18250 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18251
18252 @end deftypevr
18253
18254 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
18255 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
18256 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
18257
18258 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18259
18260 @end deftypevr
18261
18262 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
18263 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
18264 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
18265 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
18266 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
18267
18268 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18269
18270 @end deftypevr
18271
18272 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
18273 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
18274 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
18275
18276 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18277
18278 @end deftypevr
18279
18280 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
18281 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
18282 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
18283
18284 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18285
18286 @end deftypevr
18287
18288 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
18289 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
18290 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
18291 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
18292
18293 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18294
18295 @end deftypevr
18296
18297 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
18298 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
18299 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
18300 out connections.
18301
18302 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18303
18304 @end deftypevr
18305
18306 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
18307 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
18308 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
18309 failure and the first retry.
18310
18311 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18312
18313 @end deftypevr
18314
18315 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
18316 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
18317 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
18318 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
18319
18320 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18321
18322 @end deftypevr
18323
18324 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
18325 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
18326 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
18327 SSL.
18328
18329 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18330
18331 @end deftypevr
18332
18333 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
18334 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
18335 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
18336
18337 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18338
18339 @end deftypevr
18340
18341 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
18342 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
18343 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
18344
18345 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18346
18347 @end deftypevr
18348
18349 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
18350 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
18351
18352 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18353
18354 @end deftypevr
18355
18356 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
18357 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
18358 using GnuTLS.
18359
18360 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18361
18362 @end deftypevr
18363
18364 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
18365 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
18366
18367 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18368
18369 @end deftypevr
18370
18371 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
18372 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
18373 client TLS authentication.
18374
18375 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18376
18377 @end deftypevr
18378
18379 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
18380 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
18381 authentication.
18382
18383 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18384
18385 @end deftypevr
18386
18387 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
18388 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
18389 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
18390 request paged results.
18391
18392 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18393
18394 @end deftypevr
18395
18396 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
18397 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
18398 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
18399 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
18400
18401 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18402
18403 @end deftypevr
18404
18405 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
18406 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
18407 the specified value are ignored.
18408
18409 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18410
18411 @end deftypevr
18412
18413 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
18414 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
18415 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
18416
18417 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18418
18419 @end deftypevr
18420
18421 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
18422 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
18423 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
18424
18425 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18426
18427 @end deftypevr
18428
18429 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
18430 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
18431 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
18432 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
18433 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
18434 groups.
18435
18436 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18437
18438 @end deftypevr
18439
18440 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
18441 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
18442 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
18443 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
18444 groups assigned on login.
18445
18446 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18447
18448 @end deftypevr
18449
18450 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
18451 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
18452 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
18453 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
18454 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
18455 most configurations.
18456
18457 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18458
18459 @end deftypevr
18460
18461 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
18462 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
18463 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
18464 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
18465
18466 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18467
18468 @end deftypevr
18469
18470 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
18471 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
18472 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
18473 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
18474 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
18475
18476 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18477
18478 @end deftypevr
18479
18480 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
18481 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
18482 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
18483
18484 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18485
18486 @end deftypevr
18487
18488 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
18489 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
18490 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
18491 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
18492 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
18493 It should return at least one entry.
18494
18495 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18496
18497 @end deftypevr
18498
18499 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
18500 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
18501 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
18502 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
18503
18504 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18505
18506 @end deftypevr
18507
18508 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
18509 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
18510 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
18511 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
18512 changing their password.
18513
18514 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18515
18516 @end deftypevr
18517
18518 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
18519 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
18520
18521 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18522
18523 @end deftypevr
18524
18525 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
18526
18527
18528 @node Web Services
18529 @subsection Web Services
18530
18531 @cindex web
18532 @cindex www
18533 @cindex HTTP
18534 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
18535 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
18536
18537 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
18538
18539 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
18540 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
18541 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
18542 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
18543
18544 A simple example configuration is given below.
18545
18546 @example
18547 (service httpd-service-type
18548 (httpd-configuration
18549 (config
18550 (httpd-config-file
18551 (server-name "www.example.com")
18552 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
18553 @end example
18554
18555 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
18556 the configuration.
18557
18558 @example
18559 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
18560 (list
18561 (httpd-virtualhost
18562 "*:80"
18563 (list (string-append
18564 "ServerName "www.example.com
18565 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
18566 @end example
18567 @end deffn
18568
18569 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
18570 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
18571 given below.
18572
18573 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
18574 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
18575
18576 @table @asis
18577 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
18578 The httpd package to use.
18579
18580 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
18581 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
18582
18583 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
18584 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
18585 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
18586 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
18587 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
18588
18589 @end table
18590 @end deffn
18591
18592 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
18593 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
18594
18595 @table @asis
18596 @item @code{name}
18597 The name of the module.
18598
18599 @item @code{file}
18600 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
18601 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
18602 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
18603 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
18604
18605 @end table
18606 @end deffn
18607
18608 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
18609 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
18610 @end defvr
18611
18612 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
18613 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
18614
18615 @table @asis
18616 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
18617 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
18618 additional configuration.
18619
18620 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
18621 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
18622
18623 @example
18624 (service httpd-service-type
18625 (httpd-configuration
18626 (config
18627 (httpd-config-file
18628 (modules (cons*
18629 (httpd-module
18630 (name "proxy_module")
18631 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
18632 (httpd-module
18633 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
18634 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
18635 %default-httpd-modules))
18636 (extra-config (list "\
18637 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
18638 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
18639 </FilesMatch>"))))))
18640 (service php-fpm-service-type
18641 (php-fpm-configuration
18642 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
18643 (socket-group "httpd")))
18644 @end example
18645
18646 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
18647 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
18648 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
18649 taken as relative to the server root.
18650
18651 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
18652 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
18653 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
18654 itself.
18655
18656 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specifyed
18657 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
18658 @code{ServerName}.
18659
18660 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
18661 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
18662
18663 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
18664 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
18665 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
18666 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
18667 protocol to use.
18668
18669 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
18670 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
18671 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
18672 configured correctly.
18673
18674 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
18675 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
18676
18677 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
18678 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
18679
18680 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
18681 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
18682
18683 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
18684 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
18685 of the configuration file.
18686
18687 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
18688 list.
18689
18690 @end table
18691 @end deffn
18692
18693 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
18694 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
18695
18696 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
18697
18698 @example
18699 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
18700 (list
18701 (httpd-virtualhost
18702 "*:80"
18703 (list (string-append
18704 "ServerName "www.example.com
18705 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
18706 @end example
18707
18708 @table @asis
18709 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
18710 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
18711
18712 @item @code{contents}
18713 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
18714 of strings and G-expressions.
18715
18716 @end table
18717 @end deffn
18718
18719 @subsubheading NGINX
18720
18721 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
18722 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
18723 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
18724
18725 A simple example configuration is given below.
18726
18727 @example
18728 (service nginx-service-type
18729 (nginx-configuration
18730 (server-blocks
18731 (list (nginx-server-configuration
18732 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
18733 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
18734 @end example
18735
18736 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
18737 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
18738 blocks, as in this example:
18739
18740 @example
18741 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
18742 (list (nginx-server-configuration
18743 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
18744 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
18745 @end example
18746 @end deffn
18747
18748 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
18749 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
18750 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
18751 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
18752 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
18753 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
18754 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
18755 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
18756
18757 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
18758 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
18759 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
18760 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
18761
18762 @table @asis
18763 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
18764 The nginx package to use.
18765
18766 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
18767 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
18768
18769 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
18770 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
18771 files.
18772
18773 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
18774 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
18775 file, the elements should be of type
18776 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
18777
18778 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
18779 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
18780 HTTPS.
18781 @example
18782 (service nginx-service-type
18783 (nginx-configuration
18784 (server-blocks
18785 (list (nginx-server-configuration
18786 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
18787 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
18788 @end example
18789
18790 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
18791 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
18792 file, the elements should be of type
18793 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
18794
18795 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
18796 when combined with @code{locations} in the
18797 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
18798 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
18799 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
18800 requests with two servers.
18801
18802 @example
18803 (service
18804 nginx-service-type
18805 (nginx-configuration
18806 (server-blocks
18807 (list (nginx-server-configuration
18808 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
18809 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
18810 (locations
18811 (list
18812 (nginx-location-configuration
18813 (uri "/path1")
18814 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
18815 (upstream-blocks
18816 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
18817 (name "server-proxy")
18818 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
18819 "server2.example.com")))))))
18820 @end example
18821
18822 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
18823 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
18824 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
18825 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
18826 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
18827 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
18828
18829 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
18830 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
18831 nginx-configuration record.
18832
18833 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
18834 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
18835 use the size of the processors cache line.
18836
18837 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
18838 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
18839
18840 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
18841 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
18842 valued G-expression.
18843
18844 @end table
18845 @end deffn
18846
18847 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
18848 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
18849 This type has the following parameters:
18850
18851 @table @asis
18852 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
18853 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
18854 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
18855 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
18856 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
18857
18858 @example
18859 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
18860 @end example
18861
18862 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
18863 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
18864 default server for connections matching no other server.
18865
18866 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
18867 Root of the website nginx will serve.
18868
18869 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
18870 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
18871 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
18872 server block.
18873
18874 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
18875 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
18876 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
18877
18878 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
18879 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
18880 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
18881
18882 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
18883 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
18884 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
18885
18886 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
18887 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
18888 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
18889
18890 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
18891 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
18892
18893 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
18894 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
18895
18896 @end table
18897 @end deftp
18898
18899 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
18900 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
18901 block. This type has the following parameters:
18902
18903 @table @asis
18904 @item @code{name}
18905 Name for this group of servers.
18906
18907 @item @code{servers}
18908 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
18909 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
18910 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
18911 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
18912 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
18913 explicitly.
18914
18915 @end table
18916 @end deftp
18917
18918 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
18919 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
18920 block. This type has the following parameters:
18921
18922 @table @asis
18923 @item @code{uri}
18924 URI which this location block matches.
18925
18926 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
18927 @item @code{body}
18928 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
18929 many
18930 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
18931 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
18932 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
18933 http://upstream-name;")}.
18934
18935 @end table
18936 @end deftp
18937
18938 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
18939 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
18940 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
18941 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
18942 parameters:
18943
18944 @table @asis
18945 @item @code{name}
18946 Name to identify this location block.
18947
18948 @item @code{body}
18949 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
18950 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
18951 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
18952 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
18953
18954 @end table
18955 @end deftp
18956
18957 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
18958 @cindex Varnish
18959 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
18960 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
18961 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
18962 creates one request to the back-end.
18963
18964 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
18965 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
18966 @end defvr
18967
18968 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
18969 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
18970 This type has the following parameters:
18971
18972 @table @asis
18973 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
18974 The Varnish package to use.
18975
18976 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
18977 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
18978 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
18979 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
18980 directory name.
18981
18982 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
18983 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
18984
18985 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
18986 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
18987
18988 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
18989 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
18990 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
18991 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
18992 VCL syntax.
18993
18994 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
18995 For example, to mirror @url{http://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
18996 can do something along these lines:
18997
18998 @example
18999 (define %gnu-mirror
19000 (plain-file
19001 "gnu.vcl"
19002 "vcl 4.1;
19003 backend gnu @{ .host = "www.gnu.org"; @}"))
19004
19005 (operating-system
19006 ...
19007 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
19008 (varnish-configuration
19009 (listen '(":80"))
19010 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
19011 %base-services)))
19012 @end example
19013
19014 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
19015 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
19016
19017 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
19018 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
19019 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
19020
19021 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
19022 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
19023
19024 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
19025 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
19026
19027 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
19028 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
19029
19030 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
19031 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
19032
19033 @end table
19034 @end deftp
19035
19036 @subsubheading FastCGI
19037 @cindex fastcgi
19038 @cindex fcgiwrap
19039 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
19040 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
19041 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
19042 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
19043 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
19044 support for it in Guix.
19045
19046 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
19047 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
19048 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
19049 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
19050 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
19051 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
19052
19053 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
19054 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
19055 @end defvr
19056
19057 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
19058 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
19059 This type has the following parameters:
19060 @table @asis
19061 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19062 The fcgiwrap package to use.
19063
19064 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
19065 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
19066 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
19067 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
19068 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
19069 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
19070
19071 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19072 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19073 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
19074 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
19075 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
19076 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
19077
19078 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
19079 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
19080 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
19081 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end., run
19082 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
19083 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
19084 @end table
19085 @end deftp
19086
19087 @cindex php-fpm
19088 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
19089 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
19090
19091 These features include:
19092 @itemize @bullet
19093 @item Adaptive process spawning
19094 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
19095 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
19096 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
19097 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
19098 @item Stdout & stderr logging
19099 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
19100 @item Accelerated upload support
19101 @item Support for a "slowlog"
19102 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
19103 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
19104 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
19105 @end itemize
19106 ...@: and much more.
19107
19108 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
19109 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
19110 @end defvr
19111
19112 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
19113 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
19114 @table @asis
19115 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
19116 The php package to use.
19117 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
19118 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
19119 @table @asis
19120 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
19121 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
19122 @item @code{"port"}
19123 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
19124 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
19125 Listen on a unix socket.
19126 @end table
19127
19128 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19129 User who will own the php worker processes.
19130 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19131 Group of the worker processes.
19132 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19133 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
19134 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19135 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
19136 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
19137 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
19138 once the service has started.
19139 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
19140 Log for the php-fpm master process.
19141 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
19142 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
19143 Must be either:
19144 @table @asis
19145 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
19146 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
19147 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
19148 @end table
19149 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
19150 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
19151 and displayed in their browsers.
19152 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
19153 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
19154 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
19155 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
19156 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
19157 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
19158 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
19159 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
19160 An optional override of the whole configuration.
19161 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
19162 @end table
19163 @end deftp
19164
19165 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
19166 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
19167 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
19168 based on it's configured limits.
19169 @table @asis
19170 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19171 Maximum of worker processes.
19172 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
19173 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
19174 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
19175 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
19176 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
19177 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
19178 @end table
19179 @end deftp
19180
19181 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
19182 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
19183 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
19184 are created.
19185 @table @asis
19186 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19187 Maximum of worker processes.
19188 @end table
19189 @end deftp
19190
19191 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
19192 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
19193 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
19194 requests arrive.
19195 @table @asis
19196 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19197 Maximum of worker processes.
19198 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
19199 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
19200 @end table
19201 @end deftp
19202
19203
19204 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-fpm-location @
19205 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
19206 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
19207 (version-major (package-version php)) @
19208 "-fpm.sock")]
19209 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
19210 @end deffn
19211
19212 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
19213 @example
19214 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
19215 (service php-fpm-service-type)
19216 (service nginx-service-type
19217 (nginx-server-configuration
19218 (server-name '("example.com"))
19219 (root "/srv/http/")
19220 (locations
19221 (list (nginx-php-location)))
19222 (listen '("80"))
19223 (ssl-certificate #f)
19224 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
19225 %base-services))
19226 @end example
19227
19228 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
19229 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
19230 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
19231 the hash of a user's email address.
19232
19233 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
19234 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
19235 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
19236 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
19237 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
19238 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
19239 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
19240 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
19241 @end deffn
19242
19243 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
19244 @example
19245 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
19246 #:configuration
19247 (nginx-server-configuration
19248 (server-name '("example.com"))))
19249 ...
19250 %base-services))
19251 @end example
19252
19253 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
19254
19255 @cindex hpcguix-web
19256 The @uref{hpcguix-web, https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/}
19257 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
19258 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
19259 clusters.
19260
19261 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
19262 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
19263 @end defvr
19264
19265 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
19266 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
19267
19268 @table @asis
19269 @item @code{specs}
19270 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
19271 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
19272
19273 @table @asis
19274 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
19275 The page title prefix.
19276
19277 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
19278 The @command{guix} command.
19279
19280 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
19281 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
19282
19283 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
19284 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
19285
19286 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
19287 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
19288
19289 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
19290 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
19291
19292 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
19293 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
19294 the latest instances of the given channels.
19295 @end table
19296
19297 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
19298 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
19299 complete example}.
19300
19301 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
19302 The hpcguix-web package to use.
19303 @end table
19304 @end deftp
19305
19306 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
19307
19308 @example
19309 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
19310 (hpcguix-web-configuration
19311 (specs
19312 #~(define site-config
19313 (hpcweb-configuration
19314 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
19315 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
19316 @end example
19317
19318 @quotation Note
19319 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
19320 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
19321 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
19322 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
19323
19324 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
19325 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
19326 more information on X.509 certificates.
19327 @end quotation
19328
19329 @node Certificate Services
19330 @subsection Certificate Services
19331
19332 @cindex Web
19333 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
19334 @cindex Let's Encrypt
19335 @cindex TLS certificates
19336 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
19337 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
19338 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
19339 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
19340 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
19341 authenticity.
19342
19343 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
19344 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
19345 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
19346 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
19347 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
19348 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
19349 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
19350 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
19351 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
19352 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
19353 signature.
19354
19355 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
19356 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
19357 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
19358 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
19359 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
19360 with different permissions).
19361
19362 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
19363 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
19364 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
19365 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
19366 some reason.
19367
19368 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
19369 can be found there:
19370 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
19371
19372 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
19373 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
19374 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
19375
19376 @example
19377 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
19378 (program-file
19379 "nginx-deploy-hook"
19380 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
19381 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
19382
19383 (service certbot-service-type
19384 (certbot-configuration
19385 (email "foo@@example.net")
19386 (certificates
19387 (list
19388 (certificate-configuration
19389 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
19390 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
19391 (certificate-configuration
19392 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
19393 @end example
19394
19395 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
19396 @end defvr
19397
19398 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
19399 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
19400 This type has the following parameters:
19401
19402 @table @asis
19403 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
19404 The certbot package to use.
19405
19406 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
19407 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
19408 files.
19409
19410 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
19411 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
19412 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
19413 and several @code{domains}.
19414
19415 @item @code{email}
19416 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
19417 account notifications.
19418
19419 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
19420 Size of the RSA key.
19421
19422 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
19423 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
19424 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
19425 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
19426 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
19427 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
19428 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
19429 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
19430 these nginx configuration data types.
19431
19432 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
19433 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
19434 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
19435
19436 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
19437 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
19438 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
19439
19440 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
19441 @end table
19442 @end deftp
19443
19444 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
19445 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
19446 This type has the following parameters:
19447
19448 @table @asis
19449 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
19450 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
19451 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
19452 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
19453
19454 Its default is the first provided domain.
19455
19456 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
19457 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
19458 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
19459
19460 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
19461 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
19462 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
19463 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
19464 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}).
19465
19466 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
19467 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
19468 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
19469 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
19470 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
19471 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
19472
19473 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
19474 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
19475 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
19476 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
19477 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
19478 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
19479
19480 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
19481 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
19482 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
19483 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
19484 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
19485 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
19486 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
19487 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
19488
19489 @end table
19490 @end deftp
19491
19492 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
19493 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
19494 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
19495 @node DNS Services
19496 @subsection DNS Services
19497 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
19498 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
19499
19500 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
19501 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
19502 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
19503 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
19504 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
19505 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
19506
19507 @subsubheading Knot Service
19508
19509 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
19510 and one slave, is:
19511
19512 @lisp
19513 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
19514 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
19515 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
19516 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
19517 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
19518
19519 (define master-zone
19520 (knot-zone-configuration
19521 (domain "example.org")
19522 (zone (zone-file
19523 (origin "example.org")
19524 (entries example.org.zone)))))
19525
19526 (define slave-zone
19527 (knot-zone-configuration
19528 (domain "plop.org")
19529 (dnssec-policy "default")
19530 (master (list "plop-master"))))
19531
19532 (define plop-master
19533 (knot-remote-configuration
19534 (id "plop-master")
19535 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
19536
19537 (operating-system
19538 ;; ...
19539 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
19540 (knot-configuration
19541 (remotes (list plop-master))
19542 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
19543 ;; ...
19544 %base-services)))
19545 @end lisp
19546
19547 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
19548 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
19549
19550 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
19551 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
19552 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
19553 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
19554 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
19555 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
19556 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
19557
19558 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
19559 @end deffn
19560
19561 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
19562 Data type representing a key.
19563 This type has the following parameters:
19564
19565 @table @asis
19566 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
19567 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
19568 be unique and must not be empty.
19569
19570 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
19571 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
19572 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
19573 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
19574
19575 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
19576 The secret key itself.
19577
19578 @end table
19579 @end deftp
19580
19581 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
19582 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
19583 This type has the following parameters:
19584
19585 @table @asis
19586 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
19587 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
19588 unique and must not be empty.
19589
19590 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
19591 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
19592 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
19593 address match is not required.
19594
19595 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
19596 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
19597 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
19598 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
19599
19600 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
19601 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
19602 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
19603 and @code{'update}.
19604
19605 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
19606 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
19607 false, listed actions are allowed.
19608
19609 @end table
19610 @end deftp
19611
19612 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
19613 Data type represnting a record entry in a zone file.
19614 This type has the following parameters:
19615
19616 @table @asis
19617 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
19618 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
19619 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
19620 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
19621 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
19622 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
19623
19624 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
19625 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
19626
19627 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
19628 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
19629 partially @code{"CH"}.
19630
19631 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
19632 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
19633 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
19634 defined.
19635
19636 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
19637 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
19638 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
19639 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
19640
19641 @end table
19642 @end deftp
19643
19644 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
19645 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
19646 This type has the following parameters:
19647
19648 @table @asis
19649 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
19650 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
19651 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
19652 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
19653 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
19654 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
19655 field of the @code{zone-file}.
19656
19657 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
19658 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
19659
19660 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
19661 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
19662 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
19663 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
19664 to an IP address in the list of entries.
19665
19666 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
19667 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
19668 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
19669
19670 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
19671 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
19672 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
19673 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
19674
19675 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
19676 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
19677 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
19678 @code{(string->duration)}.
19679
19680 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
19681 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
19682 to do so a first time.
19683
19684 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
19685 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
19686 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
19687 and check again that it still exists.
19688
19689 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
19690 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
19691 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
19692
19693 @end table
19694 @end deftp
19695
19696 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
19697 Data type representing a remote configuration.
19698 This type has the following parameters:
19699
19700 @table @asis
19701 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
19702 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
19703 be unique and must not be empty.
19704
19705 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
19706 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
19707 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
19708 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
19709
19710 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
19711 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
19712 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
19713 The default is to choose at random.
19714
19715 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
19716 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
19717 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
19718
19719 @end table
19720 @end deftp
19721
19722 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
19723 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
19724 This type has the following parameters:
19725
19726 @table @asis
19727 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
19728 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
19729
19730 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
19731 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
19732
19733 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
19734 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
19735 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
19736 For the pem backend, the string reprensents a path in the file system.
19737
19738 @end table
19739 @end deftp
19740
19741 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
19742 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
19743 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
19744 use keys that you generate.
19745
19746 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
19747 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
19748 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
19749 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
19750 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
19751 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
19752
19753 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
19754 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
19755 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
19756 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
19757 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
19758
19759 This type has the following parameters:
19760
19761 @table @asis
19762 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
19763 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
19764
19765 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
19766 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
19767 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
19768 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
19769 was setup by this service).
19770
19771 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
19772 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
19773
19774 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
19775 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
19776
19777 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
19778 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
19779
19780 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
19781 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
19782 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
19783
19784 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
19785 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
19786 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
19787
19788 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
19789 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
19790 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
19791
19792 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
19793 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
19794
19795 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
19796 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
19797 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
19798
19799 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
19800 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
19801
19802 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
19803 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
19804
19805 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
19806 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
19807
19808 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
19809 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
19810
19811 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
19812 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
19813 name before hashing.
19814
19815 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
19816 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
19817
19818 @end table
19819 @end deftp
19820
19821 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
19822 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
19823 This type has the following parameters:
19824
19825 @table @asis
19826 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
19827 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
19828
19829 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
19830 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
19831 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
19832
19833 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
19834 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
19835 must contain a zone-file record.
19836
19837 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
19838 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
19839 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
19840
19841 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
19842 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
19843 masters.
19844
19845 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
19846 A list of slave remote identifiers.
19847
19848 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
19849 A list of acl identifiers.
19850
19851 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
19852 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
19853
19854 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
19855 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
19856
19857 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
19858 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
19859 synchronization.
19860
19861 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
19862 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
19863 are:
19864
19865 @itemize
19866 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
19867 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
19868 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
19869 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
19870 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
19871 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
19872 automatically.
19873 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
19874 @end itemize
19875
19876 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
19877 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
19878 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
19879 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
19880 default value from Knot is used.
19881
19882 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
19883 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
19884 so the default value from Knot is used.
19885
19886 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
19887 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
19888 default value from Knot is used.
19889
19890 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
19891 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
19892 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
19893 value from Knot is used.
19894
19895 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
19896 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
19897 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
19898 on this zone.
19899
19900 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
19901 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
19902
19903 @end table
19904 @end deftp
19905
19906 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
19907 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
19908 This type has the following parameters:
19909
19910 @table @asis
19911 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
19912 The Knot package.
19913
19914 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
19915 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
19916
19917 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
19918 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
19919 included at the top of the configuration file.
19920
19921 @cindex secrets, Knot service
19922 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
19923 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
19924 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
19925 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
19926 to the @code{includes} list.
19927
19928 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
19929
19930 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
19931 An ip address on which to listen.
19932
19933 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
19934 An ip address on which to listen.
19935
19936 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
19937 A port on which to listen.
19938
19939 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
19940 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
19941
19942 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
19943 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
19944
19945 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
19946 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
19947
19948 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
19949 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
19950
19951 @end table
19952 @end deftp
19953
19954 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
19955
19956 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
19957 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
19958 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
19959
19960 @example
19961 (service dnsmasq-service-type
19962 (dnsmasq-configuration
19963 (no-resolv? #t)
19964 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
19965 @end example
19966 @end deffn
19967
19968 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
19969 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
19970
19971 @table @asis
19972 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
19973 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
19974
19975 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
19976 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
19977
19978 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
19979 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
19980 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
19981
19982 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
19983 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
19984 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
19985
19986 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
19987 Listen on the given IP addresses.
19988
19989 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
19990 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
19991
19992 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
19993 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
19994
19995 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
19996 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
19997
19998 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
19999 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
20000 disables caching.
20001
20002 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
20003 When false, disable negative caching.
20004
20005 @end table
20006 @end deftp
20007
20008 @subsubheading ddclient Service
20009
20010 @cindex ddclient
20011 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
20012 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
20013 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
20014
20015 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
20016 configuration:
20017
20018 @example
20019 (service ddclient-service-type)
20020 @end example
20021
20022 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
20023 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
20024 @code{secret-file} below.) You are expected to create this file manually, in
20025 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
20026 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
20027 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}.) See the examples in the
20028 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
20029
20030 @c %start of fragment
20031
20032 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
20033
20034 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
20035 The ddclient package.
20036
20037 @end deftypevr
20038
20039 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
20040 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
20041
20042 Defaults to @samp{300}.
20043
20044 @end deftypevr
20045
20046 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
20047 Use syslog for the output.
20048
20049 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20050
20051 @end deftypevr
20052
20053 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
20054 Mail to user.
20055
20056 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
20057
20058 @end deftypevr
20059
20060 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
20061 Mail failed update to user.
20062
20063 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
20064
20065 @end deftypevr
20066
20067 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
20068 The ddclient PID file.
20069
20070 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
20071
20072 @end deftypevr
20073
20074 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
20075 Enable SSL support.
20076
20077 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20078
20079 @end deftypevr
20080
20081 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
20082 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
20083 program.
20084
20085 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
20086
20087 @end deftypevr
20088
20089 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
20090 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
20091
20092 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
20093
20094 @end deftypevr
20095
20096 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
20097 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
20098 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
20099 create it manually.
20100
20101 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
20102
20103 @end deftypevr
20104
20105 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
20106 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
20107
20108 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20109
20110 @end deftypevr
20111
20112
20113 @c %end of fragment
20114
20115
20116 @node VPN Services
20117 @subsection VPN Services
20118 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
20119 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
20120
20121 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
20122 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
20123 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
20124 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
20125
20126 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
20127 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
20128
20129 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
20130 @end deffn
20131
20132 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
20133 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
20134
20135 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
20136
20137 Both can be run simultaneously.
20138 @end deffn
20139
20140 @c %automatically generated documentation
20141
20142 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
20143
20144 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
20145 The OpenVPN package.
20146
20147 @end deftypevr
20148
20149 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
20150 The OpenVPN pid file.
20151
20152 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
20153
20154 @end deftypevr
20155
20156 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
20157 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
20158 servers.
20159
20160 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
20161
20162 @end deftypevr
20163
20164 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
20165 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
20166
20167 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
20168
20169 @end deftypevr
20170
20171 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
20172 The certificate authority to check connections against.
20173
20174 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
20175
20176 @end deftypevr
20177
20178 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
20179 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
20180 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
20181
20182 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
20183
20184 @end deftypevr
20185
20186 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
20187 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
20188 certificate is @code{cert}.
20189
20190 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
20191
20192 @end deftypevr
20193
20194 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
20195 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
20196
20197 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20198
20199 @end deftypevr
20200
20201 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
20202 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
20203
20204 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20205
20206 @end deftypevr
20207
20208 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
20209 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
20210 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
20211
20212 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20213
20214 @end deftypevr
20215
20216 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
20217 Verbosity level.
20218
20219 Defaults to @samp{3}.
20220
20221 @end deftypevr
20222
20223 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
20224 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
20225 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
20226
20227 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20228
20229 @end deftypevr
20230
20231 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
20232 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
20233
20234 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20235
20236 @end deftypevr
20237
20238 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
20239 Bind to a specific local port number.
20240
20241 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20242
20243 @end deftypevr
20244
20245 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
20246 Retry resolving server address.
20247
20248 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20249
20250 @end deftypevr
20251
20252 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
20253 A list of remote servers to connect to.
20254
20255 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20256
20257 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
20258
20259 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
20260 Server name.
20261
20262 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
20263
20264 @end deftypevr
20265
20266 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
20267 Port number the server listens to.
20268
20269 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
20270
20271 @end deftypevr
20272
20273 @end deftypevr
20274 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
20275
20276 @c %automatically generated documentation
20277
20278 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
20279
20280 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
20281 The OpenVPN package.
20282
20283 @end deftypevr
20284
20285 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
20286 The OpenVPN pid file.
20287
20288 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
20289
20290 @end deftypevr
20291
20292 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
20293 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
20294 servers.
20295
20296 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
20297
20298 @end deftypevr
20299
20300 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
20301 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
20302
20303 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
20304
20305 @end deftypevr
20306
20307 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
20308 The certificate authority to check connections against.
20309
20310 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
20311
20312 @end deftypevr
20313
20314 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
20315 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
20316 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
20317
20318 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
20319
20320 @end deftypevr
20321
20322 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
20323 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
20324 certificate is @code{cert}.
20325
20326 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
20327
20328 @end deftypevr
20329
20330 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
20331 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
20332
20333 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20334
20335 @end deftypevr
20336
20337 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
20338 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
20339
20340 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20341
20342 @end deftypevr
20343
20344 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
20345 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
20346 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
20347
20348 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20349
20350 @end deftypevr
20351
20352 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
20353 Verbosity level.
20354
20355 Defaults to @samp{3}.
20356
20357 @end deftypevr
20358
20359 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
20360 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
20361 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
20362
20363 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20364
20365 @end deftypevr
20366
20367 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
20368 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
20369
20370 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
20371
20372 @end deftypevr
20373
20374 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
20375 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
20376
20377 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
20378
20379 @end deftypevr
20380
20381 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
20382 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
20383
20384 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20385
20386 @end deftypevr
20387
20388 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
20389 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
20390
20391 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
20392
20393 @end deftypevr
20394
20395 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
20396 The file that records client IPs.
20397
20398 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
20399
20400 @end deftypevr
20401
20402 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
20403 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
20404
20405 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20406
20407 @end deftypevr
20408
20409 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
20410 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
20411
20412 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20413
20414 @end deftypevr
20415
20416 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
20417 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
20418 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
20419 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
20420 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
20421 down.
20422
20423 @end deftypevr
20424
20425 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
20426 The maximum number of clients.
20427
20428 Defaults to @samp{100}.
20429
20430 @end deftypevr
20431
20432 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
20433 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
20434 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
20435
20436 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
20437
20438 @end deftypevr
20439
20440 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
20441 The list of configuration for some clients.
20442
20443 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20444
20445 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
20446
20447 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
20448 Client name.
20449
20450 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
20451
20452 @end deftypevr
20453
20454 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
20455 Client own network
20456
20457 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20458
20459 @end deftypevr
20460
20461 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
20462 Client VPN IP.
20463
20464 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20465
20466 @end deftypevr
20467
20468 @end deftypevr
20469
20470
20471 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
20472
20473
20474 @node Network File System
20475 @subsection Network File System
20476 @cindex NFS
20477
20478 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
20479 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
20480 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
20481
20482 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
20483 @cindex rpcbind
20484
20485 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
20486 universal addresses.
20487 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
20488 started when a dependent service starts.
20489
20490 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
20491 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
20492 @end defvr
20493
20494
20495 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
20496 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
20497 This type has the following parameters:
20498 @table @asis
20499 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
20500 The rpcbind package to use.
20501
20502 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
20503 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
20504 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
20505 instance.
20506 @end table
20507 @end deftp
20508
20509
20510 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
20511 @cindex pipefs
20512 @cindex rpc_pipefs
20513
20514 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
20515 between the kernel and user space programs.
20516
20517 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
20518 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
20519 @end defvr
20520
20521 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
20522 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
20523 This type has the following parameters:
20524 @table @asis
20525 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
20526 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
20527 @end table
20528 @end deftp
20529
20530
20531 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
20532 @cindex GSSD
20533 @cindex GSS
20534 @cindex global security system
20535
20536 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
20537 based protocols.
20538 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
20539 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
20540 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
20541
20542 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
20543 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
20544 @end defvr
20545
20546 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
20547 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
20548 This type has the following parameters:
20549 @table @asis
20550 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
20551 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
20552
20553 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
20554 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
20555
20556 @end table
20557 @end deftp
20558
20559
20560 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
20561 @cindex idmapd
20562 @cindex name mapper
20563
20564 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
20565 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
20566
20567 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
20568 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
20569 @end defvr
20570
20571 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
20572 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
20573 This type has the following parameters:
20574 @table @asis
20575 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
20576 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
20577
20578 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
20579 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
20580
20581 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
20582 The local NFSv4 domain name.
20583 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
20584 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
20585
20586 @end table
20587 @end deftp
20588
20589 @node Continuous Integration
20590 @subsection Continuous Integration
20591
20592 @cindex continuous integration
20593 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
20594 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
20595 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
20596
20597 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
20598
20599 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
20600 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
20601 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
20602 @end defvr
20603
20604 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
20605 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
20606 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
20607 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
20608 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
20609
20610 @example
20611 (define %cuirass-specs
20612 #~(list
20613 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
20614 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
20615 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
20616 (#:proc-input . "guix")
20617 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
20618 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
20619 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
20620 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
20621 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
20622 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
20623 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
20624 (#:load-path . ".")
20625 (#:branch . "master")
20626 (#:no-compile? . #t))
20627 ((#:name . "config")
20628 (#:url . "git://git.example.org/config.git")
20629 (#:load-path . ".")
20630 (#:branch . "master")
20631 (#:no-compile? . #t))
20632 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
20633 (#:url . "git://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
20634 (#:load-path . ".")
20635 (#:branch . "master")
20636 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
20637
20638 (service cuirass-service-type
20639 (cuirass-configuration
20640 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
20641 @end example
20642
20643 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
20644 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
20645 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
20646
20647 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
20648 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
20649
20650 @table @asis
20651 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
20652 Location of the log file.
20653
20654 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
20655 Location of the repository cache.
20656
20657 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
20658 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
20659
20660 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
20661 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
20662
20663 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
20664 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
20665 Cuirass jobs.
20666
20667 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
20668 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
20669 added specifications.
20670
20671 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
20672 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
20673 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
20674 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
20675
20676 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
20677 Port number used by the HTTP server.
20678
20679 @item --listen=@var{host}
20680 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
20681 accept connections from localhost.
20682
20683 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
20684 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
20685 where a specification is an association list
20686 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
20687 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
20688 above.
20689
20690 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
20691 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
20692 from source.
20693
20694 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
20695 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
20696
20697 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
20698 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
20699 packages locally.
20700
20701 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
20702 The Cuirass package to use.
20703 @end table
20704 @end deftp
20705
20706 @node Power Management Services
20707 @subsection Power Management Services
20708
20709 @cindex tlp
20710 @cindex power management with TLP
20711 @subsubheading TLP daemon
20712
20713 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
20714 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
20715
20716 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
20717 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
20718 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
20719 source is detected. More information can be found at
20720 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
20721
20722 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
20723 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
20724 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
20725 write:
20726 @example
20727 (service tlp-service-type)
20728 @end example
20729 @end deffn
20730
20731 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
20732 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
20733
20734 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
20735 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
20736 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
20737 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
20738 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
20739
20740 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
20741 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
20742 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
20743 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
20744 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
20745 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
20746 @c the churn as TLP updates.
20747
20748 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
20749
20750 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
20751 The TLP package.
20752
20753 @end deftypevr
20754
20755 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
20756 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
20757
20758 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20759
20760 @end deftypevr
20761
20762 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
20763 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
20764 and BAT.
20765
20766 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
20767
20768 @end deftypevr
20769
20770 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
20771 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
20772 before syncing on AC.
20773
20774 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20775
20776 @end deftypevr
20777
20778 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
20779 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
20780
20781 Defaults to @samp{2}.
20782
20783 @end deftypevr
20784
20785 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
20786 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
20787
20788 Defaults to @samp{15}.
20789
20790 @end deftypevr
20791
20792 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
20793 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
20794
20795 Defaults to @samp{60}.
20796
20797 @end deftypevr
20798
20799 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
20800 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
20801 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
20802 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
20803
20804 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20805
20806 @end deftypevr
20807
20808 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
20809 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
20810
20811 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20812
20813 @end deftypevr
20814
20815 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
20816 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
20817
20818 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20819
20820 @end deftypevr
20821
20822 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
20823 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
20824
20825 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20826
20827 @end deftypevr
20828
20829 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
20830 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
20831
20832 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20833
20834 @end deftypevr
20835
20836 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
20837 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
20838
20839 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20840
20841 @end deftypevr
20842
20843 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
20844 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
20845 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
20846
20847 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20848
20849 @end deftypevr
20850
20851 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
20852 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
20853 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
20854
20855 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20856
20857 @end deftypevr
20858
20859 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
20860 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
20861
20862 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20863
20864 @end deftypevr
20865
20866 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
20867 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
20868
20869 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20870
20871 @end deftypevr
20872
20873 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
20874 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
20875
20876 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20877
20878 @end deftypevr
20879
20880 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
20881 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
20882
20883 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20884
20885 @end deftypevr
20886
20887 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
20888 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
20889 used under light load conditions.
20890
20891 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20892
20893 @end deftypevr
20894
20895 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
20896 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
20897
20898 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20899
20900 @end deftypevr
20901
20902 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
20903 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
20904
20905 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20906
20907 @end deftypevr
20908
20909 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
20910 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
20911 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
20912
20913 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20914
20915 @end deftypevr
20916
20917 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
20918 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
20919 performance, normal, powersave.
20920
20921 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
20922
20923 @end deftypevr
20924
20925 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
20926 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
20927
20928 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
20929
20930 @end deftypevr
20931
20932 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
20933 Hard disk devices.
20934
20935 @end deftypevr
20936
20937 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
20938 Hard disk advanced power management level.
20939
20940 @end deftypevr
20941
20942 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
20943 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
20944
20945 @end deftypevr
20946
20947 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
20948 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
20949 declared hard disk.
20950
20951 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20952
20953 @end deftypevr
20954
20955 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
20956 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
20957
20958 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20959
20960 @end deftypevr
20961
20962 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
20963 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
20964 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
20965 noop.
20966
20967 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20968
20969 @end deftypevr
20970
20971 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
20972 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
20973 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
20974
20975 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
20976
20977 @end deftypevr
20978
20979 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
20980 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
20981
20982 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
20983
20984 @end deftypevr
20985
20986 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
20987 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
20988
20989 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20990
20991 @end deftypevr
20992
20993 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
20994 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
20995 mode.
20996
20997 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20998
20999 @end deftypevr
21000
21001 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
21002 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21003
21004 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21005
21006 @end deftypevr
21007
21008 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
21009 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
21010
21011 Defaults to @samp{15}.
21012
21013 @end deftypevr
21014
21015 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
21016 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
21017 default, performance, powersave.
21018
21019 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21020
21021 @end deftypevr
21022
21023 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
21024 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
21025
21026 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
21027
21028 @end deftypevr
21029
21030 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
21031 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
21032 auto, default.
21033
21034 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
21035
21036 @end deftypevr
21037
21038 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
21039 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
21040
21041 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
21042
21043 @end deftypevr
21044
21045 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
21046 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
21047 performance.
21048
21049 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21050
21051 @end deftypevr
21052
21053 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
21054 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
21055
21056 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
21057
21058 @end deftypevr
21059
21060 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
21061 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
21062
21063 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21064
21065 @end deftypevr
21066
21067 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
21068 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
21069
21070 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21071
21072 @end deftypevr
21073
21074 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
21075 Wifi power saving mode.
21076
21077 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21078
21079 @end deftypevr
21080
21081 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
21082 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
21083
21084 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21085
21086 @end deftypevr
21087
21088 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
21089 Disable wake on LAN.
21090
21091 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21092
21093 @end deftypevr
21094
21095 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
21096 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
21097 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
21098
21099 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21100
21101 @end deftypevr
21102
21103 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
21104 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
21105
21106 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21107
21108 @end deftypevr
21109
21110 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
21111 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
21112
21113 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21114
21115 @end deftypevr
21116
21117 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
21118 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
21119 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
21120 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
21121
21122 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21123
21124 @end deftypevr
21125
21126 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
21127 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
21128
21129 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
21130
21131 @end deftypevr
21132
21133 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
21134 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
21135 and auto.
21136
21137 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
21138
21139 @end deftypevr
21140
21141 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
21142 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
21143
21144 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21145
21146 @end deftypevr
21147
21148 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
21149 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
21150 ones.
21151
21152 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21153
21154 @end deftypevr
21155
21156 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
21157 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
21158
21159 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21160
21161 @end deftypevr
21162
21163 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
21164 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
21165 Power Management.
21166
21167 @end deftypevr
21168
21169 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
21170 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
21171
21172 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21173
21174 @end deftypevr
21175
21176 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
21177 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
21178
21179 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21180
21181 @end deftypevr
21182
21183 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
21184 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
21185
21186 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21187
21188 @end deftypevr
21189
21190 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
21191 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
21192 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
21193
21194 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21195
21196 @end deftypevr
21197
21198 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
21199 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
21200
21201 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21202
21203 @end deftypevr
21204
21205 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
21206 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
21207 shutdown on system startup.
21208
21209 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21210
21211 @end deftypevr
21212
21213 @cindex thermald
21214 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
21215 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
21216
21217 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
21218 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
21219
21220 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
21221 This is the service type for
21222 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
21223 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
21224 of processors and preventing overheating.
21225 @end defvr
21226
21227 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
21228 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
21229
21230 @table @asis
21231 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
21232 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
21233
21234 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
21235 Package object of thermald.
21236
21237 @end table
21238 @end deftp
21239
21240 @node Audio Services
21241 @subsection Audio Services
21242
21243 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
21244 (the Music Player Daemon).
21245
21246 @cindex mpd
21247 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
21248
21249 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
21250 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
21251 of clients.
21252
21253 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
21254 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
21255
21256 @example
21257 (service mpd-service-type
21258 (mpd-configuration
21259 (user "bob")
21260 (port "6666")))
21261 @end example
21262
21263 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
21264 The service type for @command{mpd}
21265 @end defvr
21266
21267 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
21268 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
21269
21270 @table @asis
21271 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
21272 The user to run mpd as.
21273
21274 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
21275 The directory to scan for music files.
21276
21277 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
21278 The directory to store playlists.
21279
21280 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
21281 The location of the music database.
21282
21283 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
21284 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
21285
21286 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
21287 The location of the sticker database.
21288
21289 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
21290 The port to run mpd on.
21291
21292 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
21293 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
21294 an absolute path can be specified here.
21295
21296 @end table
21297 @end deftp
21298
21299 @node Virtualization Services
21300 @subsection Virtualization services
21301
21302 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
21303 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
21304 services.
21305
21306 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
21307 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
21308 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
21309 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
21310
21311 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
21312 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
21313 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
21314
21315 @example
21316 (service libvirt-service-type
21317 (libvirt-configuration
21318 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
21319 (tls-port "16555")))
21320 @end example
21321 @end deffn
21322
21323 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
21324 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
21325
21326 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
21327 Libvirt package.
21328
21329 @end deftypevr
21330
21331 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
21332 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
21333 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
21334
21335 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
21336 this capability.
21337
21338 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21339
21340 @end deftypevr
21341
21342 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
21343 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
21344 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
21345
21346 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
21347 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
21348 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
21349
21350 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21351
21352 @end deftypevr
21353
21354 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
21355 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
21356 service name
21357
21358 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
21359
21360 @end deftypevr
21361
21362 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
21363 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
21364 or service name
21365
21366 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
21367
21368 @end deftypevr
21369
21370 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
21371 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
21372
21373 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
21374
21375 @end deftypevr
21376
21377 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
21378 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
21379
21380 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
21381 Avahi daemon.
21382
21383 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21384
21385 @end deftypevr
21386
21387 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
21388 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
21389 broadcast network.
21390
21391 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
21392
21393 @end deftypevr
21394
21395 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
21396 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
21397 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
21398 becoming root.
21399
21400 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
21401
21402 @end deftypevr
21403
21404 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
21405 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
21406 VM status only.
21407
21408 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
21409
21410 @end deftypevr
21411
21412 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
21413 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
21414 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
21415 everyone (eg, 0777)
21416
21417 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
21418
21419 @end deftypevr
21420
21421 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
21422 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
21423 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
21424 the access to.
21425
21426 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
21427
21428 @end deftypevr
21429
21430 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
21431 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
21432
21433 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
21434
21435 @end deftypevr
21436
21437 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
21438 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
21439 permissions allow anyone to connect
21440
21441 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
21442
21443 @end deftypevr
21444
21445 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
21446 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
21447 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
21448 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
21449
21450 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
21451
21452 @end deftypevr
21453
21454 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
21455 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
21456 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
21457 scenario.
21458
21459 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
21460
21461 @end deftypevr
21462
21463 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
21464 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
21465 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
21466 by certificates.
21467
21468 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
21469 by using 'sasl' for this option
21470
21471 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
21472
21473 @end deftypevr
21474
21475 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
21476 API access control scheme.
21477
21478 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
21479 drivers can place restrictions on this.
21480
21481 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21482
21483 @end deftypevr
21484
21485 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
21486 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
21487 loaded.
21488
21489 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21490
21491 @end deftypevr
21492
21493 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
21494 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
21495 loaded.
21496
21497 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21498
21499 @end deftypevr
21500
21501 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
21502 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
21503 is loaded.
21504
21505 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21506
21507 @end deftypevr
21508
21509 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
21510 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
21511 CRL is loaded.
21512
21513 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21514
21515 @end deftypevr
21516
21517 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
21518 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
21519
21520 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
21521 certificates.
21522
21523 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21524
21525 @end deftypevr
21526
21527 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
21528 Disable verification of client certificates.
21529
21530 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
21531 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
21532 rejected.
21533
21534 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21535
21536 @end deftypevr
21537
21538 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
21539 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
21540
21541 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21542
21543 @end deftypevr
21544
21545 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
21546 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
21547 the SASL authentication mechanism.
21548
21549 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21550
21551 @end deftypevr
21552
21553 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
21554 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
21555 usually "NORMAL" unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
21556 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
21557
21558 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
21559
21560 @end deftypevr
21561
21562 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
21563 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
21564 sockets combined.
21565
21566 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
21567
21568 @end deftypevr
21569
21570 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
21571 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
21572 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
21573 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
21574
21575 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
21576
21577 @end deftypevr
21578
21579 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
21580 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
21581 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
21582
21583 Defaults to @samp{20}.
21584
21585 @end deftypevr
21586
21587 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
21588 Number of workers to start up initially.
21589
21590 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21591
21592 @end deftypevr
21593
21594 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
21595 Maximum number of worker threads.
21596
21597 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
21598 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
21599 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
21600
21601 Defaults to @samp{20}.
21602
21603 @end deftypevr
21604
21605 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
21606 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
21607 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
21608 executed in this pool.
21609
21610 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21611
21612 @end deftypevr
21613
21614 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
21615 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
21616
21617 Defaults to @samp{20}.
21618
21619 @end deftypevr
21620
21621 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
21622 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
21623 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
21624 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
21625
21626 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21627
21628 @end deftypevr
21629
21630 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
21631 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
21632
21633 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21634
21635 @end deftypevr
21636
21637 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
21638 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
21639
21640 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21641
21642 @end deftypevr
21643
21644 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
21645 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
21646
21647 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21648
21649 @end deftypevr
21650
21651 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
21652 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
21653
21654 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21655
21656 @end deftypevr
21657
21658 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
21659 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
21660
21661 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21662
21663 @end deftypevr
21664
21665 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
21666 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
21667
21668 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21669
21670 @end deftypevr
21671
21672 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
21673 Logging filters.
21674
21675 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
21676 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
21677
21678 @itemize @bullet
21679 @item
21680 x:name
21681
21682 @item
21683 x:+name
21684
21685 @end itemize
21686
21687 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
21688 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
21689 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
21690 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
21691 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
21692 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
21693 where matching messages should be logged:
21694
21695 @itemize @bullet
21696 @item
21697 1: DEBUG
21698
21699 @item
21700 2: INFO
21701
21702 @item
21703 3: WARNING
21704
21705 @item
21706 4: ERROR
21707
21708 @end itemize
21709
21710 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
21711 need to be separated by spaces.
21712
21713 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
21714
21715 @end deftypevr
21716
21717 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
21718 Logging outputs.
21719
21720 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
21721 for an output can be:
21722
21723 @table @code
21724 @item x:stderr
21725 output goes to stderr
21726
21727 @item x:syslog:name
21728 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
21729
21730 @item x:file:file_path
21731 output to a file, with the given filepath
21732
21733 @item x:journald
21734 output to journald logging system
21735
21736 @end table
21737
21738 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
21739
21740 @itemize @bullet
21741 @item
21742 1: DEBUG
21743
21744 @item
21745 2: INFO
21746
21747 @item
21748 3: WARNING
21749
21750 @item
21751 4: ERROR
21752
21753 @end itemize
21754
21755 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
21756 spaces.
21757
21758 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
21759
21760 @end deftypevr
21761
21762 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
21763 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
21764
21765 @itemize @bullet
21766 @item
21767 0: disable all auditing
21768
21769 @item
21770 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
21771
21772 @item
21773 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
21774
21775 @end itemize
21776
21777 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21778
21779 @end deftypevr
21780
21781 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
21782 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
21783
21784 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21785
21786 @end deftypevr
21787
21788 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
21789 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
21790
21791 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21792
21793 @end deftypevr
21794
21795 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
21796 Source to read host UUID.
21797
21798 @itemize @bullet
21799 @item
21800 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
21801
21802 @item
21803 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
21804
21805 @end itemize
21806
21807 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
21808 be generated.
21809
21810 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
21811
21812 @end deftypevr
21813
21814 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
21815 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
21816 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
21817 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
21818 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
21819
21820 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21821
21822 @end deftypevr
21823
21824 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
21825 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
21826 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
21827 broken.
21828
21829 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
21830 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
21831 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
21832 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
21833 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
21834 keepalive messages.
21835
21836 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21837
21838 @end deftypevr
21839
21840 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
21841 Same as above but for admin interface.
21842
21843 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21844
21845 @end deftypevr
21846
21847 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
21848 Same as above but for admin interface.
21849
21850 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21851
21852 @end deftypevr
21853
21854 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
21855 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
21856
21857 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
21858 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
21859 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
21860
21861 Defaults to @samp{5}.
21862
21863 @end deftypevr
21864
21865 @c %end of autogenerated docs
21866
21867 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
21868 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
21869 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
21870
21871 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
21872 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
21873 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
21874 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
21875 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
21876
21877 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
21878 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
21879 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
21880
21881 @example
21882 (service virtlog-service-type
21883 (virtlog-configuration
21884 (max-clients 1000)))
21885 @end example
21886 @end deffn
21887
21888 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
21889 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
21890
21891 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21892
21893 @end deftypevr
21894
21895 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
21896 Logging filters.
21897
21898 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
21899 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
21900
21901 @itemize @bullet
21902 @item
21903 x:name
21904
21905 @item
21906 x:+name
21907
21908 @end itemize
21909
21910 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
21911 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
21912 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
21913 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
21914 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
21915 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
21916 where matching messages should be logged:
21917
21918 @itemize @bullet
21919 @item
21920 1: DEBUG
21921
21922 @item
21923 2: INFO
21924
21925 @item
21926 3: WARNING
21927
21928 @item
21929 4: ERROR
21930
21931 @end itemize
21932
21933 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
21934 need to be separated by spaces.
21935
21936 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
21937
21938 @end deftypevr
21939
21940 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
21941 Logging outputs.
21942
21943 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
21944 for an output can be:
21945
21946 @table @code
21947 @item x:stderr
21948 output goes to stderr
21949
21950 @item x:syslog:name
21951 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
21952
21953 @item x:file:file_path
21954 output to a file, with the given filepath
21955
21956 @item x:journald
21957 output to journald logging system
21958
21959 @end table
21960
21961 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
21962
21963 @itemize @bullet
21964 @item
21965 1: DEBUG
21966
21967 @item
21968 2: INFO
21969
21970 @item
21971 3: WARNING
21972
21973 @item
21974 4: ERROR
21975
21976 @end itemize
21977
21978 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
21979 spaces.
21980
21981 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
21982
21983 @end deftypevr
21984
21985 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
21986 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
21987 sockets combined.
21988
21989 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
21990
21991 @end deftypevr
21992
21993 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
21994 Maximum file size before rolling over.
21995
21996 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
21997
21998 @end deftypevr
21999
22000 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
22001 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
22002
22003 Defaults to @samp{3}
22004
22005 @end deftypevr
22006
22007 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
22008
22009 @cindex emulation
22010 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
22011 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
22012 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
22013 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
22014 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
22015 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
22016
22017 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
22018 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
22019 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
22020 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
22021 emulated:
22022
22023 @example
22024 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
22025 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
22026 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64" "mips64el"))))
22027 @end example
22028
22029 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
22030 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
22031 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
22032 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
22033 @end defvr
22034
22035 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
22036 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
22037
22038 @table @asis
22039 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
22040 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
22041 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
22042
22043 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
22044 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
22045 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
22046 @code{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
22047 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
22048 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
22049
22050 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
22051 service:
22052
22053 @example
22054 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
22055 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
22056 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
22057 (guix-support? #t)))
22058 @end example
22059
22060 You can run:
22061
22062 @example
22063 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
22064 @end example
22065
22066 @noindent
22067 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
22068 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
22069 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
22070 access to!
22071
22072 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
22073 The QEMU package to use.
22074 @end table
22075 @end deftp
22076
22077 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
22078 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
22079 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
22080 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
22081 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
22082 @end deffn
22083
22084 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
22085 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
22086 @end deffn
22087
22088 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
22089 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
22090 @end deffn
22091
22092 @node Version Control Services
22093 @subsection Version Control Services
22094
22095 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
22096 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
22097 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
22098 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
22099 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
22100 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
22101 @code{cgit-service-type}.
22102
22103 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
22104
22105 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
22106 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
22107
22108 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
22109 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
22110 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
22111 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
22112 @file{/srv/git}.
22113
22114 @end deffn
22115
22116 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
22117 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
22118
22119 @table @asis
22120 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
22121 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
22122
22123 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
22124 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
22125 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
22126
22127 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
22128 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
22129 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
22130 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
22131 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
22132
22133 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
22134 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
22135 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
22136 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
22137 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
22138 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
22139 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
22140
22141 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
22142 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
22143 all.
22144
22145 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
22146 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
22147
22148 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
22149 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
22150
22151 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
22152 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
22153 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
22154
22155 @end table
22156 @end deftp
22157
22158 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
22159 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know that the data you
22160 receive was modified is really coming from the specified host, and you
22161 have your connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an
22162 authenticated and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
22163 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
22164 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
22165 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
22166 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
22167 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
22168
22169 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
22170 over HTTP.
22171
22172 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
22173 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-http-service}.
22174
22175 @table @asis
22176 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
22177 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
22178
22179 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
22180 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
22181
22182 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
22183 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
22184 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
22185
22186 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @file{/git/})
22187 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @code{/git/} prefix, this
22188 will map @code{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
22189 @code{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
22190 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
22191
22192 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
22193 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
22194 Services}.
22195 @end table
22196 @end deftp
22197
22198 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
22199 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
22200 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
22201 server.
22202
22203 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
22204 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
22205 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
22206 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
22207 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
22208
22209 @example
22210 (service nginx-service-type
22211 (nginx-configuration
22212 (server-blocks
22213 (list
22214 (nginx-server-configuration
22215 (listen '("443 ssl"))
22216 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
22217 (ssl-certificate
22218 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
22219 (ssl-certificate-key
22220 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
22221 (locations
22222 (list
22223 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
22224 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
22225 @end example
22226
22227 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
22228 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
22229 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
22230 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
22231 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
22232 @end deffn
22233
22234 @subsubheading Cgit Service
22235
22236 @cindex Cgit service
22237 @cindex Git, web interface
22238 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
22239 repositories written in C.
22240
22241 The following example will configure the service with default values.
22242 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
22243
22244 @example
22245 (service cgit-service-type)
22246 @end example
22247
22248 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
22249 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
22250
22251 @c %start of fragment
22252
22253 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
22254
22255 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
22256 The CGIT package.
22257
22258 @end deftypevr
22259
22260 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
22261 NGINX configuration.
22262
22263 @end deftypevr
22264
22265 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
22266 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
22267 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
22268
22269 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22270
22271 @end deftypevr
22272
22273 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
22274 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
22275 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
22276
22277 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22278
22279 @end deftypevr
22280
22281 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
22282 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
22283 access.
22284
22285 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22286
22287 @end deftypevr
22288
22289 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
22290 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
22291 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
22292
22293 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
22294
22295 @end deftypevr
22296
22297 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
22298 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
22299
22300 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
22301
22302 @end deftypevr
22303
22304 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
22305 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22306 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
22307
22308 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
22309
22310 @end deftypevr
22311
22312 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
22313 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22314 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
22315
22316 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22317
22318 @end deftypevr
22319
22320 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
22321 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22322 version of the repository summary page.
22323
22324 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22325
22326 @end deftypevr
22327
22328 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
22329 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22330 version of the repository index page.
22331
22332 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22333
22334 @end deftypevr
22335
22336 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
22337 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
22338 scanning a path for Git repositories.
22339
22340 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22341
22342 @end deftypevr
22343
22344 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
22345 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22346 version of the repository about page.
22347
22348 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22349
22350 @end deftypevr
22351
22352 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
22353 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22354 version of snapshots.
22355
22356 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22357
22358 @end deftypevr
22359
22360 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
22361 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
22362 caching is disabled.
22363
22364 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22365
22366 @end deftypevr
22367
22368 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
22369 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
22370
22371 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22372
22373 @end deftypevr
22374
22375 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
22376 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
22377 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
22378
22379 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22380
22381 @end deftypevr
22382
22383 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
22384 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
22385
22386 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22387
22388 @end deftypevr
22389
22390 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
22391 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
22392
22393 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22394
22395 @end deftypevr
22396
22397 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
22398 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
22399 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
22400 ordering.
22401
22402 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
22403
22404 @end deftypevr
22405
22406 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
22407 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
22408
22409 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
22410
22411 @end deftypevr
22412
22413 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
22414 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
22415 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
22416 places throughout the cgit interface.
22417
22418 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22419
22420 @end deftypevr
22421
22422 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
22423 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
22424 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
22425
22426 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22427
22428 @end deftypevr
22429
22430 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
22431 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
22432 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
22433 repository log page.
22434
22435 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22436
22437 @end deftypevr
22438
22439 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
22440 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
22441 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
22442
22443 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22444
22445 @end deftypevr
22446
22447 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
22448 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
22449 log view.
22450
22451 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22452
22453 @end deftypevr
22454
22455 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
22456 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
22457 clones.
22458
22459 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22460
22461 @end deftypevr
22462
22463 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
22464 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
22465 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
22466
22467 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22468
22469 @end deftypevr
22470
22471 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
22472 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
22473 each repo in the repository index.
22474
22475 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22476
22477 @end deftypevr
22478
22479 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
22480 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
22481 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
22482
22483 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22484
22485 @end deftypevr
22486
22487 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
22488 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
22489 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
22490
22491 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22492
22493 @end deftypevr
22494
22495 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
22496 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
22497 branches in the summary and refs views.
22498
22499 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22500
22501 @end deftypevr
22502
22503 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
22504 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
22505 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
22506 commit view.
22507
22508 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22509
22510 @end deftypevr
22511
22512 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
22513 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
22514 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
22515 commit view.
22516
22517 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22518
22519 @end deftypevr
22520
22521 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
22522 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
22523 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
22524
22525 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22526
22527 @end deftypevr
22528
22529 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
22530 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
22531 set any repo specific settings.
22532
22533 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22534
22535 @end deftypevr
22536
22537 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
22538 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
22539
22540 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
22541
22542 @end deftypevr
22543
22544 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
22545 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
22546 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
22547 "generated by..."@: message).
22548
22549 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22550
22551 @end deftypevr
22552
22553 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
22554 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
22555 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
22556
22557 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22558
22559 @end deftypevr
22560
22561 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
22562 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
22563 verbatim at the top of all pages.
22564
22565 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22566
22567 @end deftypevr
22568
22569 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
22570 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
22571 file is parsed.
22572
22573 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22574
22575 @end deftypevr
22576
22577 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
22578 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
22579 verbatim above the repository index.
22580
22581 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22582
22583 @end deftypevr
22584
22585 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
22586 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
22587 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
22588
22589 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22590
22591 @end deftypevr
22592
22593 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
22594 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
22595 in the servers timezone.
22596
22597 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22598
22599 @end deftypevr
22600
22601 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
22602 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
22603 on all cgit pages.
22604
22605 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
22606
22607 @end deftypevr
22608
22609 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
22610 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
22611
22612 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22613
22614 @end deftypevr
22615
22616 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
22617 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
22618 page.
22619
22620 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22621
22622 @end deftypevr
22623
22624 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
22625 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
22626
22627 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22628
22629 @end deftypevr
22630
22631 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
22632 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
22633
22634 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22635
22636 @end deftypevr
22637
22638 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
22639 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
22640
22641 Defaults to @samp{80}.
22642
22643 @end deftypevr
22644
22645 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
22646 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
22647 page.
22648
22649 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22650
22651 @end deftypevr
22652
22653 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
22654 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
22655 on the repository index page.
22656
22657 Defaults to @samp{80}.
22658
22659 @end deftypevr
22660
22661 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
22662 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
22663
22664 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22665
22666 @end deftypevr
22667
22668 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
22669 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
22670 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
22671
22672 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22673
22674 @end deftypevr
22675
22676 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
22677 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
22678
22679 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
22680 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
22681 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
22682
22683 @end deftypevr
22684
22685 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
22686 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
22687
22688 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22689
22690 @end deftypevr
22691
22692 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
22693 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
22694 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
22695
22696 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22697
22698 @end deftypevr
22699
22700 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
22701 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
22702
22703 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22704
22705 @end deftypevr
22706
22707 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
22708 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
22709 disabled.
22710
22711 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22712
22713 @end deftypevr
22714
22715 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
22716 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
22717 header on all pages.
22718
22719 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22720
22721 @end deftypevr
22722
22723 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
22724 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
22725 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
22726 all subdirectories will be loaded.
22727
22728 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22729
22730 @end deftypevr
22731
22732 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
22733 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
22734
22735 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22736
22737 @end deftypevr
22738
22739 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
22740 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
22741 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
22742 removed for the URL and name.
22743
22744 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22745
22746 @end deftypevr
22747
22748 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
22749 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
22750
22751 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
22752
22753 @end deftypevr
22754
22755 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
22756 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
22757
22758 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22759
22760 @end deftypevr
22761
22762 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
22763 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
22764
22765 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
22766
22767 @end deftypevr
22768
22769 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
22770 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
22771
22772 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
22773
22774 @end deftypevr
22775
22776 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
22777 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
22778 verbatim below thef "about" link on the repository index page.
22779
22780 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22781
22782 @end deftypevr
22783
22784 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
22785 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
22786
22787 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22788
22789 @end deftypevr
22790
22791 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
22792 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
22793 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
22794 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
22795 directories, considered as "hidden". Note that this does not apply to
22796 the ".git" directory in non-bare repos.
22797
22798 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22799
22800 @end deftypevr
22801
22802 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
22803 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
22804 generates links for.
22805
22806 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22807
22808 @end deftypevr
22809
22810 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
22811 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
22812 @code{scan-path}).
22813
22814 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
22815
22816 @end deftypevr
22817
22818 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
22819 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
22820 after this option will inherit the current section name.
22821
22822 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22823
22824 @end deftypevr
22825
22826 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
22827 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
22828 repository listing by name.
22829
22830 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22831
22832 @end deftypevr
22833
22834 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
22835 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
22836 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
22837
22838 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22839
22840 @end deftypevr
22841
22842 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
22843 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
22844 default.
22845
22846 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22847
22848 @end deftypevr
22849
22850 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
22851 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
22852 the tree view.
22853
22854 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22855
22856 @end deftypevr
22857
22858 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
22859 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository "summary"
22860 view.
22861
22862 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22863
22864 @end deftypevr
22865
22866 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
22867 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
22868 "summary" view.
22869
22870 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22871
22872 @end deftypevr
22873
22874 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
22875 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository "summary"
22876 view.
22877
22878 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22879
22880 @end deftypevr
22881
22882 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
22883 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
22884 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
22885
22886 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22887
22888 @end deftypevr
22889
22890 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
22891 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
22892
22893 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
22894
22895 @end deftypevr
22896
22897 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
22898 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
22899
22900 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22901
22902 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
22903
22904 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
22905 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
22906 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
22907
22908 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22909
22910 @end deftypevr
22911
22912 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
22913 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
22914
22915 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22916
22917 @end deftypevr
22918
22919 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
22920 The relative URL used to access the repository.
22921
22922 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22923
22924 @end deftypevr
22925
22926 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
22927 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
22928
22929 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22930
22931 @end deftypevr
22932
22933 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
22934 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
22935 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
22936
22937 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22938
22939 @end deftypevr
22940
22941 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
22942 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
22943
22944 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22945
22946 @end deftypevr
22947
22948 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
22949 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
22950
22951 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22952
22953 @end deftypevr
22954
22955 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
22956 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
22957 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
22958 ordering.
22959
22960 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22961
22962 @end deftypevr
22963
22964 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
22965 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
22966 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
22967 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or "master" if
22968 there is no suitable HEAD.
22969
22970 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22971
22972 @end deftypevr
22973
22974 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
22975 The value to show as repository description.
22976
22977 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22978
22979 @end deftypevr
22980
22981 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
22982 The value to show as repository homepage.
22983
22984 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22985
22986 @end deftypevr
22987
22988 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
22989 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
22990
22991 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22992
22993 @end deftypevr
22994
22995 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
22996 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
22997 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
22998
22999 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23000
23001 @end deftypevr
23002
23003 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
23004 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23005 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
23006
23007 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23008
23009 @end deftypevr
23010
23011 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
23012 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23013 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
23014
23015 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23016
23017 @end deftypevr
23018
23019 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
23020 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
23021 branches in the summary and refs views.
23022
23023 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23024
23025 @end deftypevr
23026
23027 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
23028 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
23029 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
23030
23031 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23032
23033 @end deftypevr
23034
23035 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
23036 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
23037 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
23038
23039 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23040
23041 @end deftypevr
23042
23043 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
23044 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
23045 repository index.
23046
23047 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23048
23049 @end deftypevr
23050
23051 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
23052 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
23053
23054 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23055
23056 @end deftypevr
23057
23058 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
23059 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
23060 on this repo’s pages.
23061
23062 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23063
23064 @end deftypevr
23065
23066 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
23067 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
23068
23069 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23070
23071 @end deftypevr
23072
23073 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
23074 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
23075
23076 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23077
23078 @end deftypevr
23079
23080 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
23081 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23082 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
23083 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
23084
23085 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23086
23087 @end deftypevr
23088
23089 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
23090 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23091 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
23092 listing.
23093
23094 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23095
23096 @end deftypevr
23097
23098 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
23099 Override the default maximum statistics period.
23100
23101 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23102
23103 @end deftypevr
23104
23105 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
23106 The value to show as repository name.
23107
23108 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23109
23110 @end deftypevr
23111
23112 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
23113 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
23114
23115 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23116
23117 @end deftypevr
23118
23119 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
23120 An absolute path to the repository directory.
23121
23122 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23123
23124 @end deftypevr
23125
23126 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
23127 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
23128 the "About" page for this repo.
23129
23130 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23131
23132 @end deftypevr
23133
23134 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
23135 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
23136 after this option will inherit the current section name.
23137
23138 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23139
23140 @end deftypevr
23141
23142 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
23143 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
23144
23145 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23146
23147 @end deftypevr
23148
23149 @end deftypevr
23150
23151 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
23152 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
23153
23154 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23155
23156 @end deftypevr
23157
23158
23159 @c %end of fragment
23160
23161 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
23162 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
23163 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
23164 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
23165
23166 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
23167
23168 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
23169 The cgit package.
23170 @end deftypevr
23171
23172 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
23173 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
23174 @end deftypevr
23175
23176 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
23177 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
23178
23179 @example
23180 (service cgit-service-type
23181 (opaque-cgit-configuration
23182 (cgitrc "")))
23183 @end example
23184
23185 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
23186
23187 @cindex Gitolite service
23188 @cindex Git, hosting
23189 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
23190 repositories on a central server.
23191
23192 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
23193 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
23194
23195 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
23196 user, and the provided SSH public key.
23197
23198 @example
23199 (service gitolite-service-type
23200 (gitolite-configuration
23201 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
23202 "yourname.pub"
23203 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
23204 @end example
23205
23206 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
23207 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
23208 following command to clone the admin repository.
23209
23210 @example
23211 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
23212 @end example
23213
23214 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
23215 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
23216 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
23217 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
23218
23219 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
23220 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
23221
23222 @table @asis
23223 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
23224 Gitolite package to use.
23225
23226 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
23227 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
23228 Gitolite over SSH.
23229
23230 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
23231 Group to use for Gitolite.
23232
23233 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
23234 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
23235
23236 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
23237 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
23238 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
23239
23240 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
23241 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
23242 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
23243 within the gitolite-admin repository.
23244
23245 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
23246
23247 @example
23248 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
23249 @end example
23250
23251 @end table
23252 @end deftp
23253
23254 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
23255 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
23256
23257 @table @asis
23258 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
23259 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
23260 contents.
23261
23262 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
23263 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
23264 like cgit or gitweb.
23265
23266 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
23267 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the "config" keyword. This
23268 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
23269
23270 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
23271 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
23272
23273 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
23274 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
23275
23276 @end table
23277 @end deftp
23278
23279
23280 @node Game Services
23281 @subsection Game Services
23282
23283 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
23284 @cindex wesnothd
23285 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
23286 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
23287 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
23288
23289 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
23290 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
23291 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
23292 configuration, instantiate it as:
23293
23294 @example
23295 (service wesnothd-service-type)
23296 @end example
23297 @end defvar
23298
23299 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
23300 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
23301
23302 @table @asis
23303 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
23304 The wesnoth server package to use.
23305
23306 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
23307 The port to bind the server to.
23308 @end table
23309 @end deftp
23310
23311 @node Miscellaneous Services
23312 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
23313
23314 @cindex fingerprint
23315 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
23316
23317 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
23318 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
23319
23320 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
23321 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
23322 reading capability.
23323
23324 @example
23325 (service fprintd-service-type)
23326 @end example
23327 @end defvr
23328
23329 @cindex sysctl
23330 @subsubheading System Control Service
23331
23332 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
23333 parameters at boot.
23334
23335 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
23336 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
23337 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
23338 instantiated as:
23339
23340 @example
23341 (service sysctl-service-type
23342 (sysctl-configuration
23343 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
23344 @end example
23345 @end defvr
23346
23347 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
23348 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
23349
23350 @table @asis
23351 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
23352 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
23353
23354 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
23355 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
23356 @end table
23357 @end deftp
23358
23359 @cindex pcscd
23360 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
23361
23362 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
23363 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
23364 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
23365 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
23366 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
23367
23368 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
23369 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
23370 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
23371 configuration, instantiate it as:
23372
23373 @example
23374 (service pcscd-service-type)
23375 @end example
23376 @end defvr
23377
23378 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
23379 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
23380
23381 @table @asis
23382 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
23383 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
23384 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
23385 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
23386 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
23387 @end table
23388 @end deftp
23389
23390 @cindex lirc
23391 @subsubheading Lirc Service
23392
23393 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
23394
23395 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
23396 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
23397 [#:extra-options '()]
23398 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
23399 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
23400
23401 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
23402 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
23403 for details.
23404
23405 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
23406 passed to @command{lircd}.
23407 @end deffn
23408
23409 @cindex spice
23410 @subsubheading Spice Service
23411
23412 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
23413
23414 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
23415 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
23416 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
23417 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
23418 @end deffn
23419
23420 @cindex inputattach
23421 @subsubheading inputattach Service
23422
23423 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
23424 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
23425 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
23426 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
23427 Xorg display server.
23428
23429 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
23430 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
23431 dispatches events from it.
23432 @end deffn
23433
23434 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
23435 @table @asis
23436 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
23437 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
23438 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
23439
23440 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
23441 The device file to connect to the device.
23442
23443 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
23444 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
23445 @end table
23446 @end deftp
23447
23448 @subsection Dictionary Services
23449 @cindex dictionary
23450 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
23451
23452 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
23453 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
23454 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
23455
23456 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
23457 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
23458 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
23459
23460 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
23461 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
23462 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
23463 @end deffn
23464
23465 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
23466 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
23467
23468 @table @asis
23469 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
23470 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
23471
23472 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
23473 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
23474 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
23475 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
23476
23477 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
23478 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
23479
23480 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
23481 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
23482 @end table
23483 @end deftp
23484
23485 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
23486 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
23487
23488 @table @asis
23489 @item @code{name}
23490 Name of the handler (module instance).
23491
23492 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
23493 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
23494 the module has the same name as the handler.
23495 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
23496
23497 @item @code{options}
23498 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
23499 @end table
23500 @end deftp
23501
23502 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
23503 Data type representing a dictionary database.
23504
23505 @table @asis
23506 @item @code{name}
23507 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
23508
23509 @item @code{handler}
23510 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
23511 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
23512
23513 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
23514 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
23515 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
23516
23517 @item @code{options}
23518 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
23519 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
23520 @end table
23521 @end deftp
23522
23523 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
23524 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
23525 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
23526 @end defvr
23527
23528 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
23529
23530 @example
23531 (dicod-service #:config
23532 (dicod-configuration
23533 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
23534 (name "wordnet")
23535 (module "dictorg")
23536 (options
23537 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
23538 (databases (list (dicod-database
23539 (name "wordnet")
23540 (complex? #t)
23541 (handler "wordnet")
23542 (options '("database=wn")))
23543 %dicod-database:gcide))))
23544 @end example
23545
23546 @cindex Docker
23547 @subsubheading Docker Service
23548
23549 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following service.
23550
23551 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
23552
23553 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
23554 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
23555 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
23556
23557 @end defvr
23558
23559 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
23560 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
23561
23562 @table @asis
23563
23564 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
23565 The Docker package to use.
23566
23567 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
23568 The Containerd package to use.
23569
23570 @end table
23571 @end deftp
23572
23573 @node Setuid Programs
23574 @section Setuid Programs
23575
23576 @cindex setuid programs
23577 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
23578 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
23579 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
23580 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
23581 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
23582 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
23583 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
23584 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
23585 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
23586
23587 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
23588 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
23589 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
23590 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
23591 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
23592 should be setuid root.
23593
23594 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
23595 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
23596 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
23597 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
23598 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
23599
23600 @example
23601 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
23602 @end example
23603
23604 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
23605 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
23606
23607 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
23608 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
23609
23610 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
23611 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
23612 @end defvr
23613
23614 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
23615 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
23616 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
23617 store.
23618
23619 @node X.509 Certificates
23620 @section X.509 Certificates
23621
23622 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
23623 @cindex X.509 certificates
23624 @cindex TLS
23625 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
23626 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
23627 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
23628 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
23629 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
23630 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
23631
23632 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
23633 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
23634 out-of-the-box.
23635
23636 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
23637 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
23638 certificates can be found.
23639
23640 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
23641 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
23642 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
23643 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
23644 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
23645 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
23646
23647 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
23648 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
23649 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
23650 to the certificates installed globally.
23651
23652 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
23653 can also install their own certificate package in
23654 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
23655 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
23656 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
23657 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
23658 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
23659 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
23660 would typically run something like:
23661
23662 @example
23663 $ guix install nss-certs
23664 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
23665 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
23666 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
23667 @end example
23668
23669 As another example, R requires the @code{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
23670 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
23671 something like this:
23672
23673 @example
23674 $ guix install nss-certs
23675 $ export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
23676 @end example
23677
23678 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
23679 variable in the relevant documentation.
23680
23681
23682 @node Name Service Switch
23683 @section Name Service Switch
23684
23685 @cindex name service switch
23686 @cindex NSS
23687 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
23688 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
23689 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
23690 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
23691 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
23692 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
23693 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
23694 C Library Reference Manual}).
23695
23696 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
23697 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
23698 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
23699 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
23700 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
23701 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
23702
23703 @cindex nss-mdns
23704 @cindex .local, host name lookup
23705 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
23706 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
23707 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
23708 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
23709
23710 @example
23711 (name-service-switch
23712 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
23713
23714 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
23715 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
23716 (name-service
23717 (name "mdns_minimal")
23718
23719 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
23720 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
23721 ;; no need to try the next methods.
23722 (reaction (lookup-specification
23723 (not-found => return))))
23724
23725 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
23726 (name-service
23727 (name "dns"))
23728
23729 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
23730 (name-service
23731 (name "mdns")))))
23732 @end example
23733
23734 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
23735 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
23736 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
23737
23738 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
23739 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
23740 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
23741 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
23742 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
23743 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
23744 @code{nscd-service}}).
23745
23746 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
23747 configurations.
23748
23749 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
23750 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
23751 @code{name-service-switch} object.
23752 @end defvr
23753
23754 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
23755 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
23756 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
23757 @end defvr
23758
23759 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
23760 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
23761 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
23762 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23763 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
23764 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
23765 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
23766 run @command{guix system}.
23767
23768 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
23769
23770 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
23771 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
23772 system databases.
23773
23774 @table @code
23775 @item aliases
23776 @itemx ethers
23777 @itemx group
23778 @itemx gshadow
23779 @itemx hosts
23780 @itemx initgroups
23781 @itemx netgroup
23782 @itemx networks
23783 @itemx password
23784 @itemx public-key
23785 @itemx rpc
23786 @itemx services
23787 @itemx shadow
23788 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
23789 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
23790 @end table
23791 @end deftp
23792
23793 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
23794
23795 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
23796 associated lookup action.
23797
23798 @table @code
23799 @item name
23800 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
23801 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23802
23803 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
23804 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
23805 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
23806 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
23807
23808 @item reaction
23809 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
23810 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
23811 Reference Manual}). For example:
23812
23813 @example
23814 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
23815 (success => return))
23816 @end example
23817 @end table
23818 @end deftp
23819
23820 @node Initial RAM Disk
23821 @section Initial RAM Disk
23822
23823 @cindex initrd
23824 @cindex initial RAM disk
23825 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
23826 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
23827 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
23828 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
23829 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
23830
23831 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
23832 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
23833 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
23834 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
23835 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
23836 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
23837 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
23838 file system, you would write:
23839
23840 @example
23841 (operating-system
23842 ;; @dots{}
23843 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
23844 @end example
23845
23846 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
23847 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
23848 @end defvr
23849
23850 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
23851 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
23852 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
23853 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
23854 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
23855 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
23856
23857 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
23858 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
23859 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
23860 system declaration like this:
23861
23862 @example
23863 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
23864 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
23865 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
23866 (apply base-initrd file-systems
23867 #:qemu-networking? #t
23868 rest)))
23869 @end example
23870
23871 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
23872 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
23873 volatile root file system.
23874
23875 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
23876 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
23877 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
23878 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
23879 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
23880 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
23881
23882 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
23883 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
23884 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
23885 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
23886
23887 @table @code
23888 @item --load=@var{boot}
23889 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
23890 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
23891
23892 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
23893 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
23894 initialization system.
23895
23896 @item --root=@var{root}
23897 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
23898 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system
23899 UUID.
23900
23901 @item --system=@var{system}
23902 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
23903 @var{system}.
23904
23905 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
23906 @cindex module, black-listing
23907 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
23908 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
23909 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
23910 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
23911 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
23912
23913 @item --repl
23914 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
23915 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
23916 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
23917 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
23918 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
23919
23920 @end table
23921
23922 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
23923 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
23924 here is how to use it and customize it further.
23925
23926 @cindex initrd
23927 @cindex initial RAM disk
23928 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
23929 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
23930 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
23931 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
23932 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
23933 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
23934 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
23935 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
23936 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
23937 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
23938 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
23939 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
23940 the root file system.
23941
23942 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
23943 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
23944 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
23945 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
23946 intended keyboard layout.
23947
23948 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
23949 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
23950 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
23951
23952 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
23953 to it are lost.
23954 @end deffn
23955
23956 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
23957 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
23958 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
23959 [#:linux-modules '()]
23960 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
23961 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
23962 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
23963 on the kernel command line via @code{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
23964 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
23965
23966 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
23967 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
23968 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
23969 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
23970 intended keyboard layout.
23971
23972 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
23973
23974 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
23975 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
23976 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
23977 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
23978 @end deffn
23979
23980 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
23981 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
23982 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
23983 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
23984 program to run in that initrd.
23985
23986 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
23987 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
23988 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
23989 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
23990 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
23991 automatically copied to the initrd.
23992 @end deffn
23993
23994 @node Bootloader Configuration
23995 @section Bootloader Configuration
23996
23997 @cindex bootloader
23998 @cindex boot loader
23999
24000 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
24001 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
24002 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
24003 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
24004 installed.
24005
24006 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
24007 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
24008 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
24009 field.
24010
24011 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
24012 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
24013
24014 @table @asis
24015
24016 @item @code{bootloader}
24017 @cindex EFI, bootloader
24018 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
24019 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
24020 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
24021 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
24022 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
24023
24024 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
24025 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
24026 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
24027 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
24028 when you boot it on your system.
24029
24030 @vindex grub-bootloader
24031 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
24032 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
24033
24034 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
24035 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
24036 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
24037 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
24038 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
24039 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
24040
24041 @item @code{target}
24042 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
24043 bootloader.
24044
24045 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
24046 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
24047 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
24048 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
24049 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
24050 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}.
24051
24052 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
24053 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
24054 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
24055 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
24056
24057 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
24058 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
24059 current system.
24060
24061 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
24062 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
24063 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
24064
24065 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
24066 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
24067 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
24068 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
24069
24070 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
24071 Layout}).
24072
24073 @quotation Note
24074 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
24075 @code{grub-efi}.
24076 @end quotation
24077
24078 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
24079 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
24080 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
24081 for GRUB.
24082
24083 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'gfxterm})
24084 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
24085 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
24086 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
24087 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
24088 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
24089 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24090
24091 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
24092 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
24093 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
24094 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
24095 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
24096 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
24097 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
24098 manual}).
24099
24100 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
24101 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
24102 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
24103 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24104
24105 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
24106 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
24107 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
24108 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24109 @end table
24110
24111 @end deftp
24112
24113 @cindex dual boot
24114 @cindex boot menu
24115 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
24116 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
24117 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
24118 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
24119 along these lines:
24120
24121 @example
24122 (menu-entry
24123 (label "The Other Distro")
24124 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
24125 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
24126 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
24127 @end example
24128
24129 Details below.
24130
24131 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
24132 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
24133
24134 @table @asis
24135
24136 @item @code{label}
24137 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
24138
24139 @item @code{linux}
24140 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
24141
24142 @example
24143 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
24144 @end example
24145
24146 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
24147 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
24148 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
24149
24150 @example
24151 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
24152 @end example
24153
24154 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
24155 field is ignored entirely.
24156
24157 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
24158 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
24159 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
24160
24161 @item @code{initrd}
24162 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
24163 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
24164 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
24165 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
24166 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
24167
24168 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
24169 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
24170 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
24171 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
24172 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
24173
24174 @end table
24175 @end deftp
24176
24177 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
24178 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
24179 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not documented yet.
24180
24181 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
24182 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
24183 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
24184 record.
24185
24186 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
24187 logos.
24188 @end defvr
24189
24190
24191 @node Invoking guix system
24192 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
24193
24194 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
24195 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
24196 system} command. The synopsis is:
24197
24198 @example
24199 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
24200 @end example
24201
24202 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
24203 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
24204 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
24205 supported:
24206
24207 @table @code
24208 @item search
24209 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
24210 expressions, sorted by relevance:
24211
24212 @example
24213 $ guix system search console font
24214 name: console-fonts
24215 location: gnu/services/base.scm:729:2
24216 extends: shepherd-root
24217 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are
24218 + per virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list
24219 + of tty/font pairs like:
24220 +
24221 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16"))
24222 relevance: 20
24223
24224 name: mingetty
24225 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1048:2
24226 extends: shepherd-root
24227 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
24228 relevance: 2
24229
24230 name: login
24231 location: gnu/services/base.scm:775:2
24232 extends: pam
24233 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
24234 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
24235 relevance: 2
24236
24237 @dots{}
24238 @end example
24239
24240 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
24241 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
24242 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
24243
24244 @item reconfigure
24245 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
24246 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
24247 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
24248 systems already running Guix System.}.
24249
24250 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
24251 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
24252 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
24253 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
24254 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
24255 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
24256
24257 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
24258 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
24259 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
24260 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
24261 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
24262
24263 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
24264 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
24265 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
24266 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
24267
24268 @quotation Note
24269 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
24270 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
24271 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
24272 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
24273 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
24274 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
24275 @end quotation
24276
24277 @item switch-generation
24278 @cindex generations
24279 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
24280 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
24281 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
24282 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
24283 and it moves the entries for the other generatiors to a submenu, if
24284 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
24285 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
24286
24287 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
24288 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
24289 configuration file.
24290
24291 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
24292 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
24293 generation 7:
24294
24295 @example
24296 guix system switch-generation 7
24297 @end example
24298
24299 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
24300 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
24301 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
24302 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
24303 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
24304 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
24305
24306 @example
24307 guix system switch-generation -- -1
24308 @end example
24309
24310 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
24311 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
24312 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
24313 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
24314 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
24315 like activating and deactivating services.
24316
24317 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
24318
24319 @item roll-back
24320 @cindex rolling back
24321 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
24322 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
24323 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
24324 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
24325
24326 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
24327 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
24328 generation.
24329
24330 @item delete-generations
24331 @cindex deleting system generations
24332 @cindex saving space
24333 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
24334 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
24335 collector'').
24336
24337 This works in the same way as @command{guix package --delete-generations}
24338 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{--delete-generations}}). With no
24339 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
24340
24341 @example
24342 guix system delete-generations
24343 @end example
24344
24345 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
24346 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
24347
24348 @example
24349 guix system delete-generations 2m
24350 @end example
24351
24352 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
24353 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
24354 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
24355
24356 @item build
24357 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
24358 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
24359 This action does not actually install anything.
24360
24361 @item init
24362 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
24363 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
24364 installations of Guix System. For instance:
24365
24366 @example
24367 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
24368 @end example
24369
24370 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
24371 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
24372 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
24373 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
24374 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
24375
24376 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
24377 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
24378 passed.
24379
24380 @item vm
24381 @cindex virtual machine
24382 @cindex VM
24383 @anchor{guix system vm}
24384 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
24385 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
24386
24387 @quotation Note
24388 The @code{vm} action and others below
24389 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
24390 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
24391 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
24392 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
24393 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
24394 @end quotation
24395
24396 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
24397 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
24398 emulated machine:
24399
24400 @example
24401 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -net user
24402 @end example
24403
24404 The VM shares its store with the host system.
24405
24406 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
24407 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
24408 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
24409 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
24410
24411 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
24412 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
24413 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
24414
24415 @example
24416 guix system vm my-config.scm \
24417 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
24418 @end example
24419
24420 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
24421 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
24422 store of the host can then be mounted.
24423
24424 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
24425 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
24426 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
24427 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
24428 size of the image.
24429
24430 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
24431 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
24432 @item vm-image
24433 @itemx disk-image
24434 @itemx docker-image
24435 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
24436 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
24437 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
24438 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
24439 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
24440 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
24441 @code{docker-image}.
24442
24443 You can specify the root file system type by using the
24444 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
24445
24446 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
24447 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM},
24448 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
24449
24450 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
24451 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
24452 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
24453 using the following command:
24454
24455 @example
24456 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
24457 @end example
24458
24459 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
24460 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
24461 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
24462 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
24463 Docker container using commands like the following:
24464
24465 @example
24466 image_id="$(docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz)"
24467 docker run -e GUIX_NEW_SYSTEM=/var/guix/profiles/system \\
24468 --entrypoint /var/guix/profiles/system/profile/bin/guile \\
24469 $image_id /var/guix/profiles/system/boot
24470 @end example
24471
24472 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
24473 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
24474 start any services you have defined in the operating system
24475 configuration. Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
24476 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
24477 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
24478 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
24479 @code{docker run}.
24480
24481 @item container
24482 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
24483 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
24484 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
24485 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
24486 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
24487 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
24488
24489 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
24490 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
24491 system.
24492
24493 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
24494 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
24495 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
24496
24497 @example
24498 guix system container my-config.scm \
24499 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
24500 @end example
24501
24502 @quotation Note
24503 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
24504 @end quotation
24505
24506 @end table
24507
24508 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
24509 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
24510 following:
24511
24512 @table @option
24513 @item --expression=@var{expr}
24514 @itemx -e @var{expr}
24515 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
24516 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
24517 operating system.
24518 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
24519 Installation Image}).
24520
24521 @item --system=@var{system}
24522 @itemx -s @var{system}
24523 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
24524 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
24525
24526 @item --derivation
24527 @itemx -d
24528 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
24529 building anything.
24530
24531 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
24532 @itemx -t @var{type}
24533 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
24534 @var{type} on the image.
24535
24536 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
24537
24538 @cindex ISO-9660 format
24539 @cindex CD image format
24540 @cindex DVD image format
24541 @code{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
24542 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
24543
24544 @item --image-size=@var{size}
24545 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
24546 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
24547 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
24548 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
24549
24550 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
24551 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
24552 @var{file}.
24553
24554 @item --root=@var{file}
24555 @itemx -r @var{file}
24556 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
24557 collector root.
24558
24559 @item --skip-checks
24560 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
24561
24562 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
24563 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
24564 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
24565 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
24566 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
24567 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
24568
24569 @cindex on-error
24570 @cindex on-error strategy
24571 @cindex error strategy
24572 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
24573 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
24574 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
24575
24576 @table @code
24577 @item nothing-special
24578 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
24579
24580 @item backtrace
24581 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
24582
24583 @item debug
24584 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
24585 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
24586 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
24587 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
24588 a list of available debugging commands.
24589 @end table
24590 @end table
24591
24592 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
24593 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
24594 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
24595 bootloader boot menu:
24596
24597 @table @code
24598
24599 @item list-generations
24600 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
24601 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
24602 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
24603 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
24604
24605 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
24606 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
24607 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
24608 generations that are up to 10 days old:
24609
24610 @example
24611 $ guix system list-generations 10d
24612 @end example
24613
24614 @end table
24615
24616 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
24617 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
24618 each other:
24619
24620 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
24621 @table @code
24622
24623 @item extension-graph
24624 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
24625 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
24626 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
24627 extensions.)
24628
24629 The command:
24630
24631 @example
24632 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
24633 @end example
24634
24635 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
24636
24637 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
24638 @item shepherd-graph
24639 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
24640 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
24641 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
24642 example graph.
24643
24644 @end table
24645
24646 @node Running Guix in a VM
24647 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
24648
24649 @cindex virtual machine
24650 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
24651 distributed at
24652 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}
24653 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
24654 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
24655 as QEMU (see below for details).
24656
24657 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
24658 commonly-used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
24659 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
24660 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
24661 as @file{/etc/config.scm} (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
24662
24663 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
24664 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
24665 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
24666 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
24667
24668 @cindex QEMU
24669 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
24670 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
24671 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
24672 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
24673 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
24674 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
24675
24676 @example
24677 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
24678 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
24679 -enable-kvm -m 512 \
24680 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
24681 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
24682 @end example
24683
24684 Here is what each of these options means:
24685
24686 @table @code
24687 @item qemu-system-x86_64
24688 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
24689 host.
24690
24691 @item -net user
24692 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
24693 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
24694 guest OS online.
24695
24696 @item -net nic,model=virtio
24697 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
24698 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
24699 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
24700 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
24701
24702 @item -enable-kvm
24703 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
24704 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
24705 faster.
24706
24707 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
24708 @item -m 1024
24709 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
24710 which may be insufficient for some operations.
24711
24712 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
24713 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
24714 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
24715 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
24716 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
24717
24718 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
24719 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing store the
24720 the ``myhd'' drive.
24721 @end table
24722
24723 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
24724 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-net user} flag by default.
24725 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
24726 to your system definition and start the VM using
24727 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -net user}. An important caveat of using
24728 @command{-net user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
24729 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
24730 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
24731
24732 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
24733
24734 @cindex SSH
24735 @cindex SSH server
24736 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
24737 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
24738 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
24739 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
24740
24741 @example
24742 `guix system vm config.scm` -net user,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
24743 @end example
24744
24745 To connect to the VM you can run
24746
24747 @example
24748 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
24749 @end example
24750
24751 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
24752 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
24753 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
24754 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
24755 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
24756
24757 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
24758
24759 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
24760 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
24761 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
24762 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
24763
24764 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
24765 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
24766
24767 @example
24768 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
24769 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
24770 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
24771 name=com.redhat.spice.0
24772 @end example
24773
24774 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
24775
24776 @node Defining Services
24777 @section Defining Services
24778
24779 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
24780 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
24781 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
24782
24783 @menu
24784 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
24785 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
24786 * Service Reference:: API reference.
24787 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
24788 @end menu
24789
24790 @node Service Composition
24791 @subsection Service Composition
24792
24793 @cindex services
24794 @cindex daemons
24795 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
24796 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
24797 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
24798 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
24799 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
24800 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
24801 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
24802 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
24803 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
24804 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
24805 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
24806 of the system.
24807
24808 @cindex service extensions
24809 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
24810 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
24811 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
24812 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
24813 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
24814 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
24815 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
24816 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
24817 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
24818 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
24819 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
24820
24821 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
24822 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
24823 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
24824
24825 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
24826
24827 @cindex system service
24828 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
24829 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
24830 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
24831 to learn about the other service types shown here.
24832 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
24833 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
24834 particular operating system definition.
24835
24836 @cindex service types
24837 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
24838 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
24839 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
24840 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
24841 different parameters.
24842
24843 The following section describes the programming interface for service
24844 types and services.
24845
24846 @node Service Types and Services
24847 @subsection Service Types and Services
24848
24849 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
24850 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
24851 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
24852
24853 @example
24854 (define guix-service-type
24855 (service-type
24856 (name 'guix)
24857 (extensions
24858 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
24859 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
24860 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
24861 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
24862 @end example
24863
24864 @noindent
24865 It defines three things:
24866
24867 @enumerate
24868 @item
24869 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
24870
24871 @item
24872 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
24873 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
24874 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
24875
24876 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
24877 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
24878
24879 @item
24880 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
24881 @end enumerate
24882
24883 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
24884
24885 @table @code
24886 @item shepherd-root-service-type
24887 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
24888 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
24889 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
24890 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
24891
24892 @item account-service-type
24893 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
24894 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
24895 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
24896 guix-daemon}).
24897
24898 @item activation-service-type
24899 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
24900 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
24901 booted.
24902 @end table
24903
24904 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
24905
24906 @example
24907 (service guix-service-type
24908 (guix-configuration
24909 (build-accounts 5)
24910 (use-substitutes? #f)))
24911 @end example
24912
24913 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
24914 the parameters of this specific service instance.
24915 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
24916 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
24917 value is omitted, the default value specified by
24918 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
24919
24920 @example
24921 (service guix-service-type)
24922 @end example
24923
24924 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
24925 services but is not extensible itself.
24926
24927 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
24928
24929 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
24930
24931 @example
24932 (define udev-service-type
24933 (service-type (name 'udev)
24934 (extensions
24935 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
24936 udev-shepherd-service)))
24937
24938 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
24939 (extend (lambda (config rules)
24940 (match config
24941 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
24942 (udev-configuration
24943 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
24944 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
24945 @end example
24946
24947 This is the service type for the
24948 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
24949 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
24950 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
24951
24952 @table @code
24953 @item compose
24954 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
24955 services of this type.
24956
24957 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
24958 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
24959
24960 @item extend
24961 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
24962 the composition of the extensions.
24963
24964 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
24965 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
24966 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
24967 list of contributed rules.
24968
24969 @item description
24970 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
24971 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
24972 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
24973 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
24974 @end table
24975
24976 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
24977 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
24978 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
24979
24980 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
24981 interface for services.
24982
24983 @node Service Reference
24984 @subsection Service Reference
24985
24986 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
24987 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
24988 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
24989 @code{(gnu services)} module.
24990
24991 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
24992 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
24993 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
24994 this particular service instance.
24995
24996 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
24997 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
24998 raised.
24999
25000 For instance, this:
25001
25002 @example
25003 (service openssh-service-type)
25004 @end example
25005
25006 @noindent
25007 is equivalent to this:
25008
25009 @example
25010 (service openssh-service-type
25011 (openssh-configuration))
25012 @end example
25013
25014 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
25015 with the default configuration.
25016 @end deffn
25017
25018 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
25019 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
25020 @end deffn
25021
25022 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
25023 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
25024 @end deffn
25025
25026 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
25027 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
25028 parameters.
25029 @end deffn
25030
25031 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
25032
25033 @example
25034 (define s
25035 (service nginx-service-type
25036 (nginx-configuration
25037 (nginx nginx)
25038 (log-directory log-directory)
25039 (run-directory run-directory)
25040 (file config-file))))
25041
25042 (service? s)
25043 @result{} #t
25044
25045 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
25046 @result{} #t
25047 @end example
25048
25049 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
25050 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
25051 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
25052 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
25053 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
25054 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
25055 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
25056 common pattern.
25057
25058 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
25059 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
25060
25061 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
25062 clauses. Each clause has the form:
25063
25064 @example
25065 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
25066 @end example
25067
25068 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
25069 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
25070 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
25071 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
25072 @var{type}.
25073
25074 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
25075 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
25076 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
25077 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
25078 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
25079 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
25080
25081 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
25082
25083 @end deffn
25084
25085 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
25086 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
25087 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
25088 @code{operating-system} declaration.
25089
25090 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
25091 @cindex service type
25092 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
25093 and Services}).
25094
25095 @table @asis
25096 @item @code{name}
25097 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
25098
25099 @item @code{extensions}
25100 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
25101
25102 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
25103 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
25104 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
25105 services.
25106
25107 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
25108 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
25109 extensions. It may return any single value.
25110
25111 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
25112 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
25113
25114 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
25115 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
25116 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
25117 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
25118 parameter value for the service instance.
25119 @end table
25120
25121 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
25122 @end deftp
25123
25124 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
25125 @var{compute}
25126 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
25127 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
25128 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
25129 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
25130 @end deffn
25131
25132 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
25133 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
25134 @end deffn
25135
25136 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
25137 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
25138 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
25139 provides a shorthand for this.
25140
25141 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
25142 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
25143 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
25144 service is an instance.
25145
25146 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
25147 an additional job:
25148
25149 @example
25150 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
25151 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
25152 @end example
25153 @end deffn
25154
25155 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
25156 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
25157 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
25158 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
25159 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
25160 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
25161 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
25162
25163 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
25164 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
25165 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
25166 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
25167 @end deffn
25168
25169 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
25170 service types, some of which are listed below.
25171
25172 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
25173 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
25174 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
25175 @end defvr
25176
25177 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
25178 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
25179 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
25180 @end defvr
25181
25182 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
25183 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
25184 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
25185 passing it name/file tuples such as:
25186
25187 @example
25188 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
25189 @end example
25190
25191 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
25192 pointing to the given file.
25193 @end defvr
25194
25195 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
25196 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
25197 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
25198 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
25199 @end defvr
25200
25201 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
25202 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
25203 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
25204 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
25205 @end defvr
25206
25207
25208 @node Shepherd Services
25209 @subsection Shepherd Services
25210
25211 @cindex shepherd services
25212 @cindex PID 1
25213 @cindex init system
25214 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
25215 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
25216 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
25217 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
25218 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
25219
25220 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
25221 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
25222 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
25223 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
25224 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
25225
25226 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
25227
25228 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
25229 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
25230 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
25231
25232 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
25233 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
25234 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
25235
25236 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
25237 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
25238
25239 @table @asis
25240 @item @code{provision}
25241 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
25242
25243 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
25244 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
25245 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
25246 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
25247
25248 @item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
25249 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
25250
25251 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
25252 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
25253 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
25254 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
25255 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
25256
25257 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
25258 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
25259 underlying process dies.
25260
25261 @item @code{start}
25262 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
25263 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
25264 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
25265 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
25266 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
25267 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
25268
25269 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
25270 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
25271 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
25272 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
25273 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
25274 @command{herd} sub-commands:
25275
25276 @example
25277 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
25278 @end example
25279
25280 @item @code{documentation}
25281 A documentation string, as shown when running:
25282
25283 @example
25284 herd doc @var{service-name}
25285 @end example
25286
25287 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
25288 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
25289
25290 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
25291 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
25292 @code{stop} are evaluated.
25293
25294 @end table
25295 @end deftp
25296
25297 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
25298 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
25299 Shepherd service (see above).
25300
25301 @table @code
25302 @item name
25303 Symbol naming the action.
25304
25305 @item documentation
25306 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
25307
25308 @example
25309 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
25310 @end example
25311
25312 @item procedure
25313 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
25314 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
25315 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
25316 @end table
25317
25318 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
25319 greets the user:
25320
25321 @example
25322 (shepherd-action
25323 (name 'say-hello)
25324 (documentation "Say hi!")
25325 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
25326 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
25327 args)
25328 #t)))
25329 @end example
25330
25331 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
25332
25333 @example
25334 # herd say-hello example
25335 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
25336 # herd say-hello example a b c
25337 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
25338 @end example
25339
25340 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
25341 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
25342 info on actions.
25343 @end deftp
25344
25345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
25346 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
25347
25348 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
25349 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
25350 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
25351 @end defvr
25352
25353 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
25354 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
25355 @end defvr
25356
25357
25358 @node Documentation
25359 @chapter Documentation
25360
25361 @cindex documentation, searching for
25362 @cindex searching for documentation
25363 @cindex Info, documentation format
25364 @cindex man pages
25365 @cindex manual pages
25366 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
25367 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
25368 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
25369 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
25370 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
25371 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
25372
25373 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
25374 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
25375 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
25376
25377 @example
25378 $ info -k TLS
25379 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
25380 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
25381 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
25382 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
25383 @dots{}
25384 @end example
25385
25386 @noindent
25387 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
25388
25389 @example
25390 $ man -k TLS
25391 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
25392 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
25393 @dots {}
25394 @end example
25395
25396 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
25397 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
25398 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
25399 respected.
25400
25401 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
25402 running, say:
25403
25404 @example
25405 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
25406 @end example
25407
25408 @noindent
25409 or:
25410
25411 @example
25412 $ man certtool
25413 @end example
25414
25415 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
25416 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
25417 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
25418 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
25419 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
25420 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
25421
25422 @node Installing Debugging Files
25423 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
25424
25425 @cindex debugging files
25426 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
25427 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
25428 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
25429 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
25430 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
25431
25432 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
25433 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
25434 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
25435 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
25436 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
25437 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
25438 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
25439
25440 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
25441 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
25442 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
25443 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
25444 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
25445 with GDB}).
25446
25447 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
25448 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
25449 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
25450 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
25451 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
25452 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
25453 Guile:
25454
25455 @example
25456 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
25457 @end example
25458
25459 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
25460 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
25461 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
25462 GDB}):
25463
25464 @example
25465 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
25466 @end example
25467
25468 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
25469 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
25470
25471 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
25472 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
25473 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
25474 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
25475 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
25476 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
25477
25478 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
25479 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
25480 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
25481 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
25482 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
25483 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
25484 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
25485 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
25486
25487
25488 @node Security Updates
25489 @chapter Security Updates
25490
25491 @cindex security updates
25492 @cindex security vulnerabilities
25493 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
25494 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
25495 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
25496 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
25497 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
25498 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
25499 distribution:
25500
25501 @smallexample
25502 $ guix lint -c cve
25503 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
25504 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
25505 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
25506 @dots{}
25507 @end smallexample
25508
25509 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
25510
25511 @quotation Note
25512 As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described below is considered
25513 ``beta''.
25514 @end quotation
25515
25516 Guix follows a functional
25517 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
25518 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
25519 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
25520 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
25521 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
25522 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
25523 desired.
25524
25525 @cindex grafts
25526 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
25527 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
25528 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
25529 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
25530 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
25531 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
25532 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
25533
25534 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
25535 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
25536 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
25537 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
25538 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
25539 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
25540
25541 @example
25542 (define bash
25543 (package
25544 (name "bash")
25545 ;; @dots{}
25546 (replacement bash-fixed)))
25547 @end example
25548
25549 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
25550 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
25551 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
25552 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
25553 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
25554 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
25555 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
25556 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
25557
25558 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
25559 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
25560 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
25561 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
25562 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
25563 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
25564 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
25565
25566 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
25567 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
25568 Thus, the command:
25569
25570 @example
25571 guix build bash --no-grafts
25572 @end example
25573
25574 @noindent
25575 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
25576
25577 @example
25578 guix build bash
25579 @end example
25580
25581 @noindent
25582 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
25583 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
25584
25585 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
25586 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
25587
25588 @example
25589 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
25590 @end example
25591
25592 @noindent
25593 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
25594 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
25595
25596 @example
25597 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
25598 @end example
25599
25600 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
25601 @command{lsof} command:
25602
25603 @example
25604 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
25605 @end example
25606
25607
25608 @node Bootstrapping
25609 @chapter Bootstrapping
25610
25611 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
25612
25613 @cindex bootstrapping
25614
25615 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
25616 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
25617 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
25618 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
25619 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
25620 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
25621 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
25622 a ``regular user''.
25623
25624 @cindex bootstrap binaries
25625 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
25626 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
25627 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
25628 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
25629 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
25630 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
25631 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
25632 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
25633 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
25634
25635 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
25636 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
25637
25638 @unnumberedsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
25639
25640 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
25641 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
25642 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
25643
25644 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
25645 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
25646 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
25647 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
25648
25649 @example
25650 guix graph -t derivation \
25651 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
25652 | dot -Tps > t.ps
25653 @end example
25654
25655 At this level of detail, things are
25656 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
25657 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
25658 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
25659 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
25660 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
25661 (@pxref{The Store}).
25662
25663 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
25664 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
25665 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
25666 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
25667 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
25668 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
25669 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
25670 tarball to be unpacked.
25671
25672 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
25673 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
25674 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
25675 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
25676 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
25677 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
25678 in the store, using the original layout. The
25679 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
25680 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
25681 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
25682 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
25683
25684 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
25685 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
25686 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
25687
25688
25689 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
25690
25691 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
25692 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
25693 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
25694 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
25695 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
25696 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
25697 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
25698
25699 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
25700 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
25701 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
25702 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
25703 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
25704 package from source. The command:
25705
25706 @example
25707 guix graph -t bag \
25708 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
25709 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
25710 @end example
25711
25712 @noindent
25713 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
25714 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
25715 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
25716 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
25717
25718 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
25719
25720 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
25721 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
25722 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
25723 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
25724 built.
25725
25726 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
25727 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
25728 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
25729 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
25730
25731 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
25732 GCC uses @code{ld}
25733 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
25734 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
25735 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
25736
25737 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
25738 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
25739 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
25740 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
25741 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
25742
25743
25744 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
25745
25746 @cindex bootstrap binaries
25747 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
25748 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
25749 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
25750 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
25751
25752 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
25753 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
25754 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
25755
25756 @example
25757 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
25758 @end example
25759
25760 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
25761 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
25762 this section.
25763
25764 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
25765 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
25766 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
25767 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
25768 know.
25769
25770 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
25771
25772 Our bootstrap binaries currently include GCC, Guile, etc. That's a lot
25773 of binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these
25774 big chunks of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it
25775 hard to establish what source code produced them. Every unauditable
25776 binary also leaves us vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by
25777 Ken Thompson in the 1984 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
25778
25779 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
25780 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
25781 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
25782 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
25783 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
25784
25785 The @uref{http://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
25786 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
25787 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
25788 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
25789 a simple and auditable assembler. Your help is welcome!
25790
25791
25792 @node Porting
25793 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
25794
25795 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
25796 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
25797 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
25798 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
25799 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
25800 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
25801 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
25802
25803 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
25804 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
25805 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
25806 one:
25807
25808 @example
25809 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
25810 @end example
25811
25812 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
25813 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
25814 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
25815 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
25816 taught about the new platform.
25817
25818 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
25819 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
25820 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
25821 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
25822 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
25823 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
25824 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
25825 as well.
25826
25827 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
25828 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
25829 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
25830 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
25831 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
25832 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
25833 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
25834 reason.
25835
25836 @c *********************************************************************
25837 @include contributing.texi
25838
25839 @c *********************************************************************
25840 @node Acknowledgments
25841 @chapter Acknowledgments
25842
25843 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
25844 which was designed and
25845 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
25846 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
25847 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
25848 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
25849 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
25850
25851 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
25852 an inspiration for Guix.
25853
25854 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
25855 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
25856 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
25857 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
25858 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
25859
25860
25861 @c *********************************************************************
25862 @node GNU Free Documentation License
25863 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
25864 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
25865 @include fdl-1.3.texi
25866
25867 @c *********************************************************************
25868 @node Concept Index
25869 @unnumbered Concept Index
25870 @printindex cp
25871
25872 @node Programming Index
25873 @unnumbered Programming Index
25874 @syncodeindex tp fn
25875 @syncodeindex vr fn
25876 @printindex fn
25877
25878 @bye
25879
25880 @c Local Variables:
25881 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
25882 @c End: